]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/gnus.texi
Trailing whitespace deleted.
[gnu-emacs] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*- mode: texinfo; coding: iso-latin-1; -*-
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @synindex fn cp
6 @synindex vr cp
7 @synindex pg cp
8 @dircategory Emacs
9 @direntry
10 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
11 @end direntry
12 @iftex
13 @finalout
14 @end iftex
15 @setchapternewpage odd
16
17 @iftex
18 @iflatex
19 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
20 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
21 \usepackage{pagestyle}
22 \usepackage{epsfig}
23 \usepackage{bembo}
24 \usepackage{pixidx}
25
26 \makeindex
27 \begin{document}
28
29 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
30 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
31
32 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
33
34 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
35 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
36
37 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
38 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
39
40 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\fontfamily{pfu}\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont #1}}
41 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
42 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\fontfamily{pfu}\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont #1}''}
43 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
44 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
45 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
46 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
47 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
48 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
49 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
50 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
51 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
52 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
53 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
54 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
55
56 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
57 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
58 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
59 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
60 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
61 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
62 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
63 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
64 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
65 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
66 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
67 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
68 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
69
70 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head.eps,height=1cm}}}
71 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
72 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
73 }
74
75 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
76
77 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
78 {\mbox{}}
79 }
80
81 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
82 \gnusdimen 0pt
83
84 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
85 \gnuscleardoublepage
86 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
87 \chapter{#2}
88 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
89 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
90 \thispagestyle{empty}
91 \hspace*{-2cm}
92 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
93 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
94 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
95 \end{picture}
96 \clearpage
97 }
98
99 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
100 \begin{figure}
101 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
102 #3
103 \end{picture}
104 \caption{#1}
105 \end{figure}
106 }
107
108 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
109 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/#1-up.ps,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/#1-up.ps,height=1cm}}}
110 }
111
112 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
113 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
114 }
115
116 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
117 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
118 }
119
120 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
121 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
122 }
123
124 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
125
126 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
127 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
128 \section{#1}
129 }
130
131 \newenvironment{codelist}%
132 {\begin{list}{}{
133 }
134 }{\end{list}}
135
136 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
137 {\begin{list}{}{
138 \labelwidth=0cm
139 }
140 }{\end{list}}
141
142 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
143 {\begin{list}{}{
144 }
145 }{\end{list}}
146
147 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
148 {\begin{list}{}{
149 }
150 }{\end{list}}
151
152 \newenvironment{samplist}%
153 {\begin{list}{}{
154 }
155 }{\end{list}}
156
157 \newenvironment{varlist}%
158 {\begin{list}{}{
159 }
160 }{\end{list}}
161
162 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
163 {\begin{list}{}{
164 }
165 }{\end{list}}
166
167 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
168 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
169 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
170
171 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
172 {
173 {
174 \ifodd\count0
175 {
176 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
177 }
178 \else
179 {
180 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
181 }
182 }
183 \fi
184 }
185 }
186 {
187 \ifodd\count0
188 \mbox{} \hfill
189 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
190 \else
191 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
192 \hfill \mbox{}
193 \fi
194 }
195
196 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
197 {
198 {
199 \ifodd\count0
200 {
201 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
202 }
203 \else
204 {
205 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
206 }
207 \fi
208 }
209 }
210 {
211 \ifodd\count0
212 \mbox{} \hfill
213 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
214 \else
215 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
216 \hfill \mbox{}
217 \fi
218 }
219
220 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
221 {
222 {
223 \ifodd\count0
224 {
225 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
226 }
227 \else
228 {
229 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
230 }
231 \fi
232 }
233 }
234 {
235 \ifodd\count0
236 \mbox{} \hfill
237 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
238 \else
239 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=1cm}}
240 \hfill \mbox{}
241 \fi
242 }
243
244 \pagenumbering{roman}
245 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
246
247 @end iflatex
248 @end iftex
249
250 @iftex
251 @iflatex
252 \begin{titlepage}
253 {
254
255 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
256 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
257 \parindent=0cm
258 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
259
260 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\\
261 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
262 \vfill
263 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo.eps,height=15cm}
264 \vfill
265 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
266 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
267 \newpage
268 }
269
270 \mbox{}
271 \vfill
272
273 \thispagestyle{empty}
274
275 Copyright \copyright{} 1995,96,97,98,99,2000,2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
276
277
278 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
279 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
280 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
281 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
282 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
283 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
284 License'' in the Emacs manual.
285
286 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
287 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
288 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
289
290 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
291 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
292 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
293 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
294 \newpage
295 \end{titlepage}
296 @end iflatex
297 @end iftex
298
299 @ifnottex
300
301 This file documents Gnus, the GNU Emacs newsreader.
302
303 Copyright (C) 1995,96,97,98,99,2000,2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
304
305 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
306 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
307 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
308 Invariant Sections being none, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
309 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
310 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
311 License'' in the Emacs manual.
312
313 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
314 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
315 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
316
317 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
318 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
319 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
320 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
321 @end ifnottex
322
323 @tex
324
325 @titlepage
326 @title Gnus Manual
327
328 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
329 @page
330
331 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
332 Copyright @copyright{} 1995,96,97,98,99,2000,2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
333
334 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
335 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
336 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
337 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
338 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
339 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
340 License'' in the Emacs manual.
341
342 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
343 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
344 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
345
346 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
347 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
348 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
349 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
350
351 @end titlepage
352 @page
353
354 @end tex
355
356
357 @node Top
358 @top The Gnus Newsreader
359
360 @ifinfo
361
362 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
363 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@sc{nntp}, local
364 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
365 luck.
366
367 This manual corresponds to Gnus 5.9.0.
368
369 @end ifinfo
370
371 @iftex
372
373 @iflatex
374 \tableofcontents
375 \gnuscleardoublepage
376 @end iflatex
377
378 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
379 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
380
381 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
382 being accused of plagiarism:
383
384 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
385 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
386 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
387 can even read news with it!
388
389 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
390 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
391 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
392 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
393 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
394 the program.
395
396 @end iftex
397
398 @menu
399 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
400 * The Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
401 * The Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
402 * The Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
403 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
404 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
405 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
406 * Various:: General purpose settings.
407 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
408 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, FAQ, History, Internals.
409 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
410 * Key Index:: Key Index.
411
412 @detailmenu
413 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
414
415 Starting Gnus
416
417 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
418 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
419 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
420 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
421 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
422 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
423 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
424 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
425 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
426 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
427 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
428
429 New Groups
430
431 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
432 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
433 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
434
435 The Group Buffer
436
437 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
438 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
439 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
440 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
441 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
442 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
443 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
444 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
445 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
446 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
447 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
448 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
449 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
450 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
451 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
452 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
453 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
454
455 Group Buffer Format
456
457 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
458 * Group Modeline Specification:: The group buffer modeline.
459 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
460
461 Group Topics
462
463 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
464 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
465 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
466 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
467 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
468
469 Misc Group Stuff
470
471 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
472 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
473 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
474 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
475
476 The Summary Buffer
477
478 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
479 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
480 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
481 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
482 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
483 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
484 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
485 * Threading:: How threads are made.
486 * Sorting:: How articles and threads are sorted.
487 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
488 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
489 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
490 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
491 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
492 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
493 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
494 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
495 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
496 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
497 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
498 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
499 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
500 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
501 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
502 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
503 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer.
504 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
505 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
506
507 Summary Buffer Format
508
509 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
510 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
511 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
512 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
513
514 Choosing Articles
515
516 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
517 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
518
519 Reply, Followup and Post
520
521 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
522 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
523 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
524 * Canceling and Superseding:: ``Whoops, I shouldn't have called him that.''
525
526 Marking Articles
527
528 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
529 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
530 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
531 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
532 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
533 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
534
535 Threading
536
537 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
538 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
539
540 Customizing Threading
541
542 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
543 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
544 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
545 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over... but you were wrong!
546
547 Decoding Articles
548
549 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
550 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
551 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
552 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
553 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
554 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
555
556 Decoding Variables
557
558 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
559 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
560 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
561
562 Article Treatment
563
564 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
565 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
566 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
567 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
568 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
569 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
570 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
571 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
572
573 Alternative Approaches
574
575 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
576 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
577
578 Various Summary Stuff
579
580 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
581 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
582 * Summary Generation Commands:: (Re)generating the summary buffer.
583 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
584
585 The Article Buffer
586
587 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
588 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @sc{mime} before reading them.
589 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
590 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
591 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
592
593 Composing Messages
594
595 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
596 * Posting Server:: What server should you post via?
597 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
598 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
599 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
600 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
601 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
602
603 Select Methods
604
605 * The Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
606 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
607 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
608 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
609 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
610 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
611 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
612
613 The Server Buffer
614
615 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
616 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
617 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
618 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
619 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
620 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
621 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
622
623 Getting News
624
625 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @sc{nntp} server.
626 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
627
628 Getting Mail
629
630 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
631 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
632 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
633 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
634 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
635 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
636 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
637 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
638 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
639 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
640 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
641 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
642 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
643
644 Mail Sources
645
646 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
647 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
648 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
649
650 Choosing a Mail Back End
651
652 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
653 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the rmail babyl format.
654 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
655 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
656 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
657 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
658
659 Browsing the Web
660
661 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
662 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
663 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
664 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
665
666 Other Sources
667
668 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
669 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
670 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
671 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
672 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
673 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @sc{imap} client.
674
675 Document Groups
676
677 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
678
679 SOUP
680
681 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
682 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
683 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
684
685 @sc{imap}
686
687 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
688 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
689 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a "compress mailbox" button.
690
691 Combined Groups
692
693 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
694 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
695
696 Gnus Unplugged
697
698 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
699 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
700 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
701 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
702 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with IMAP.
703 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
704 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
705 * Example Setup:: An example @file{.gnus.el} file for offline people.
706 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
707 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
708
709 Agent Categories
710
711 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
712 * The Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
713 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
714
715 Agent Commands
716
717 * Group Agent Commands::
718 * Summary Agent Commands::
719 * Server Agent Commands::
720
721 Scoring
722
723 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
724 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
725 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
726 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
727 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
728 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
729 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
730 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
731 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
732 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
733 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
734 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
735 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
736 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
737 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
738 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
739
740 GroupLens
741
742 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
743 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
744 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
745 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
746
747 Advanced Scoring
748
749 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
750 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
751 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
752
753 Various
754
755 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
756 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
757 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
758 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
759 * Windows Configuration:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
760 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
761 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
762 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
763 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
764 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
765 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
766 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
767 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
768 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
769 * XEmacs Enhancements:: There are more pictures and stuff under XEmacs.
770 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
771 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
772 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
773
774 Formatting Variables
775
776 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
777 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
778 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
779 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
780 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
781
782 XEmacs Enhancements
783
784 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what your reading.
785 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
786 * Toolbar:: Click'n'drool.
787 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
788
789 Picons
790
791 * Picon Basics:: What are picons and How do I get them.
792 * Picon Requirements:: Don't go further if you aren't using XEmacs.
793 * Easy Picons:: Displaying Picons---the easy way.
794 * Hard Picons:: The way you should do it. You'll learn something.
795 * Picon Useless Configuration:: Other variables you can trash/tweak/munge/play with.
796
797 Appendices
798
799 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
800 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
801 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
802 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
803 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
804 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
805 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
806 * Frequently Asked Questions:: A question-and-answer session.
807
808 History
809
810 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
811 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
812 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
813 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
814 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
815 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
816 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
817 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
818 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
819
820 New Features
821
822 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
823 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
824 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
825 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
826 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
827
828 Customization
829
830 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
831 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
832 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
833 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
834
835 Gnus Reference Guide
836
837 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
838 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
839 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
840 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
841 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
842 * Group Info:: The group info format.
843 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
844 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
845 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
846
847 Back End Interface
848
849 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
850 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
851 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
852 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
853 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
854 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
855
856 Various File Formats
857
858 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
859 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
860
861 Emacs for Heathens
862
863 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
864 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
865
866 @end detailmenu
867 @end menu
868
869 @node Starting Up
870 @chapter Starting Gnus
871 @cindex starting up
872
873 @kindex M-x gnus
874 @findex gnus
875 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
876 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
877 your Emacs.
878
879 @findex gnus-other-frame
880 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
881 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
882 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
883
884 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
885 variables in your @file{~/.gnus} file. This file is similar to
886 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when gnus starts.
887
888 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
889 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
890
891 @menu
892 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
893 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
894 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
895 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
896 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
897 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
898 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
899 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
900 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
901 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
902 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
903 @end menu
904
905
906 @node Finding the News
907 @section Finding the News
908 @cindex finding news
909
910 @vindex gnus-select-method
911 @c @head
912 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
913 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
914 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
915 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
916 foreign groups.
917
918 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @sc{nntp} server is where
919 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
920
921 @lisp
922 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
923 @end lisp
924
925 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
926
927 @lisp
928 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
929 @end lisp
930
931 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
932 certainly be much faster.
933
934 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
935 @cindex NNTPSERVER
936 @cindex @sc{nntp} server
937 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
938 @code{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
939 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
940 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter. If
941 that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs as an @sc{nntp} server. That's a long shot, though.
942
943 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
944 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
945 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
946 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
947
948 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
949 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
950 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
951 @sc{nntp} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
952 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
953 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
954 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
955 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
956 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
957 server.)
958
959 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
960 @kindex B @r{(Group)}
961 However, if you use one @sc{nntp} server regularly and are just
962 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
963 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
964 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
965 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
966 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
967
968 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
969 @c @head
970 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
971 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
972 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
973 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
974 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
975 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
976 groups are.
977
978 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
979 you would typically set this variable to
980
981 @lisp
982 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
983 @end lisp
984
985
986 @node The First Time
987 @section The First Time
988 @cindex first time usage
989
990 If no startup files exist, Gnus will try to determine what groups should
991 be subscribed by default.
992
993 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
994 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
995 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
996 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
997 something useful.
998
999 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1000 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1001 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1002
1003 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1004 help you with most common problems.
1005
1006 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1007 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1008 special.
1009
1010
1011 @node The Server is Down
1012 @section The Server is Down
1013 @cindex server errors
1014
1015 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1016 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1017 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1018
1019 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1020 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1021 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1022 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1023 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1024 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1025 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1026
1027 @findex gnus-no-server
1028 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1029 @c @head
1030 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1031 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1032 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1033 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1034 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1035 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1036 levels.)
1037
1038
1039 @node Slave Gnusae
1040 @section Slave Gnusae
1041 @cindex slave
1042
1043 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1044 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1045 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1046 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1047
1048 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1049 @code{.newsrc} file.
1050
1051 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1052 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1053 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1054 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1055 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1056 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1057 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1058
1059 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1060 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1061 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1062 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1063 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1064 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1065 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1066 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1067
1068 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1069 information in the normal (i.e., master) @code{.newsrc} file.
1070
1071
1072 @node Fetching a Group
1073 @section Fetching a Group
1074 @cindex fetching a group
1075
1076 @findex gnus-fetch-group
1077 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
1078 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
1079 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
1080 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
1081 It takes the group name as a parameter.
1082
1083
1084 @node New Groups
1085 @section New Groups
1086 @cindex new groups
1087 @cindex subscription
1088
1089 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1090 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1091 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1092 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1093 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1094 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1095 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1096 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1097 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1098
1099 @menu
1100 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1101 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1102 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1103 @end menu
1104
1105
1106 @node Checking New Groups
1107 @subsection Checking New Groups
1108
1109 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1110 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1111 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1112 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1113 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1114 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1115 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1116 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1117 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1118 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1119
1120 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1121 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1122 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1123 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1124 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1125 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1126 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1127 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1128 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1129 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1130 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1131
1132 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1133 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1134 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1135 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1136 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1137 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1138
1139
1140 @node Subscription Methods
1141 @subsection Subscription Methods
1142
1143 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1144 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1145 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1146
1147 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1148 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1149
1150 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1151
1152 @table @code
1153
1154 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1155 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1156 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1157 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1158 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1159
1160 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1161 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1162 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1163 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1164
1165 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1166 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1167 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1168
1169 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1170 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1171 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1172 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1173 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1174 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1175 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1176 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1177 up. Or something like that.
1178
1179 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1180 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1181 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1182 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1183 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1184
1185 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1186 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1187 Kill all new groups.
1188
1189 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1190 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1191 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1192 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1193 topic parameter that looks like
1194
1195 @example
1196 "nnslashdot"
1197 @end example
1198
1199 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1200 that topic.
1201
1202 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1203 top-level topic.
1204
1205 @end table
1206
1207 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1208 A closely related variable is
1209 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1210 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1211 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1212 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1213 hierarchy or not.
1214
1215 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1216 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1217 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1218 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1219
1220
1221 @node Filtering New Groups
1222 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1223
1224 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1225 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1226 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1227
1228 @example
1229 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1230 @end example
1231
1232 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1233 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1234 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1235 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1236 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1237 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1238 subscribing these groups.
1239 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1240 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1241
1242 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1243 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1244 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1245 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1246 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1247 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1248 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1249 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1250
1251 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1252 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1253 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1254 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous, but I
1255 thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is more
1256 meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is used
1257 more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new groups
1258 that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1259 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, and @code{nnmh}) subscribed. If you
1260 don't like that, just set this variable to @code{nil}.
1261
1262 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1263 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1264
1265
1266 @node Changing Servers
1267 @section Changing Servers
1268 @cindex changing servers
1269
1270 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @sc{nntp} server to another.
1271 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1272 very flaky and you want to use another.
1273
1274 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1275 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1276
1277 @emph{Wrong!}
1278
1279 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1280 @sc{nntp} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1281 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1282 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1283 worthless.
1284
1285 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1286 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1287 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1288 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1289
1290 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1291 @findex gnus-change-server
1292 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1293 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1294 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1295 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1296 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1297
1298 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1299 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1300 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1301 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1302 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1303
1304 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1305 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1306 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1307 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1308 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1309 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1310
1311 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1312 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1313 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1314
1315
1316 @node Startup Files
1317 @section Startup Files
1318 @cindex startup files
1319 @cindex .newsrc
1320 @cindex .newsrc.el
1321 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1322
1323 Now, you all know about the @file{.newsrc} file. All subscription
1324 information is traditionally stored in this file.
1325
1326 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1327 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1328 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1329 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1330 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1331 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1332 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1333
1334 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1335 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1336 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1337 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1338 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1339 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1340
1341 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1342 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1343 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1344 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1345 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1346 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1347 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1348 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1349 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which is
1350 convenient if you have a tendency to use Netscape once in a while.
1351
1352 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1353 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1354 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1355 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1356 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1357 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1358 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1359 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1360 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1361 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1362 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1363 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1364
1365 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1366 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1367 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1368 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1369
1370 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1371 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1372 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1373 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1374 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1375 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1376 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1377 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1378 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1379 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1380
1381 @lisp
1382 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1383 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1384
1385 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1386 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1387 @end lisp
1388
1389 @vindex gnus-init-file
1390 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1391 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1392 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1393 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1394 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1395 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1396 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1397 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1398 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order).
1399
1400
1401
1402 @node Auto Save
1403 @section Auto Save
1404 @cindex dribble file
1405 @cindex auto-save
1406
1407 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1408 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1409 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1410 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1411 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1412 this file.
1413
1414 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1415 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1416 saved.
1417
1418 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1419 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1420 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1421
1422 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1423 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1424 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1425 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1426 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1427 file permissions as the @code{.newsrc} file.
1428
1429 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1430 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1431 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1432
1433
1434 @node The Active File
1435 @section The Active File
1436 @cindex active file
1437 @cindex ignored groups
1438
1439 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1440 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1441 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1442
1443 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1444 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1445 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1446 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1447 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1448 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1449 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1450
1451 @c This variable is
1452 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1453 @c if you set it to anything else.
1454
1455 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1456 @c @head
1457 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1458 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1459 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1460
1461 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1462 you actually subscribe to.
1463
1464 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1465 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1466 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1467 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1468
1469 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1470 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1471 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1472 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1473 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1474 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1475
1476 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1477 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1478 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1479 variable.
1480
1481 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1482 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1483 @sc{nntp} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1484 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1485 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1486 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1487
1488 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1489 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1490
1491 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1492 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1493
1494 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1495 secondary select methods.
1496
1497
1498 @node Startup Variables
1499 @section Startup Variables
1500
1501 @table @code
1502
1503 @item gnus-load-hook
1504 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1505 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1506 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1507 times you start Gnus.
1508
1509 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1510 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1511 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1512
1513 @item gnus-startup-hook
1514 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1515 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1516
1517 @item gnus-started-hook
1518 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1519 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1520 successfully.
1521
1522 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1523 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1524 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1525 generating the group buffer.
1526
1527 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1528 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1529 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1530 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1531 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1532 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1533 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1534 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1535
1536 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1537 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1538 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1539 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1540 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1541 @file{.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @code{.emacs} instead.
1542
1543 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1544 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1545 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1546
1547 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1548 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1549 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1550
1551 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1552 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1553 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1554 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1555
1556 @end table
1557
1558
1559 @node The Group Buffer
1560 @chapter The Group Buffer
1561 @cindex group buffer
1562
1563 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1564 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1565 long as Gnus is active.
1566
1567 @iftex
1568 @iflatex
1569 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1570 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=tmp/group.ps,height=9cm}}
1571 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1572 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1573 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1574 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1575 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1576 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1577 }
1578 @end iflatex
1579 @end iftex
1580
1581 @menu
1582 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1583 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1584 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1585 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1586 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1587 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1588 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1589 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1590 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1591 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1592 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1593 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1594 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1595 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1596 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1597 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1598 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1599 @end menu
1600
1601
1602 @node Group Buffer Format
1603 @section Group Buffer Format
1604
1605 @menu
1606 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1607 * Group Modeline Specification:: The group buffer modeline.
1608 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1609 @end menu
1610
1611
1612 @node Group Line Specification
1613 @subsection Group Line Specification
1614 @cindex group buffer format
1615
1616 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1617 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1618
1619 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1620
1621 @example
1622 25: news.announce.newusers
1623 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1624 @end example
1625
1626 Quite simple, huh?
1627
1628 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1629 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1630 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1631 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1632
1633 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1634 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1635 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1636 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1637 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1638 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1639
1640 @samp{%M%S%5y: %(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1641
1642 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1643 the colon after performing an operation. Nothing else is required---not
1644 even the group name. All displayed text is just window dressing, and is
1645 never examined by Gnus. Gnus stores all real information it needs using
1646 text properties.
1647
1648 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1649 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1650 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1651
1652 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1653
1654 @table @samp
1655
1656 @item M
1657 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1658
1659 @item S
1660 Whether the group is subscribed.
1661
1662 @item L
1663 Level of subscribedness.
1664
1665 @item N
1666 Number of unread articles.
1667
1668 @item I
1669 Number of dormant articles.
1670
1671 @item T
1672 Number of ticked articles.
1673
1674 @item R
1675 Number of read articles.
1676
1677 @item t
1678 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1679 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1680
1681 @item y
1682 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1683
1684 @item i
1685 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1686
1687 @item g
1688 Full group name.
1689
1690 @item G
1691 Group name.
1692
1693 @item D
1694 Newsgroup description.
1695
1696 @item o
1697 @samp{m} if moderated.
1698
1699 @item O
1700 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1701
1702 @item s
1703 Select method.
1704
1705 @item n
1706 Select from where.
1707
1708 @item z
1709 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1710 used.
1711
1712 @item P
1713 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1714
1715 @item c
1716 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1717 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1718 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1719 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1720 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1721
1722 @item m
1723 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1724 @cindex %
1725 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1726 the group lately.
1727
1728 @item p
1729 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1730
1731 @item d
1732 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1733 Timestamp}).
1734
1735 @item u
1736 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1737 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1738 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1739 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1740 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1741 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1742 specifier.
1743 @end table
1744
1745 @cindex *
1746 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1747 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1748 group, or a bogus native group.
1749
1750
1751 @node Group Modeline Specification
1752 @subsection Group Modeline Specification
1753 @cindex group modeline
1754
1755 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1756 The mode line can be changed by setting
1757 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1758 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1759
1760 @table @samp
1761 @item S
1762 The native news server.
1763 @item M
1764 The native select method.
1765 @end table
1766
1767
1768 @node Group Highlighting
1769 @subsection Group Highlighting
1770 @cindex highlighting
1771 @cindex group highlighting
1772
1773 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1774 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1775 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1776 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1777 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1778
1779 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1780 background is dark:
1781
1782 @lisp
1783 (cond (window-system
1784 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1785 (defface my-group-face-1
1786 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1787 (defface my-group-face-2
1788 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t))) "Second group face")
1789 (defface my-group-face-3
1790 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1791 (defface my-group-face-4
1792 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1793 (defface my-group-face-5
1794 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1795
1796 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1797 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1798 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1799 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1800 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1801 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1802 @end lisp
1803
1804 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1805
1806 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1807 include:
1808
1809 @table @code
1810 @item group
1811 The group name.
1812 @item unread
1813 The number of unread articles in the group.
1814 @item method
1815 The select method.
1816 @item mailp
1817 Whether the group is a mail group.
1818 @item level
1819 The level of the group.
1820 @item score
1821 The score of the group.
1822 @item ticked
1823 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1824 @item total
1825 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather, MAX-NUMBER minus
1826 MIN-NUMBER plus one.
1827 @item topic
1828 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1829 topic being inserted.
1830 @end table
1831
1832 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1833 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1834 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1835
1836 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1837 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1838 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1839 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1840 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1841
1842
1843 @node Group Maneuvering
1844 @section Group Maneuvering
1845 @cindex group movement
1846
1847 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1848 expected, hopefully.
1849
1850 @table @kbd
1851
1852 @item n
1853 @kindex n @r{(Group)}
1854 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1855 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1856 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1857
1858 @item p
1859 @itemx @key{DEL}
1860 @kindex @key{DEL} @r{(Group)}
1861 @kindex p @r{(Group)}
1862 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1863 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1864 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
1865
1866 @item N
1867 @kindex N @r{(Group)}
1868 @findex gnus-group-next-group
1869 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
1870
1871 @item P
1872 @kindex P @r{(Group)}
1873 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
1874 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
1875
1876 @item M-n
1877 @kindex M-n @r{(Group)}
1878 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
1879 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
1880 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
1881
1882 @item M-p
1883 @kindex M-p @r{(Group)}
1884 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
1885 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
1886 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
1887 @end table
1888
1889 Three commands for jumping to groups:
1890
1891 @table @kbd
1892
1893 @item j
1894 @kindex j @r{(Group)}
1895 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
1896 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
1897 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
1898 like living groups.
1899
1900 @item ,
1901 @kindex , @r{(Group)}
1902 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
1903 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
1904 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
1905
1906 @item .
1907 @kindex . @r{(Group)}
1908 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
1909 Jump to the first group with unread articles
1910 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
1911 @end table
1912
1913 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
1914 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
1915 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
1916 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
1917 is @code{t}.
1918
1919
1920 @node Selecting a Group
1921 @section Selecting a Group
1922 @cindex group selection
1923
1924 @table @kbd
1925
1926 @item @key{SPC}
1927 @kindex @key{SPC} @r{(Group)}
1928 @findex gnus-group-read-group
1929 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
1930 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
1931 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
1932 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
1933 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{N}, @var{N}
1934 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{N} is
1935 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{N} newest articles, if @var{N} is
1936 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{N})} oldest articles.
1937
1938 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
1939 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
1940 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
1941
1942 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
1943 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
1944 ones.
1945
1946 @item @key{RET}
1947 @kindex @key{RET} @r{(Group)}
1948
1949 @findex gnus-group-select-group
1950 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
1951 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
1952 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
1953 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
1954 entry.
1955
1956 @item M-@key{RET}
1957 @kindex M-@key{RET} @r{(Group)}
1958 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
1959 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
1960 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
1961 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
1962 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
1963 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
1964 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-@key{RET}}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
1965 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
1966 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
1967
1968 @item M-@key{SPC}
1969 @kindex M-@key{SPC} @r{(Group)}
1970 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
1971 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @key{RET}
1972 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
1973 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
1974
1975 @item C-M-@key{RET}
1976 @kindex C-M-@key{RET} @r{(Group)}
1977 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
1978 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
1979 doing any processing of its contents
1980 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
1981 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
1982 manner will have no permanent effects.
1983
1984 @end table
1985
1986 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
1987 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should consider
1988 to be a big group. This is 200 by default. If the group has more
1989 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
1990 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many articles
1991 should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a negative
1992 number (@code{-n}), the @code{n} oldest articles will be fetched. If it
1993 is positive, the @code{n} articles that have arrived most recently will
1994 be fetched.
1995
1996 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
1997 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
1998 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} control whether any articles are selected
1999 automatically when entering a group with the @key{SPC} command.
2000
2001 @table @code
2002
2003 @item nil
2004 Don't select any articles when entering the group. Just display the
2005 full summary buffer.
2006
2007 @item t
2008 Select the first unread article when entering the group.
2009
2010 @item best
2011 Select the highest scored article in the group when entering the
2012 group.
2013
2014 @end table
2015
2016 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2017 be called to place point on a subject line, and/or select some article.
2018 Useful functions include:
2019
2020 @table @code
2021 @item gnus-summary-first-unread-subject
2022 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article, but
2023 don't select the article.
2024
2025 @item gnus-summary-first-unread-article
2026 Select the first unread article.
2027
2028 @item gnus-summary-best-unread-article
2029 Select the highest-scored unread article.
2030 @end table
2031
2032
2033 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2034 binary group with Huge articles) you can set this variable to @code{nil}
2035 in @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2036 selected.
2037
2038
2039 @node Subscription Commands
2040 @section Subscription Commands
2041 @cindex subscription
2042
2043 @table @kbd
2044
2045 @item S t
2046 @itemx u
2047 @kindex S t @r{(Group)}
2048 @kindex u @r{(Group)}
2049 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2050 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2051 Toggle subscription to the current group
2052 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2053
2054 @item S s
2055 @itemx U
2056 @kindex S s @r{(Group)}
2057 @kindex U @r{(Group)}
2058 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2059 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2060 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2061 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2062
2063 @item S k
2064 @itemx C-k
2065 @kindex S k @r{(Group)}
2066 @kindex C-k @r{(Group)}
2067 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2068 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2069 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2070
2071 @item S y
2072 @itemx C-y
2073 @kindex S y @r{(Group)}
2074 @kindex C-y @r{(Group)}
2075 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2076 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2077
2078 @item C-x C-t
2079 @kindex C-x C-t @r{(Group)}
2080 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2081 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2082 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2083 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2084
2085 @item S w
2086 @itemx C-w
2087 @kindex S w @r{(Group)}
2088 @kindex C-w @r{(Group)}
2089 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2090 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2091
2092 @item S z
2093 @kindex S z @r{(Group)}
2094 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2095 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2096
2097 @item S C-k
2098 @kindex S C-k @r{(Group)}
2099 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2100 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2101 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2102 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2103 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2104 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2105 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2106 @file{.newsrc} file.
2107
2108 @end table
2109
2110 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2111
2112
2113 @node Group Data
2114 @section Group Data
2115
2116 @table @kbd
2117
2118 @item c
2119 @kindex c @r{(Group)}
2120 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2121 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2122 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2123 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2124 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2125 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2126 the group buffer.
2127
2128 @item C
2129 @kindex C @r{(Group)}
2130 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2131 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2132 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2133
2134 @item M-c
2135 @kindex M-c @r{(Group)}
2136 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2137 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2138 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2139
2140 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2141 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2142 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2143 If you have switched from one @sc{nntp} server to another, all your marks
2144 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2145 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2146 caution.
2147
2148 @end table
2149
2150
2151 @node Group Levels
2152 @section Group Levels
2153 @cindex group level
2154 @cindex level
2155
2156 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2157 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2158 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2159 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2160 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2161
2162 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2163
2164 @table @kbd
2165
2166 @item S l
2167 @kindex S l @r{(Group)}
2168 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2169 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2170 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2171 prompted for a level.
2172 @end table
2173
2174 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2175 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2176 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2177 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2178 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2179 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2180 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2181 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2182 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2183 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2184 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2185 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2186 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2187 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2188 reasons of efficiency.
2189
2190 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2191 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2192
2193 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2194 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2195 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2196 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2197 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2198 groups are hidden, in a way.
2199
2200 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2201 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2202 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2203 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2204 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2205 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2206
2207 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2208 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2209 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2210 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2211 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2212 list of killed groups.)
2213
2214 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2215 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2216 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2217
2218 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2219 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2220 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2221 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2222 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2223 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2224 relevant valid ranges.
2225
2226 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2227 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2228 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2229 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2230 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2231 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2232 rest.
2233
2234 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2235 one with the best level.
2236
2237 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2238 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2239 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2240 by default.
2241
2242 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2243 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2244 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2245 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2246 listed.
2247
2248 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2249 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2250 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2251 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2252
2253 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2254 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2255 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2256 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2257 to 5. The default is 6.
2258
2259
2260 @node Group Score
2261 @section Group Score
2262 @cindex group score
2263 @cindex group rank
2264 @cindex rank
2265
2266 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2267 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2268 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2269 reason?
2270
2271 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2272 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2273 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2274 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2275 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2276 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2277 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2278 least significant part.))
2279
2280 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2281 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2282 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2283 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2284 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2285 action after each summary exit, you can add
2286 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2287 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2288 slow things down somewhat.
2289
2290
2291 @node Marking Groups
2292 @section Marking Groups
2293 @cindex marking groups
2294
2295 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2296 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2297 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2298 bidding on those groups.
2299
2300 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2301 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2302 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2303
2304 @table @kbd
2305
2306 @item #
2307 @kindex # @r{(Group)}
2308 @itemx M m
2309 @kindex M m @r{(Group)}
2310 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2311 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2312
2313 @item M-#
2314 @kindex M-# @r{(Group)}
2315 @itemx M u
2316 @kindex M u @r{(Group)}
2317 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2318 Remove the mark from the current group
2319 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2320
2321 @item M U
2322 @kindex M U @r{(Group)}
2323 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2324 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2325
2326 @item M w
2327 @kindex M w @r{(Group)}
2328 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2329 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2330
2331 @item M b
2332 @kindex M b @r{(Group)}
2333 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2334 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2335
2336 @item M r
2337 @kindex M r @r{(Group)}
2338 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2339 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2340 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2341 @end table
2342
2343 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2344
2345 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2346 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2347 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2348 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2349 the command to be executed.
2350
2351
2352 @node Foreign Groups
2353 @section Foreign Groups
2354 @cindex foreign groups
2355
2356 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2357 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2358 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2359 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2360 consulted.
2361
2362 @table @kbd
2363
2364 @item G m
2365 @kindex G m @r{(Group)}
2366 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2367 @cindex making groups
2368 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2369 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2370 to subscribe to @sc{nntp} groups, @pxref{Browse Foreign Server}.
2371
2372 @item G r
2373 @kindex G r @r{(Group)}
2374 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2375 @cindex renaming groups
2376 Rename the current group to something else
2377 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2378 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2379 on some back ends.
2380
2381 @item G c
2382 @kindex G c @r{(Group)}
2383 @cindex customizing
2384 @findex gnus-group-customize
2385 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2386
2387 @item G e
2388 @kindex G e @r{(Group)}
2389 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2390 @cindex renaming groups
2391 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2392 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2393
2394 @item G p
2395 @kindex G p @r{(Group)}
2396 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2397 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2398 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2399
2400 @item G E
2401 @kindex G E @r{(Group)}
2402 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2403 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2404 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2405
2406 @item G d
2407 @kindex G d @r{(Group)}
2408 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2409 @cindex nndir
2410 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2411 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2412
2413 @item G h
2414 @kindex G h @r{(Group)}
2415 @cindex help group
2416 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2417 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2418
2419 @item G a
2420 @kindex G a @r{(Group)}
2421 @cindex (ding) archive
2422 @cindex archive group
2423 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2424 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2425 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2426 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2427 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2428 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2429 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2430
2431 @item G k
2432 @kindex G k @r{(Group)}
2433 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2434 @cindex nnkiboze
2435 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2436 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2437 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2438 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2439
2440 @item G D
2441 @kindex G D @r{(Group)}
2442 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2443 @cindex nneething
2444 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2445 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2446 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2447
2448 @item G f
2449 @kindex G f @r{(Group)}
2450 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2451 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2452 @cindex nndoc
2453 Make a group based on some file or other
2454 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2455 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2456 Currently supported types are @code{babyl}, @code{mbox}, @code{digest},
2457 @code{mmdf}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{clari-briefs},
2458 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{nsmail} and @code{forward}.
2459 If you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2460 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2461
2462 @item G u
2463 @kindex G u @r{(Group)}
2464 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2465 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2466 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2467 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2468
2469 @item G w
2470 @kindex G w @r{(Group)}
2471 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2472 @cindex DejaNews
2473 @cindex Alta Vista
2474 @cindex InReference
2475 @cindex nnweb
2476 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2477 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2478 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2479 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2480 include @code{dejanews}, @code{altavista} and @code{reference}.
2481 @xref{Web Searches}.
2482
2483 If you use the @code{dejanews} search engine, you can limit the search
2484 to a particular group by using a match string like
2485 @samp{~g alt.sysadmin.recovery shaving}.
2486
2487 @item G @key{DEL}
2488 @kindex G @key{DEL} @r{(Group)}
2489 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2490 This function will delete the current group
2491 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2492 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2493 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2494 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2495 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} group), though.
2496
2497 @item G V
2498 @kindex G V @r{(Group)}
2499 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2500 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2501 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2502
2503 @item G v
2504 @kindex G v @r{(Group)}
2505 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2506 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2507 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2508 @end table
2509
2510 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2511 methods.
2512
2513 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2514 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2515 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2516 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2517 groups from different @sc{nntp} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2518 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2519 newsgroups.
2520
2521
2522 @node Group Parameters
2523 @section Group Parameters
2524 @cindex group parameters
2525
2526 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2527 Here's an example group parameter list:
2528
2529 @example
2530 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2531 (auto-expire . t))
2532 @end example
2533
2534 We see that each element consists of a "dotted pair"---the thing before
2535 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2536 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2537 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2538
2539 The following group parameters can be used:
2540
2541 @table @code
2542 @item to-address
2543 @cindex to-address
2544 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2545
2546 @example
2547 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2548 @end example
2549
2550 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2551 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2552 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2553 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2554 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2555
2556 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2557 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2558 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2559 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2560 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2561 list address instead.
2562
2563 Some parameters have corresponding customizable variables, each of which
2564 is an alist of regexps and values.
2565
2566 @item to-list
2567 @cindex to-list
2568 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2569
2570 @example
2571 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2572 @end example
2573
2574 It is totally ignored
2575 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2576 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2577
2578 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2579 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2580 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2581 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2582 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2583
2584 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you don't have a
2585 @code{to-list} group parameter, one will be added automatically upon
2586 sending the message.
2587
2588 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2589
2590 @item visible
2591 @cindex visible
2592 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2593 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2594 of whether it has any unread articles.
2595
2596 @item broken-reply-to
2597 @cindex broken-reply-to
2598 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2599 headers in this group are to be ignored. This can be useful if you're
2600 reading a mailing list group where the listserv has inserted
2601 @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv itself. This is
2602 broken behavior. So there!
2603
2604 @item to-group
2605 @cindex to-group
2606 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2607 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2608
2609 @item newsgroup
2610 @cindex newsgroup
2611 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2612 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2613 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2614 news group.
2615
2616 @item gcc-self
2617 @cindex gcc-self
2618 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2619 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2620 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2621 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2622 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2623 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2624 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2625
2626 @item auto-expire
2627 @cindex auto-expire
2628 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2629 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2630 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2631
2632 @item total-expire
2633 @cindex total-expire
2634 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2635 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2636 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2637 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2638 expiry.
2639
2640 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2641
2642 @item expiry-wait
2643 @cindex expiry-wait
2644 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2645 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(expiry-wait
2646 . 10)}, this value will override any @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and
2647 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} when expiring expirable messages.
2648 The value can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or
2649 the symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2650
2651 @item score-file
2652 @cindex score file group parameter
2653 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2654 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2655 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2656
2657 @item adapt-file
2658 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2659 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2660 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2661 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2662
2663 @item admin-address
2664 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2665 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2666 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2667 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2668
2669 @item display
2670 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2671 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2672
2673 @table @code
2674 @item all
2675 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2676
2677 @item default
2678 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2679 ticked articles.
2680 @end table
2681
2682 @item comment
2683 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")}
2684 are arbitrary comments on the group. They are currently ignored by
2685 Gnus, but provide a place for you to store information on particular
2686 groups.
2687
2688 @item charset
2689 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2690 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2691 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2692
2693 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2694
2695 @item ignored-charsets
2696 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-known iso-8859-1)}
2697 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2698 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2699
2700 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2701
2702 @item posting-style
2703 You can store additional posting style information for this group only
2704 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2705 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2706 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2707 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2708
2709 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2710 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2711 like this in the group parameters:
2712
2713 @example
2714 (posting-style
2715 (name "Funky Name")
2716 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2717 @end example
2718
2719 @item banner
2720 An item like @code{(banner . "regex")} causes any part of an article
2721 that matches the regular expression "regex" to be stripped. Instead of
2722 "regex", you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2723 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2724 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2725
2726 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
2727 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
2728 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
2729 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
2730 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
2731 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
2732 @code{eval}ed there.
2733
2734 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function, if you like.
2735 If you want to hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put
2736 something like @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that
2737 group. @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the result of the
2738 @code{(ding)} form, but who cares?
2739
2740 @end table
2741
2742 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2743 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2744 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2745 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2746 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2747
2748
2749 @node Listing Groups
2750 @section Listing Groups
2751 @cindex group listing
2752
2753 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
2754
2755 @table @kbd
2756
2757 @item l
2758 @itemx A s
2759 @kindex A s @r{(Group)}
2760 @kindex l @r{(Group)}
2761 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
2762 List all groups that have unread articles
2763 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
2764 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
2765 only lists groups of level five (i. e.,
2766 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
2767 groups).
2768
2769 @item L
2770 @itemx A u
2771 @kindex A u @r{(Group)}
2772 @kindex L @r{(Group)}
2773 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
2774 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
2775 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
2776 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
2777 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
2778 unsubscribed groups).
2779
2780 @item A l
2781 @kindex A l @r{(Group)}
2782 @findex gnus-group-list-level
2783 List all unread groups on a specific level
2784 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
2785 with no unread articles.
2786
2787 @item A k
2788 @kindex A k @r{(Group)}
2789 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
2790 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
2791 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
2792 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
2793 from the server.
2794
2795 @item A z
2796 @kindex A z @r{(Group)}
2797 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
2798 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
2799
2800 @item A m
2801 @kindex A m @r{(Group)}
2802 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
2803 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
2804 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
2805
2806 @item A M
2807 @kindex A M @r{(Group)}
2808 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
2809 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
2810
2811 @item A A
2812 @kindex A A @r{(Group)}
2813 @findex gnus-group-list-active
2814 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
2815 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
2816 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
2817 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
2818 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
2819 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
2820 Take the output with some grains of salt.
2821
2822 @item A a
2823 @kindex A a @r{(Group)}
2824 @findex gnus-group-apropos
2825 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
2826 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
2827
2828 @item A d
2829 @kindex A d @r{(Group)}
2830 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
2831 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
2832 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
2833
2834 @item A c
2835 @kindex A c @r{(Group)}
2836 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
2837 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
2838
2839 @item A ?
2840 @kindex A ? @r{(Group)}
2841 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
2842 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
2843
2844 @end table
2845
2846 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
2847 @cindex visible group parameter
2848 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
2849 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
2850 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
2851 get the same effect.
2852
2853 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
2854 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
2855 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
2856 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
2857 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
2858
2859
2860 @node Sorting Groups
2861 @section Sorting Groups
2862 @cindex sorting groups
2863
2864 @kindex C-c C-s @r{(Group)}
2865 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
2866 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
2867 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
2868 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
2869 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
2870 include:
2871
2872 @table @code
2873
2874 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
2875 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
2876 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
2877
2878 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
2879 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
2880 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
2881
2882 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
2883 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
2884 Sort by group level.
2885
2886 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
2887 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
2888 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
2889
2890 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
2891 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
2892 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
2893 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
2894
2895 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
2896 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
2897 Sort by number of unread articles.
2898
2899 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
2900 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
2901 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
2902
2903
2904 @end table
2905
2906 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
2907 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
2908 the last one.
2909
2910
2911 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
2912 some sorting criteria:
2913
2914 @table @kbd
2915 @item G S a
2916 @kindex G S a @r{(Group)}
2917 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
2918 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
2919 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
2920
2921 @item G S u
2922 @kindex G S u @r{(Group)}
2923 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
2924 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
2925 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
2926
2927 @item G S l
2928 @kindex G S l @r{(Group)}
2929 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
2930 Sort the group buffer by group level
2931 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
2932
2933 @item G S v
2934 @kindex G S v @r{(Group)}
2935 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
2936 Sort the group buffer by group score
2937 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
2938
2939 @item G S r
2940 @kindex G S r @r{(Group)}
2941 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
2942 Sort the group buffer by group rank
2943 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
2944
2945 @item G S m
2946 @kindex G S m @r{(Group)}
2947 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
2948 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name
2949 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
2950
2951 @end table
2952
2953 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
2954 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
2955
2956 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
2957 commands will sort in reverse order.
2958
2959 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
2960
2961 @table @kbd
2962 @item G P a
2963 @kindex G P a @r{(Group)}
2964 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
2965 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
2966 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
2967
2968 @item G P u
2969 @kindex G P u @r{(Group)}
2970 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
2971 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
2972 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
2973
2974 @item G P l
2975 @kindex G P l @r{(Group)}
2976 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
2977 Sort the groups by group level
2978 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
2979
2980 @item G P v
2981 @kindex G P v @r{(Group)}
2982 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
2983 Sort the groups by group score
2984 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
2985
2986 @item G P r
2987 @kindex G P r @r{(Group)}
2988 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
2989 Sort the groups by group rank
2990 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
2991
2992 @item G P m
2993 @kindex G P m @r{(Group)}
2994 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
2995 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name
2996 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
2997
2998 @end table
2999
3000
3001
3002 @node Group Maintenance
3003 @section Group Maintenance
3004 @cindex bogus groups
3005
3006 @table @kbd
3007 @item b
3008 @kindex b @r{(Group)}
3009 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3010 Find bogus groups and delete them
3011 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3012
3013 @item F
3014 @kindex F @r{(Group)}
3015 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3016 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3017 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3018 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3019 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3020 zombies.
3021
3022 @item C-c C-x
3023 @kindex C-c C-x @r{(Group)}
3024 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3025 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3026 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}).
3027
3028 @item C-c C-M-x
3029 @kindex C-c C-M-x @r{(Group)}
3030 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3031 Run all articles in all groups through the expiry process
3032 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3033
3034 @end table
3035
3036
3037 @node Browse Foreign Server
3038 @section Browse Foreign Server
3039 @cindex foreign servers
3040 @cindex browsing servers
3041
3042 @table @kbd
3043 @item B
3044 @kindex B @r{(Group)}
3045 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3046 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3047 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3048 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3049 @end table
3050
3051 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3052 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3053 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3054 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3055
3056 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3057
3058 @table @kbd
3059 @item n
3060 @kindex n (Browse)
3061 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3062 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3063
3064 @item p
3065 @kindex p (Browse)
3066 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3067 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3068
3069 @item @key{SPC}
3070 @kindex @key{SPC} (Browse)
3071 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3072 Enter the current group and display the first article
3073 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3074
3075 @item @key{RET}
3076 @kindex @key{RET} (Browse)
3077 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3078 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3079
3080 @item u
3081 @kindex u (Browse)
3082 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3083 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3084 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3085
3086 @item l
3087 @itemx q
3088 @kindex q (Browse)
3089 @kindex l (Browse)
3090 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3091 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3092
3093 @item ?
3094 @kindex ? (Browse)
3095 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3096 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3097 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3098 @end table
3099
3100
3101 @node Exiting Gnus
3102 @section Exiting Gnus
3103 @cindex exiting Gnus
3104
3105 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3106
3107 @table @kbd
3108 @item z
3109 @kindex z @r{(Group)}
3110 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3111 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3112 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3113 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3114
3115 @item q
3116 @kindex q @r{(Group)}
3117 @findex gnus-group-exit
3118 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3119 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3120
3121 @item Q
3122 @kindex Q @r{(Group)}
3123 @findex gnus-group-quit
3124 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3125 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3126 @end table
3127
3128 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3129 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3130 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3131 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3132 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3133 exiting Gnus.
3134
3135 @findex gnus-unload
3136 @cindex unloading
3137 If you wish to completely unload Gnus and all its adherents, you can use
3138 the @code{gnus-unload} command. This command is also very handy when
3139 trying to customize meta-variables.
3140
3141 Note:
3142
3143 @quotation
3144 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3145 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3146 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3147 plastic chair.
3148 @end quotation
3149
3150
3151 @node Group Topics
3152 @section Group Topics
3153 @cindex topics
3154
3155 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3156 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3157 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3158 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3159 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3160 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3161
3162 @iftex
3163 @iflatex
3164 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3165 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=tmp/group-topic.ps,height=9cm}}
3166 }
3167 @end iflatex
3168 @end iftex
3169
3170 Here's an example:
3171
3172 @example
3173 Gnus
3174 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3175 3: comp.emacs
3176 2: alt.religion.emacs
3177 Naughty Emacs
3178 452: alt.sex.emacs
3179 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3180 Misc
3181 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3182 13: comp.sources.unix
3183 @end example
3184
3185 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3186 @kindex t @r{(Group)}
3187 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3188 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3189 is a toggling command.)
3190
3191 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3192 dum... Nice tune, that... la la la... What, you're back? Yes, and now
3193 press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed under
3194 @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy? Hot and
3195 bothered?
3196
3197 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3198 the hook for the group mode:
3199
3200 @lisp
3201 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3202 @end lisp
3203
3204 @menu
3205 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3206 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3207 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3208 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3209 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3210 @end menu
3211
3212
3213 @node Topic Variables
3214 @subsection Topic Variables
3215 @cindex topic variables
3216
3217 Now, if you select a topic, it will fold/unfold that topic, which is
3218 really neat, I think.
3219
3220 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3221 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3222 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3223 Valid elements are:
3224
3225 @table @samp
3226 @item i
3227 Indentation.
3228 @item n
3229 Topic name.
3230 @item v
3231 Visibility.
3232 @item l
3233 Level.
3234 @item g
3235 Number of groups in the topic.
3236 @item a
3237 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3238 @item A
3239 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3240 @end table
3241
3242 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3243 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3244 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3245 The default is 2.
3246
3247 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3248 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3249
3250 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3251 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3252 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3253
3254
3255 @node Topic Commands
3256 @subsection Topic Commands
3257 @cindex topic commands
3258
3259 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3260 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3261 definitions slightly.
3262
3263 @table @kbd
3264
3265 @item T n
3266 @kindex T n (Topic)
3267 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3268 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3269 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3270
3271 @item T m
3272 @kindex T m (Topic)
3273 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3274 Move the current group to some other topic
3275 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3276 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3277
3278 @item T j
3279 @kindex T j (Topic)
3280 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3281 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3282
3283 @item T c
3284 @kindex T c (Topic)
3285 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3286 Copy the current group to some other topic
3287 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3288 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3289
3290 @item T h
3291 @kindex T h (Topic)
3292 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3293 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3294 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3295
3296 @item T s
3297 @kindex T s (Topic)
3298 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3299 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3300 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3301
3302 @item T D
3303 @kindex T D (Topic)
3304 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3305 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3306 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3307 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3308 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3309 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3310 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3311 topic.
3312
3313 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3314 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3315
3316 @item T M
3317 @kindex T M (Topic)
3318 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3319 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3320 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3321
3322 @item T C
3323 @kindex T C (Topic)
3324 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3325 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3326 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3327
3328 @item T H
3329 @kindex T H (Topic)
3330 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3331 Toggle hiding empty topics
3332 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3333
3334 @item T #
3335 @kindex T # (Topic)
3336 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3337 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3338 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}).
3339
3340 @item T M-#
3341 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3342 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3343 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3344 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}).
3345
3346 @item T TAB
3347 @itemx TAB
3348 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3349 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3350 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3351 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3352 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3353 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3354
3355 @item M-TAB
3356 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3357 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3358 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3359 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3360
3361 @item @key{RET}
3362 @kindex @key{RET} (Topic)
3363 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3364 @itemx @key{SPC}
3365 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3366 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3367 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3368 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3369 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3370 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3371
3372 @item C-c C-x
3373 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3374 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3375 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the expiry
3376 process (if any) (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}).
3377
3378 @item C-k
3379 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3380 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3381 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3382 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3383
3384 @item C-y
3385 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3386 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3387 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3388 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3389 before all groups.
3390
3391 @item T r
3392 @kindex T r (Topic)
3393 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3394 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3395
3396 @item T @key{DEL}
3397 @kindex T @key{DEL} (Topic)
3398 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3399 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3400
3401 @item A T
3402 @kindex A T (Topic)
3403 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3404 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3405 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3406
3407 @item G p
3408 @kindex G p (Topic)
3409 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3410 @cindex group parameters
3411 @cindex topic parameters
3412 @cindex parameters
3413 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3414 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3415
3416 @end table
3417
3418
3419 @node Topic Sorting
3420 @subsection Topic Sorting
3421 @cindex topic sorting
3422
3423 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3424 commands:
3425
3426
3427 @table @kbd
3428 @item T S a
3429 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3430 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3431 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3432 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3433
3434 @item T S u
3435 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3436 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3437 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3438 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3439
3440 @item T S l
3441 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3442 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3443 Sort the current topic by group level
3444 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3445
3446 @item T S v
3447 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3448 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3449 Sort the current topic by group score
3450 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3451
3452 @item T S r
3453 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3454 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3455 Sort the current topic by group rank
3456 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3457
3458 @item T S m
3459 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3460 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3461 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3462 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3463
3464 @end table
3465
3466 @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group sorting.
3467
3468
3469 @node Topic Topology
3470 @subsection Topic Topology
3471 @cindex topic topology
3472 @cindex topology
3473
3474 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3475
3476 @example
3477 Gnus
3478 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3479 3: comp.emacs
3480 2: alt.religion.emacs
3481 Naughty Emacs
3482 452: alt.sex.emacs
3483 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3484 Misc
3485 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3486 13: comp.sources.unix
3487 @end example
3488
3489 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3490 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3491 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3492 follows:
3493
3494 @lisp
3495 (("Gnus" visible)
3496 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3497 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3498 (("Misc" visible)))
3499 @end lisp
3500
3501 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3502 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3503 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3504 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3505 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3506 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3507
3508 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3509 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3510 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3511
3512
3513 @node Topic Parameters
3514 @subsection Topic Parameters
3515 @cindex topic parameters
3516
3517 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent (and
3518 ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid topic
3519 parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
3520
3521 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
3522 parameters:
3523
3524 @table @code
3525 @item subscribe
3526 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
3527 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
3528 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
3529 topic.
3530
3531 @end table
3532
3533 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
3534 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
3535 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
3536 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
3537
3538 @example
3539 Gnus
3540 Emacs
3541 3: comp.emacs
3542 2: alt.religion.emacs
3543 452: alt.sex.emacs
3544 Relief
3545 452: alt.sex.emacs
3546 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3547 Misc
3548 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3549 13: comp.sources.unix
3550 452: alt.sex.emacs
3551 @end example
3552
3553 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
3554 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
3555 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
3556 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
3557 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
3558 . "religion.SCORE")}.
3559
3560 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
3561 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
3562 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
3563 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
3564 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
3565
3566 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
3567 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
3568 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
3569 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
3570 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
3571 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
3572 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
3573 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
3574
3575
3576 @node Misc Group Stuff
3577 @section Misc Group Stuff
3578
3579 @menu
3580 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
3581 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
3582 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
3583 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
3584 @end menu
3585
3586 @table @kbd
3587
3588 @item ^
3589 @kindex ^ @r{(Group)}
3590 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
3591 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
3592 @xref{The Server Buffer}.
3593
3594 @item a
3595 @kindex a @r{(Group)}
3596 @findex gnus-group-post-news
3597 Post an article to a group (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a
3598 prefix, the current group name will be used as the default.
3599
3600 @item m
3601 @kindex m @r{(Group)}
3602 @findex gnus-group-mail
3603 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}).
3604
3605 @end table
3606
3607 Variables for the group buffer:
3608
3609 @table @code
3610
3611 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
3612 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
3613 is called after the group buffer has been
3614 created.
3615
3616 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
3617 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
3618 is called after the group buffer is
3619 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
3620 unnatural way.
3621
3622 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
3623 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
3624 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
3625 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
3626
3627 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3628 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3629 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
3630 whether they are empty or not.
3631
3632 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
3633 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
3634 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
3635 non-ASCII group names.
3636
3637 For example:
3638 @lisp
3639 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
3640 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
3641 @end lisp
3642
3643 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
3644 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
3645 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
3646 It is used to show non-ASCII group names.
3647
3648 For example:
3649 @lisp
3650 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
3651 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
3652 @end lisp
3653
3654 @end table
3655
3656 @node Scanning New Messages
3657 @subsection Scanning New Messages
3658 @cindex new messages
3659 @cindex scanning new news
3660
3661 @table @kbd
3662
3663 @item g
3664 @kindex g @r{(Group)}
3665 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
3666 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
3667 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
3668 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
3669 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
3670 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
3671 back end(s).
3672
3673 @item M-g
3674 @kindex M-g @r{(Group)}
3675 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
3676 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
3677 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
3678 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
3679 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
3680 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
3681 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
3682
3683 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
3684 @cindex activating groups
3685 @item C-c M-g
3686 @kindex C-c M-g @r{(Group)}
3687 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
3688
3689 @item R
3690 @kindex R @r{(Group)}
3691 @cindex restarting
3692 @findex gnus-group-restart
3693 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
3694 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
3695 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
3696
3697 @end table
3698
3699 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
3700 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
3701
3702 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
3703 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
3704 news.
3705
3706
3707 @node Group Information
3708 @subsection Group Information
3709 @cindex group information
3710 @cindex information on groups
3711
3712 @table @kbd
3713
3714
3715 @item H f
3716 @kindex H f @r{(Group)}
3717 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
3718 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
3719 @cindex FAQ
3720 @cindex ange-ftp
3721 Try to fetch the FAQ for the current group
3722 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the FAQ from
3723 @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on a
3724 remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories. In
3725 that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
3726 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be used
3727 for fetching the file.
3728
3729 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
3730 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
3731
3732 @item H d
3733 @itemx C-c C-d
3734 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
3735 @kindex H d @r{(Group)}
3736 @kindex C-c C-d @r{(Group)}
3737 @cindex describing groups
3738 @cindex group description
3739 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
3740 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
3741 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
3742
3743 @item M-d
3744 @kindex M-d @r{(Group)}
3745 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
3746 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
3747 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
3748
3749 @item H v
3750 @itemx V
3751 @kindex V @r{(Group)}
3752 @kindex H v @r{(Group)}
3753 @cindex version
3754 @findex gnus-version
3755 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
3756
3757 @item ?
3758 @kindex ? @r{(Group)}
3759 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
3760 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
3761
3762 @item C-c C-i
3763 @kindex C-c C-i @r{(Group)}
3764 @cindex info
3765 @cindex manual
3766 @findex gnus-info-find-node
3767 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
3768 @end table
3769
3770
3771 @node Group Timestamp
3772 @subsection Group Timestamp
3773 @cindex timestamps
3774 @cindex group timestamps
3775
3776 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
3777 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
3778 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
3779
3780 @lisp
3781 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
3782 @end lisp
3783
3784 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
3785
3786 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
3787 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
3788
3789 @lisp
3790 (setq gnus-group-line-format
3791 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
3792 @end lisp
3793
3794 This will result in lines looking like:
3795
3796 @example
3797 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
3798 0: custom 19961002T012713
3799 @end example
3800
3801 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
3802 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
3803 something like:
3804
3805 @lisp
3806 (setq gnus-group-line-format
3807 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
3808 @end lisp
3809
3810
3811 @node File Commands
3812 @subsection File Commands
3813 @cindex file commands
3814
3815 @table @kbd
3816
3817 @item r
3818 @kindex r @r{(Group)}
3819 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
3820 @vindex gnus-init-file
3821 @cindex reading init file
3822 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
3823 @file{~/.gnus}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
3824
3825 @item s
3826 @kindex s @r{(Group)}
3827 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
3828 @cindex saving .newsrc
3829 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
3830 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
3831 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
3832
3833 @c @item Z
3834 @c @kindex Z @r{(Group)}
3835 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
3836 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
3837
3838 @end table
3839
3840
3841 @node The Summary Buffer
3842 @chapter The Summary Buffer
3843 @cindex summary buffer
3844
3845 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
3846 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
3847
3848 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
3849 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
3850
3851 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
3852
3853 @menu
3854 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
3855 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
3856 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
3857 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
3858 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
3859 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
3860 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
3861 * Threading:: How threads are made.
3862 * Sorting:: How articles and threads are sorted.
3863 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
3864 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
3865 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
3866 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
3867 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
3868 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
3869 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
3870 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
3871 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
3872 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
3873 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
3874 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
3875 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
3876 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
3877 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
3878 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
3879 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
3880 or reselecting the current group.
3881 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
3882 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
3883 @end menu
3884
3885
3886 @node Summary Buffer Format
3887 @section Summary Buffer Format
3888 @cindex summary buffer format
3889
3890 @iftex
3891 @iflatex
3892 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
3893 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary.ps,width=7.5cm}}
3894 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-article.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
3895 }
3896 @end iflatex
3897 @end iftex
3898
3899 @menu
3900 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
3901 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
3902 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
3903 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
3904 @end menu
3905
3906 @findex mail-extract-address-components
3907 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
3908 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
3909 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
3910 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
3911 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
3912 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
3913 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
3914 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
3915 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
3916 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
3917
3918 @lisp
3919 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
3920 'mail-extract-address-components)
3921 @end lisp
3922
3923 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
3924 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
3925 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
3926 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
3927
3928
3929 @node Summary Buffer Lines
3930 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
3931
3932 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
3933 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
3934 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
3935 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
3936 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3937
3938 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-20,20n%]%) %s\n}.
3939
3940 The following format specification characters are understood:
3941
3942 @table @samp
3943 @item N
3944 Article number.
3945 @item S
3946 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
3947 @code{gnus-list-identifies}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
3948 @item s
3949 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
3950 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
3951 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
3952 @item F
3953 Full @code{From} header.
3954 @item n
3955 The name (from the @code{From} header).
3956 @item f
3957 The name, code @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header
3958 (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
3959 @item a
3960 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
3961 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
3962 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
3963 may be more thorough.
3964 @item A
3965 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
3966 the @code{a} spec.
3967 @item L
3968 Number of lines in the article.
3969 @item c
3970 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported in some
3971 methods (like nnfolder).
3972 @item I
3973 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
3974 @item T
3975 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
3976 pushes everything after it off the screen).
3977 @item [
3978 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
3979 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
3980 @item ]
3981 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
3982 for adopted articles.
3983 @item >
3984 One space for each thread level.
3985 @item <
3986 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
3987 @item U
3988 Unread.
3989
3990 @item R
3991 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
3992 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
3993 or has been saved.
3994
3995 @item i
3996 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
3997 @item z
3998 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
3999 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4000 default level. If the difference between
4001 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4002 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4003 @item V
4004 Total thread score.
4005 @item x
4006 @code{Xref}.
4007 @item D
4008 @code{Date}.
4009 @item d
4010 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4011 @item o
4012 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4013 @item M
4014 @code{Message-ID}.
4015 @item r
4016 @code{References}.
4017 @item t
4018 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4019 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4020 @item e
4021 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4022 article has any children.
4023 @item P
4024 The line number.
4025 @item O
4026 Download mark.
4027 @item u
4028 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4029 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4030 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
4031 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4032 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4033 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4034 @end table
4035
4036 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4037 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4038 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4039 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4040 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4041 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4042
4043 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4044 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4045
4046 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4047
4048
4049 @node To From Newsgroups
4050 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4051 @cindex To
4052 @cindex Newsgroups
4053
4054 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4055 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4056 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4057 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4058 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4059
4060 @enumerate
4061 @item
4062 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4063 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4064 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4065 instance:
4066
4067 @lisp
4068 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4069 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4070 @end lisp
4071
4072 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4073 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4074
4075 @item
4076 @findex gnus-extra-header
4077 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4078 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4079 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4080
4081 @example
4082 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4083 @end example
4084
4085 @item
4086 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4087 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4088 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4089 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4090 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4091 headers are used instead.
4092
4093 @end enumerate
4094
4095 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4096 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4097 to include extra headers when generating overview (@sc{nov}) files. If
4098 you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after changing
4099 this variable.
4100
4101 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4102 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4103 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4104 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4105
4106 In summary, you'd typically do something like the following:
4107
4108 @lisp
4109 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4110 '(To Newsgroups))
4111 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4112 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4113 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-20,20f%]%) %s\n")
4114 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4115 "Your Name Here")
4116 @end lisp
4117
4118 Now, this is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4119 the @sc{nov} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4120 nntp admin to add:
4121
4122 @example
4123 Newsgroups:full
4124 @end example
4125
4126 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4127 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4128
4129
4130 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4131 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4132
4133 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4134 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4135 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4136 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4137
4138 Here are the elements you can play with:
4139
4140 @table @samp
4141 @item G
4142 Group name.
4143 @item p
4144 Unprefixed group name.
4145 @item A
4146 Current article number.
4147 @item z
4148 Current article score.
4149 @item V
4150 Gnus version.
4151 @item U
4152 Number of unread articles in this group.
4153 @item e
4154 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4155 summary buffer.
4156 @item Z
4157 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4158 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4159 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4160 and no unselected ones.
4161 @item g
4162 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4163 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4164 @item S
4165 Subject of the current article.
4166 @item u
4167 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4168 @item s
4169 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4170 @item d
4171 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4172 @item t
4173 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4174 @item r
4175 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4176 @item E
4177 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4178 @end table
4179
4180
4181 @node Summary Highlighting
4182 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4183
4184 @table @code
4185
4186 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4187 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4188 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4189 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4190 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4191
4192 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4193 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4194 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4195 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4196
4197 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4198 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4199 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4200 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4201
4202 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4203 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4204 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4205 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4206 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4207 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4208 to something like
4209 @lisp
4210 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4211 ((> score default) . bold))
4212 @end lisp
4213 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4214 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4215 @end table
4216
4217
4218 @node Summary Maneuvering
4219 @section Summary Maneuvering
4220 @cindex summary movement
4221
4222 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4223 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4224
4225 None of these commands select articles.
4226
4227 @table @kbd
4228 @item G M-n
4229 @itemx M-n
4230 @kindex M-n @r{(Summary)}
4231 @kindex G M-n @r{(Summary)}
4232 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4233 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4234 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4235
4236 @item G M-p
4237 @itemx M-p
4238 @kindex M-p @r{(Summary)}
4239 @kindex G M-p @r{(Summary)}
4240 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4241 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4242 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4243
4244 @item G g
4245 @kindex G g @r{(Summary)}
4246 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4247 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4248 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4249 @end table
4250
4251 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4252 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4253 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4254 to the group buffer.
4255
4256 Variables related to summary movement:
4257
4258 @table @code
4259
4260 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
4261 @item gnus-auto-select-next
4262 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
4263 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
4264 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
4265 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
4266 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
4267 next group, no matter whether it has any unread articles or not. As a
4268 special case, if this variable is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the
4269 next group without asking for confirmation. If this variable is
4270 @code{almost-quietly}, the same will happen only if you are located on
4271 the last article in the group. Finally, if this variable is
4272 @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n} command will go to the next group
4273 without confirmation. Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
4274
4275 @item gnus-auto-select-same
4276 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
4277 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
4278 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
4279 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
4280 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
4281 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
4282
4283 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
4284
4285 @item gnus-summary-check-current
4286 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
4287 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
4288 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
4289 Instead, they will choose the current article.
4290
4291 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
4292 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
4293 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
4294 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
4295 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
4296 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
4297 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
4298 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
4299 threads.
4300
4301 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
4302 the given number of lines from the top.
4303
4304 @end table
4305
4306
4307 @node Choosing Articles
4308 @section Choosing Articles
4309 @cindex selecting articles
4310
4311 @menu
4312 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
4313 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
4314 @end menu
4315
4316
4317 @node Choosing Commands
4318 @subsection Choosing Commands
4319
4320 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
4321 and they all select and display an article.
4322
4323 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
4324 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
4325
4326 @table @kbd
4327 @item @key{SPC}
4328 @kindex @key{SPC} @r{(Summary)}
4329 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4330 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
4331 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4332
4333 @item G n
4334 @itemx n
4335 @kindex n @r{(Summary)}
4336 @kindex G n @r{(Summary)}
4337 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
4338 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
4339 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
4340
4341 @item G p
4342 @itemx p
4343 @kindex p @r{(Summary)}
4344 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
4345 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
4346 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
4347
4348 @item G N
4349 @itemx N
4350 @kindex N @r{(Summary)}
4351 @kindex G N @r{(Summary)}
4352 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
4353 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
4354
4355 @item G P
4356 @itemx P
4357 @kindex P @r{(Summary)}
4358 @kindex G P @r{(Summary)}
4359 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
4360 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
4361
4362 @item G C-n
4363 @kindex G C-n @r{(Summary)}
4364 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
4365 Go to the next article with the same subject
4366 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
4367
4368 @item G C-p
4369 @kindex G C-p @r{(Summary)}
4370 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
4371 Go to the previous article with the same subject
4372 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
4373
4374 @item G f
4375 @itemx .
4376 @kindex G f @r{(Summary)}
4377 @kindex . @r{(Summary)}
4378 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
4379 Go to the first unread article
4380 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
4381
4382 @item G b
4383 @itemx ,
4384 @kindex G b @r{(Summary)}
4385 @kindex , @r{(Summary)}
4386 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
4387 Go to the article with the highest score
4388 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}).
4389
4390 @item G l
4391 @itemx l
4392 @kindex l @r{(Summary)}
4393 @kindex G l @r{(Summary)}
4394 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
4395 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
4396
4397 @item G o
4398 @kindex G o @r{(Summary)}
4399 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
4400 @cindex history
4401 @cindex article history
4402 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
4403 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
4404 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
4405 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
4406 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
4407 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
4408
4409 @item G j
4410 @itemx j
4411 @kindex j @r{(Summary)}
4412 @kindex G j @r{(Summary)}
4413 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
4414 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
4415 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
4416 @end table
4417
4418
4419 @node Choosing Variables
4420 @subsection Choosing Variables
4421
4422 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
4423
4424 @table @code
4425 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
4426 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
4427 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
4428 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
4429 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
4430 the server and display it in the article buffer.
4431
4432 @item gnus-select-article-hook
4433 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
4434 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. By default it
4435 exposes any threads hidden under the selected article.
4436
4437 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
4438 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
4439 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
4440 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
4441 @findex gnus-unread-mark
4442 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
4443 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
4444 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
4445 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-unread-mark}. The
4446 only articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
4447 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
4448 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
4449 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
4450 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
4451
4452 @end table
4453
4454
4455 @node Paging the Article
4456 @section Scrolling the Article
4457 @cindex article scrolling
4458
4459 @table @kbd
4460
4461 @item @key{SPC}
4462 @kindex @key{SPC} @r{(Summary)}
4463 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
4464 Pressing @key{SPC} will scroll the current article forward one page,
4465 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
4466 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
4467
4468 @item @key{DEL}
4469 @kindex @key{DEL} @r{(Summary)}
4470 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
4471 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
4472
4473 @item @key{RET}
4474 @kindex @key{RET} @r{(Summary)}
4475 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
4476 Scroll the current article one line forward
4477 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
4478
4479 @item M-@key{RET}
4480 @kindex M-@key{RET} @r{(Summary)}
4481 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
4482 Scroll the current article one line backward
4483 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
4484
4485 @item A g
4486 @itemx g
4487 @kindex A g @r{(Summary)}
4488 @kindex g @r{(Summary)}
4489 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
4490 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
4491 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
4492 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
4493 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
4494 the way it came from the server.
4495
4496 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
4497 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 @key{RET}} will decode the message as if it were
4498 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
4499
4500 @lisp
4501 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
4502 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
4503 (2 . big5)))
4504 @end lisp
4505
4506 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
4507
4508 @item A <
4509 @itemx <
4510 @kindex < @r{(Summary)}
4511 @kindex A < @r{(Summary)}
4512 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
4513 Scroll to the beginning of the article
4514 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
4515
4516 @item A >
4517 @itemx >
4518 @kindex > @r{(Summary)}
4519 @kindex A > @r{(Summary)}
4520 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
4521 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
4522
4523 @item A s
4524 @itemx s
4525 @kindex A s @r{(Summary)}
4526 @kindex s @r{(Summary)}
4527 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
4528 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
4529 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
4530
4531 @item h
4532 @kindex h @r{(Summary)}
4533 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
4534 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
4535
4536 @end table
4537
4538
4539 @node Reply Followup and Post
4540 @section Reply, Followup and Post
4541
4542 @menu
4543 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
4544 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
4545 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
4546 * Canceling and Superseding:: ``Whoops, I shouldn't have called him that.''
4547 @end menu
4548
4549
4550 @node Summary Mail Commands
4551 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
4552 @cindex mail
4553 @cindex composing mail
4554
4555 Commands for composing a mail message:
4556
4557 @table @kbd
4558
4559 @item S r
4560 @itemx r
4561 @kindex S r @r{(Summary)}
4562 @kindex r @r{(Summary)}
4563 @findex gnus-summary-reply
4564 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
4565 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
4566 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
4567 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
4568
4569 @item S R
4570 @itemx R
4571 @kindex R @r{(Summary)}
4572 @kindex S R @r{(Summary)}
4573 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
4574 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
4575 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
4576 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
4577 command uses the process/prefix convention.
4578
4579 @item S w
4580 @kindex S w @r{(Summary)}
4581 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
4582 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
4583 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
4584 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
4585 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers.
4586
4587 @item S W
4588 @kindex S W @r{(Summary)}
4589 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
4590 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
4591 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
4592 the process/prefix convention.
4593
4594 @item S o m
4595 @itemx C-c C-f
4596 @kindex S o m @r{(Summary)}
4597 @kindex C-c C-f @r{(Summary)}
4598 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
4599 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
4600 Forward the current article to some other person
4601 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
4602 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
4603 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
4604 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
4605 as an rfc822 MIME section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
4606 forward as an rfc822 MIME section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
4607 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
4608 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
4609 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 MIME section.
4610
4611 @item S m
4612 @itemx m
4613 @kindex m @r{(Summary)}
4614 @kindex S m @r{(Summary)}
4615 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
4616 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
4617 Send a mail to some other person
4618 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}).
4619
4620 @item S D b
4621 @kindex S D b @r{(Summary)}
4622 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
4623 @cindex bouncing mail
4624 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
4625 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
4626 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
4627 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
4628 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
4629 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
4630 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
4631 very well fail, though.
4632
4633 @item S D r
4634 @kindex S D r @r{(Summary)}
4635 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
4636 Not to be confused with the previous command,
4637 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
4638 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
4639 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
4640 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
4641 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
4642 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
4643 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
4644
4645 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
4646 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
4647 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
4648 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
4649 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muß sein!
4650
4651 This command understands the process/prefix convention
4652 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4653
4654 @item S O m
4655 @kindex S O m @r{(Summary)}
4656 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
4657 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
4658 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
4659 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4660
4661 @item S M-c
4662 @kindex S M-c @r{(Summary)}
4663 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
4664 @cindex crossposting
4665 @cindex excessive crossposting
4666 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
4667 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
4668
4669 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
4670 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
4671 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
4672 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
4673 command understands the process/prefix convention
4674 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
4675
4676 @end table
4677
4678 Also @pxref{(message)Header Commands} for more information.
4679
4680
4681 @node Summary Post Commands
4682 @subsection Summary Post Commands
4683 @cindex post
4684 @cindex composing news
4685
4686 Commands for posting a news article:
4687
4688 @table @kbd
4689 @item S p
4690 @itemx a
4691 @kindex a @r{(Summary)}
4692 @kindex S p @r{(Summary)}
4693 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
4694 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
4695 Post an article to the current group
4696 (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}).
4697
4698 @item S f
4699 @itemx f
4700 @kindex f @r{(Summary)}
4701 @kindex S f @r{(Summary)}
4702 @findex gnus-summary-followup
4703 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
4704 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
4705
4706 @item S F
4707 @itemx F
4708 @kindex S F @r{(Summary)}
4709 @kindex F @r{(Summary)}
4710 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
4711 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
4712 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
4713 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
4714 process/prefix convention.
4715
4716 @item S n
4717 @kindex S n @r{(Summary)}
4718 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
4719 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
4720 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
4721
4722 @item S N
4723 @kindex S N @r{(Summary)}
4724 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
4725 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
4726 message through mail and include the original message
4727 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
4728 the process/prefix convention.
4729
4730 @item S o p
4731 @kindex S o p @r{(Summary)}
4732 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
4733 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
4734 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
4735 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
4736 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
4737 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
4738 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
4739 as an rfc822 MIME section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
4740 forward as an rfc822 MIME section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
4741 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
4742 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
4743 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 MIME section.
4744
4745 @item S O p
4746 @kindex S O p @r{(Summary)}
4747 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
4748 @cindex digests
4749 @cindex making digests
4750 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
4751 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command uses the
4752 process/prefix convention.
4753
4754 @item S u
4755 @kindex S u @r{(Summary)}
4756 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
4757 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
4758 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
4759 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
4760 @end table
4761
4762 Also @pxref{(message)Header Commands} for more information.
4763
4764
4765 @node Summary Message Commands
4766 @subsection Summary Message Commands
4767
4768 @table @kbd
4769 @item S y
4770 @kindex S y @r{(Summary)}
4771 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
4772 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
4773 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
4774 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
4775 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4776
4777 @end table
4778
4779
4780 @node Canceling and Superseding
4781 @subsection Canceling Articles
4782 @cindex canceling articles
4783 @cindex superseding articles
4784
4785 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
4786 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
4787
4788 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
4789
4790 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
4791 @kindex C @r{(Summary)}
4792 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
4793 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
4794 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
4795 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
4796 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
4797 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
4798
4799 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
4800 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
4801 question.
4802
4803 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
4804 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
4805 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
4806
4807 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
4808 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
4809 your original article.
4810
4811 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
4812 @kindex S @r{(Summary)}
4813 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
4814 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
4815 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
4816 usual way.
4817
4818 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
4819 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
4820 have posted almost the same article twice.
4821
4822 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
4823 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
4824 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
4825 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
4826 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
4827 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
4828 header by substituting one of those words for the word
4829 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
4830 you would do normally. The previous article will be
4831 canceled/superseded.
4832
4833 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
4834
4835
4836 @node Marking Articles
4837 @section Marking Articles
4838 @cindex article marking
4839 @cindex article ticking
4840 @cindex marks
4841
4842 There are several marks you can set on an article.
4843
4844 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
4845 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
4846 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
4847
4848 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
4849
4850 @menu
4851 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
4852 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
4853 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
4854 @end menu
4855
4856 @ifinfo
4857 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks:
4858 @end ifinfo
4859
4860 @menu
4861 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
4862 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
4863 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
4864 @end menu
4865
4866
4867 @node Unread Articles
4868 @subsection Unread Articles
4869
4870 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
4871 other.
4872
4873 @table @samp
4874 @item !
4875 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
4876 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
4877
4878 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
4879 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
4880 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
4881 tick it. However, articles can be expired, so if you want to keep an
4882 article forever, you'll have to make it persistent (@pxref{Persistent
4883 Articles}).
4884
4885 @item ?
4886 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
4887 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
4888
4889 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
4890 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
4891 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
4892
4893 @item @key{SPC}
4894 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
4895 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
4896
4897 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
4898 @end table
4899
4900
4901 @node Read Articles
4902 @subsection Read Articles
4903 @cindex expirable mark
4904
4905 All the following marks mark articles as read.
4906
4907 @table @samp
4908
4909 @item r
4910 @vindex gnus-del-mark
4911 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
4912 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
4913
4914 @item R
4915 @vindex gnus-read-mark
4916 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
4917
4918 @item O
4919 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
4920 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
4921 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
4922
4923 @item K
4924 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
4925 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
4926
4927 @item X
4928 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
4929 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
4930
4931 @item Y
4932 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
4933 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
4934
4935 @item C
4936 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
4937 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
4938
4939 @item G
4940 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
4941 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
4942
4943 @item F
4944 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
4945 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
4946
4947 @item Q
4948 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
4949 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
4950 Threading}.
4951
4952 @item M
4953 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
4954 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
4955 (@code{gnus-duplicated-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
4956
4957 @end table
4958
4959 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
4960 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
4961
4962 One more special mark, though:
4963
4964 @table @samp
4965 @item E
4966 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
4967 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
4968
4969 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
4970 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
4971 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
4972 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
4973 any time.
4974 @end table
4975
4976
4977 @node Other Marks
4978 @subsection Other Marks
4979 @cindex process mark
4980 @cindex bookmarks
4981
4982 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
4983 read or not.
4984
4985 @itemize @bullet
4986
4987 @item
4988 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
4989 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
4990 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
4991 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
4992 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
4993
4994 @item
4995 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
4996 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
4997 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
4998 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
4999
5000 @item
5001 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5002 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5003 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5004
5005 @item
5006 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5007 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5008 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5009 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5010
5011 @item
5012 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5013 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5014 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5015 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5016 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5017
5018 @item
5019 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5020 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5021 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5022 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5023 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5024 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5025
5026 @end itemize
5027
5028 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5029 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5030 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5031
5032 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5033 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5034 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5035
5036
5037 @node Setting Marks
5038 @subsection Setting Marks
5039 @cindex setting marks
5040
5041 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
5042
5043 @table @kbd
5044 @item M c
5045 @itemx M-u
5046 @kindex M c @r{(Summary)}
5047 @kindex M-u @r{(Summary)}
5048 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
5049 @cindex mark as unread
5050 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
5051 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
5052 article as unread.
5053
5054 @item M t
5055 @itemx !
5056 @kindex ! @r{(Summary)}
5057 @kindex M t @r{(Summary)}
5058 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
5059 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
5060 @xref{Article Caching}.
5061
5062 @item M ?
5063 @itemx ?
5064 @kindex ? @r{(Summary)}
5065 @kindex M ? @r{(Summary)}
5066 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
5067 Mark the current article as dormant
5068 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5069
5070 @item M d
5071 @itemx d
5072 @kindex M d @r{(Summary)}
5073 @kindex d @r{(Summary)}
5074 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
5075 Mark the current article as read
5076 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
5077
5078 @item D
5079 @kindex D @r{(Summary)}
5080 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
5081 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
5082 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
5083
5084 @item M k
5085 @itemx k
5086 @kindex k @r{(Summary)}
5087 @kindex M k @r{(Summary)}
5088 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
5089 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
5090 and then select the next unread article
5091 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
5092
5093 @item M K
5094 @itemx C-k
5095 @kindex M K @r{(Summary)}
5096 @kindex C-k @r{(Summary)}
5097 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
5098 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
5099 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
5100
5101 @item M C
5102 @kindex M C @r{(Summary)}
5103 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
5104 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
5105 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
5106
5107 @item M C-c
5108 @kindex M C-c @r{(Summary)}
5109 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
5110 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
5111 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
5112
5113 @item M H
5114 @kindex M H @r{(Summary)}
5115 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
5116 Catchup the current group to point
5117 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
5118
5119 @item C-w
5120 @kindex C-w @r{(Summary)}
5121 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
5122 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
5123 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
5124
5125 @item M V k
5126 @kindex M V k @r{(Summary)}
5127 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
5128 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
5129 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
5130
5131 @item M e
5132 @itemx E
5133 @kindex M e @r{(Summary)}
5134 @kindex E @r{(Summary)}
5135 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
5136 Mark the current article as expirable
5137 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
5138
5139 @item M b
5140 @kindex M b @r{(Summary)}
5141 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
5142 Set a bookmark in the current article
5143 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
5144
5145 @item M B
5146 @kindex M B @r{(Summary)}
5147 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
5148 Remove the bookmark from the current article
5149 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
5150
5151 @item M V c
5152 @kindex M V c @r{(Summary)}
5153 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
5154 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
5155 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
5156
5157 @item M V u
5158 @kindex M V u @r{(Summary)}
5159 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
5160 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
5161 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
5162
5163 @item M V m
5164 @kindex M V m @r{(Summary)}
5165 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
5166 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
5167 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
5168 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
5169 @end table
5170
5171 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
5172 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
5173 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
5174 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
5175 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
5176 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
5177 @key{SPC}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
5178 The default is @code{t}.
5179
5180
5181 @node Generic Marking Commands
5182 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
5183
5184 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
5185 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
5186 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
5187 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
5188 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
5189 well.
5190
5191 Multiply these five behaviors by five different marking commands, and
5192 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
5193 command should do.
5194
5195 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
5196 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
5197 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
5198 to list in this manual.
5199
5200 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
5201 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
5202 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
5203 article, you could say something like:
5204
5205 @lisp
5206 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
5207 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
5208 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
5209 @end lisp
5210
5211 or
5212
5213 @lisp
5214 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
5215 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
5216 @end lisp
5217
5218
5219 @node Setting Process Marks
5220 @subsection Setting Process Marks
5221 @cindex setting process marks
5222
5223 @table @kbd
5224
5225 @item M P p
5226 @itemx #
5227 @kindex # @r{(Summary)}
5228 @kindex M P p @r{(Summary)}
5229 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
5230 Mark the current article with the process mark
5231 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
5232 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
5233
5234 @item M P u
5235 @itemx M-#
5236 @kindex M P u @r{(Summary)}
5237 @kindex M-# @r{(Summary)}
5238 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
5239 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
5240
5241 @item M P U
5242 @kindex M P U @r{(Summary)}
5243 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
5244 Remove the process mark from all articles
5245 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
5246
5247 @item M P i
5248 @kindex M P i @r{(Summary)}
5249 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
5250 Invert the list of process marked articles
5251 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
5252
5253 @item M P R
5254 @kindex M P R @r{(Summary)}
5255 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
5256 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
5257 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
5258
5259 @item M P G
5260 @kindex M P G @r{(Summary)}
5261 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
5262 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
5263 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
5264
5265 @item M P r
5266 @kindex M P r @r{(Summary)}
5267 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
5268 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
5269
5270 @item M P t
5271 @kindex M P t @r{(Summary)}
5272 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
5273 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
5274 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
5275
5276 @item M P T
5277 @kindex M P T @r{(Summary)}
5278 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
5279 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
5280 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
5281
5282 @item M P v
5283 @kindex M P v @r{(Summary)}
5284 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
5285 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
5286 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
5287
5288 @item M P s
5289 @kindex M P s @r{(Summary)}
5290 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
5291 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
5292
5293 @item M P S
5294 @kindex M P S @r{(Summary)}
5295 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
5296 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
5297 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
5298
5299 @item M P a
5300 @kindex M P a @r{(Summary)}
5301 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
5302 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
5303
5304 @item M P b
5305 @kindex M P b @r{(Summary)}
5306 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
5307 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
5308 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
5309
5310 @item M P k
5311 @kindex M P k @r{(Summary)}
5312 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
5313 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
5314 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
5315
5316 @item M P y
5317 @kindex M P y @r{(Summary)}
5318 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
5319 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
5320 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
5321
5322 @item M P w
5323 @kindex M P w @r{(Summary)}
5324 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
5325 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
5326 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
5327
5328 @end table
5329
5330 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @pxref{Searching for Articles} for how to
5331 set process marks based on article body contents.
5332
5333
5334 @node Limiting
5335 @section Limiting
5336 @cindex limiting
5337
5338 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
5339 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
5340 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
5341 buffer.
5342
5343 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
5344 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
5345 additional articles.
5346
5347 @table @kbd
5348
5349 @item / /
5350 @itemx / s
5351 @kindex / / @r{(Summary)}
5352 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
5353 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
5354 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}).
5355
5356 @item / a
5357 @kindex / a @r{(Summary)}
5358 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
5359 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
5360 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}).
5361
5362 @item / x
5363 @kindex / x @r{(Summary)}
5364 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
5365 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
5366 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
5367 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}).
5368
5369 @item / u
5370 @itemx x
5371 @kindex / u @r{(Summary)}
5372 @kindex x @r{(Summary)}
5373 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
5374 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
5375 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
5376 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
5377 dormant articles will also be excluded.
5378
5379 @item / m
5380 @kindex / m @r{(Summary)}
5381 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
5382 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
5383 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
5384
5385 @item / t
5386 @kindex / t @r{(Summary)}
5387 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
5388 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
5389 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
5390 articles younger than that number of days.
5391
5392 @item / n
5393 @kindex / n @r{(Summary)}
5394 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
5395 Limit the summary buffer to the current article
5396 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}). Uses the process/prefix
5397 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5398
5399 @item / w
5400 @kindex / w @r{(Summary)}
5401 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
5402 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
5403 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
5404 the stack.
5405
5406 @item / v
5407 @kindex / v @r{(Summary)}
5408 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
5409 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
5410 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
5411
5412 @item / E
5413 @itemx M S
5414 @kindex M S @r{(Summary)}
5415 @kindex / E @r{(Summary)}
5416 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
5417 Include all expunged articles in the limit
5418 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
5419
5420 @item / D
5421 @kindex / D @r{(Summary)}
5422 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
5423 Include all dormant articles in the limit
5424 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
5425
5426 @item / *
5427 @kindex / * @r{(Summary)}
5428 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
5429 Include all cached articles in the limit
5430 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
5431
5432 @item / d
5433 @kindex / d @r{(Summary)}
5434 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
5435 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
5436 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
5437
5438 @item / M
5439 @kindex / M @r{(Summary)}
5440 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
5441 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
5442
5443 @item / T
5444 @kindex / T @r{(Summary)}
5445 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
5446 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
5447
5448 @item / c
5449 @kindex / c @r{(Summary)}
5450 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
5451 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit
5452 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
5453
5454 @item / C
5455 @kindex / C @r{(Summary)}
5456 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
5457 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
5458 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
5459 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
5460
5461 @end table
5462
5463
5464 @node Threading
5465 @section Threading
5466 @cindex threading
5467 @cindex article threading
5468
5469 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
5470 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
5471 hierarchical fashion.
5472
5473 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
5474 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
5475 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
5476 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
5477 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
5478 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
5479 @pxref{Customizing Threading}.
5480
5481 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
5482
5483 @table @dfn
5484 @item root
5485 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
5486
5487 @item thread
5488 A tree-like article structure.
5489
5490 @item sub-thread
5491 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
5492
5493 @item loose threads
5494 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
5495 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
5496 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
5497 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
5498 called loose threads.
5499
5500 @item thread gathering
5501 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
5502
5503 @item sparse threads
5504 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
5505 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
5506
5507 @end table
5508
5509
5510 @menu
5511 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
5512 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
5513 @end menu
5514
5515
5516 @node Customizing Threading
5517 @subsection Customizing Threading
5518 @cindex customizing threading
5519
5520 @menu
5521 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
5522 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
5523 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
5524 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over... but you were wrong!
5525 @end menu
5526
5527
5528 @node Loose Threads
5529 @subsubsection Loose Threads
5530 @cindex <
5531 @cindex >
5532 @cindex loose threads
5533
5534 @table @code
5535 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
5536 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
5537 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
5538 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
5539 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
5540 read or killed the root in a previous session.
5541
5542 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
5543 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
5544 There are four possible values:
5545
5546 @iftex
5547 @iflatex
5548 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
5549 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-adopt.ps,width=7.5cm}}
5550 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-empty.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
5551 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-none.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
5552 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/summary-dummy.ps,width=7.5cm}}}
5553 }
5554 @end iflatex
5555 @end iftex
5556
5557 @cindex adopting articles
5558
5559 @table @code
5560
5561 @item adopt
5562 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
5563 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
5564 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
5565 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
5566
5567 @item dummy
5568 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
5569 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
5570 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
5571 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
5572 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
5573 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
5574 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
5575
5576 @item empty
5577 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
5578 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
5579 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
5580 Buffer Format}).)
5581
5582 @item none
5583 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
5584 display them after one another.
5585
5586 @item nil
5587 Don't gather loose threads.
5588 @end table
5589
5590 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
5591 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
5592 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
5593 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
5594 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
5595 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
5596 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
5597 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
5598 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
5599 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
5600 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
5601
5602 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
5603 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
5604 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
5605 Matching}).
5606
5607 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
5608 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
5609 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
5610 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
5611 simplification is used.
5612
5613 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
5614 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
5615 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
5616 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
5617
5618 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
5619 @lisp
5620 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
5621 (concat
5622 "\\`\\[?\\("
5623 (mapconcat
5624 'identity
5625 '("looking"
5626 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
5627 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
5628 "answer" "reference" "announce"
5629 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
5630 ;; ...
5631 )
5632 "\\|")
5633 "\\)\\s *\\("
5634 (mapconcat 'identity
5635 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
5636 "\\|")
5637 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
5638 @end lisp
5639
5640 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
5641 subjects.
5642
5643 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
5644 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
5645 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
5646 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
5647 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
5648 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
5649
5650 Useful functions to put in this list include:
5651
5652 @table @code
5653 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
5654 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
5655 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
5656
5657 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
5658 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
5659 Simplify fuzzily.
5660
5661 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
5662 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
5663 Remove excessive whitespace.
5664 @end table
5665
5666 You may also write your own functions, of course.
5667
5668
5669 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
5670 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
5671 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
5672 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
5673 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
5674 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
5675 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
5676 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
5677
5678 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
5679 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
5680 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
5681 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
5682 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
5683 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
5684 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
5685 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
5686 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
5687 cholera:
5688
5689 @table @code
5690 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
5691 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
5692 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
5693 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
5694
5695 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
5696 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
5697 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
5698 @end table
5699
5700 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
5701 something like:
5702
5703 @lisp
5704 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
5705 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
5706 @end lisp
5707
5708 @end table
5709
5710
5711 @node Filling In Threads
5712 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
5713
5714 @table @code
5715 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
5716 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
5717 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
5718 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you
5719 would like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still
5720 connect as many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable
5721 to @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than
5722 that number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case,
5723 fetching old headers only works if the back end you are using carries
5724 overview files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and
5725 @code{nnml}. Also remember that if the root of the thread has been
5726 expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can do about that.
5727
5728 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
5729 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
5730 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
5731
5732 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
5733 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
5734 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
5735 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
5736 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
5737 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
5738 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
5739 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
5740 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
5741 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
5742 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
5743 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
5744 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
5745 @code{nil} by default.
5746
5747 @end table
5748
5749
5750 @node More Threading
5751 @subsubsection More Threading
5752
5753 @table @code
5754 @item gnus-show-threads
5755 @vindex gnus-show-threads
5756 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
5757 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
5758 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
5759 slower and more awkward.
5760
5761 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
5762 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
5763 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
5764 generated.
5765
5766 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
5767 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
5768 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
5769 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
5770 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
5771 threads are expunged.
5772
5773 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
5774 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
5775 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
5776 will be hidden.
5777
5778 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
5779 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
5780 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
5781 this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subject change is ignored. If it
5782 is @code{nil}, which is the default, a change in the subject will result
5783 in a new thread.
5784
5785 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
5786 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
5787 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
5788 The default is 4.
5789
5790 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
5791 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
5792 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
5793 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
5794 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
5795 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
5796 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
5797 Setting this variable to an alternate value
5798 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
5799 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
5800 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
5801
5802 @end table
5803
5804
5805 @node Low-Level Threading
5806 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
5807
5808 @table @code
5809
5810 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
5811 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
5812 Hook run before parsing any headers.
5813
5814 @item gnus-alter-header-function
5815 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
5816 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
5817 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
5818 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
5819 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
5820 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
5821 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
5822 meaningful. Here's one example:
5823
5824 @lisp
5825 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
5826
5827 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
5828 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
5829 (when (string-match
5830 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
5831 (mail-header-set-id
5832 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
5833 header))))
5834 @end lisp
5835
5836 @end table
5837
5838
5839 @node Thread Commands
5840 @subsection Thread Commands
5841 @cindex thread commands
5842
5843 @table @kbd
5844
5845 @item T k
5846 @itemx C-M-k
5847 @kindex T k @r{(Summary)}
5848 @kindex C-M-k @r{(Summary)}
5849 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
5850 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
5851 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
5852 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
5853 articles instead.
5854
5855 @item T l
5856 @itemx C-M-l
5857 @kindex T l @r{(Summary)}
5858 @kindex C-M-l @r{(Summary)}
5859 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
5860 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
5861 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
5862
5863 @item T i
5864 @kindex T i @r{(Summary)}
5865 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
5866 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
5867 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
5868
5869 @item T #
5870 @kindex T # @r{(Summary)}
5871 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
5872 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
5873 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
5874
5875 @item T M-#
5876 @kindex T M-# @r{(Summary)}
5877 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
5878 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
5879 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
5880
5881 @item T T
5882 @kindex T T @r{(Summary)}
5883 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
5884 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
5885
5886 @item T s
5887 @kindex T s @r{(Summary)}
5888 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
5889 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any
5890 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
5891
5892 @item T h
5893 @kindex T h @r{(Summary)}
5894 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
5895 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
5896
5897 @item T S
5898 @kindex T S @r{(Summary)}
5899 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
5900 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
5901
5902 @item T H
5903 @kindex T H @r{(Summary)}
5904 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
5905 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
5906
5907 @item T t
5908 @kindex T t @r{(Summary)}
5909 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
5910 Re-thread the current article's thread
5911 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
5912 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
5913
5914 @item T ^
5915 @kindex T ^ @r{(Summary)}
5916 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
5917 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
5918 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
5919
5920 @end table
5921
5922 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
5923 understand the numeric prefix.
5924
5925 @table @kbd
5926
5927 @item T n
5928 @kindex T n @r{(Summary)}
5929 @itemx C-M-n
5930 @kindex C-M-n @r{(Summary)}
5931 @itemx M-down
5932 @kindex M-down @r{(Summary)}
5933 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
5934 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
5935
5936 @item T p
5937 @kindex T p @r{(Summary)}
5938 @itemx C-M-p
5939 @kindex C-M-p @r{(Summary)}
5940 @itemx M-up
5941 @kindex M-up @r{(Summary)}
5942 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
5943 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
5944
5945 @item T d
5946 @kindex T d @r{(Summary)}
5947 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
5948 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
5949
5950 @item T u
5951 @kindex T u @r{(Summary)}
5952 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
5953 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
5954
5955 @item T o
5956 @kindex T o @r{(Summary)}
5957 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
5958 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
5959 @end table
5960
5961 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
5962 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
5963 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
5964 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
5965 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
5966 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
5967 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
5968 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
5969 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
5970 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
5971 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
5972 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
5973 Matching}).
5974
5975
5976 @node Sorting
5977 @section Sorting
5978
5979 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
5980 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
5981 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
5982 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
5983 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
5984 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
5985 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
5986 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
5987 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
5988 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
5989 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
5990
5991 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
5992 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
5993 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
5994 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score}, and
5995 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
5996
5997 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
5998 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
5999 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
6000
6001 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
6002 last function in the list. You should probably always include
6003 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
6004 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
6005 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
6006 ascending article order.
6007
6008 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
6009 by number, you could do something like:
6010
6011 @lisp
6012 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
6013 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
6014 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
6015 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
6016 @end lisp
6017
6018 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
6019 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
6020 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
6021 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
6022 which the articles arrived.
6023
6024 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
6025 say something like:
6026
6027 @lisp
6028 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
6029 '((lambda (t1 t2)
6030 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
6031 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
6032 @end lisp
6033
6034 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
6035 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
6036 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
6037 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
6038 tickles your fancy.
6039
6040 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
6041 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
6042 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
6043 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
6044 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
6045 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
6046 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or other,
6047 you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions} variable.
6048 It is very similar to the @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that
6049 it uses slightly different functions for article comparison. Available
6050 sorting predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
6051 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject},
6052 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date}, and @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
6053
6054 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
6055 say something like:
6056
6057 @lisp
6058 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
6059 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
6060 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
6061 @end lisp
6062
6063
6064
6065 @node Asynchronous Fetching
6066 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
6067 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
6068 @cindex article pre-fetch
6069 @cindex pre-fetch
6070
6071 If you read your news from an @sc{nntp} server that's far away, the
6072 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
6073 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
6074 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
6075 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
6076
6077 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
6078 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
6079
6080 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
6081 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
6082 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
6083 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
6084 connection is blocked.
6085
6086 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
6087 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
6088 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
6089 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
6090
6091 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
6092 the link between your machine and the @sc{nntp} server will become more
6093 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
6094 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
6095 extra connection.
6096
6097 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing... unless
6098 you really want to.
6099
6100 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
6101 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
6102 happen automatically.
6103
6104 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
6105 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
6106 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
6107 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
6108 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
6109 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
6110 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
6111
6112 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
6113 @findex gnus-async-read-p
6114 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
6115 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p} variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This function should
6116 return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is to be
6117 pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-read-p}, which returns
6118 @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an article
6119 data structure as the only parameter.
6120
6121 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter than 100 lines, you could say something like:
6122
6123 @lisp
6124 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
6125 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
6126 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
6127 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
6128 100)))
6129
6130 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
6131 @end lisp
6132
6133 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
6134 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
6135 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
6136
6137 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
6138 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
6139 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
6140 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
6141
6142 @table @code
6143 @item read
6144 Remove articles when they are read.
6145
6146 @item exit
6147 Remove articles when exiting the group.
6148 @end table
6149
6150 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
6151
6152 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
6153 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
6154 @c from the next group.
6155
6156
6157 @node Article Caching
6158 @section Article Caching
6159 @cindex article caching
6160 @cindex caching
6161
6162 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @sc{nntp} connection, you may
6163 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
6164 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
6165 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
6166 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
6167
6168 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
6169
6170 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
6171 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
6172 @vindex gnus-use-cache
6173 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
6174 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
6175 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
6176 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
6177 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
6178
6179 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
6180 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
6181 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
6182 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
6183 as dormant, and don't worry.
6184
6185 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
6186
6187 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
6188 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
6189 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
6190 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
6191 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
6192 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
6193 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
6194 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
6195 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
6196 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
6197
6198 @findex gnus-jog-cache
6199 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
6200 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
6201 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
6202 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
6203 command if 1) your connection to the @sc{nntp} server is really, really,
6204 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
6205 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
6206 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
6207 not then be downloaded by this command.
6208
6209 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
6210 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
6211 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
6212 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
6213 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
6214 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
6215
6216 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
6217 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
6218 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
6219 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
6220 variables, the group is not cached.
6221
6222 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
6223 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
6224 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
6225 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
6226 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
6227 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
6228 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
6229 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @sc{nov}
6230 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
6231 file.
6232
6233
6234 @node Persistent Articles
6235 @section Persistent Articles
6236 @cindex persistent articles
6237
6238 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
6239 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
6240 useful in my opinion.
6241
6242 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
6243 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
6244 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
6245 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
6246 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
6247 the expiry going on at the news server.
6248
6249 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
6250 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
6251 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
6252
6253 @table @kbd
6254
6255 @item *
6256 @kindex * @r{(Summary)}
6257 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
6258 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
6259
6260 @item M-*
6261 @kindex M-* @r{(Summary)}
6262 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
6263 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
6264 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
6265 article.
6266 @end table
6267
6268 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
6269
6270 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
6271 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
6272 interested in persistent articles:
6273
6274 @lisp
6275 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
6276 @end lisp
6277
6278
6279 @node Article Backlog
6280 @section Article Backlog
6281 @cindex backlog
6282 @cindex article backlog
6283
6284 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
6285 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
6286 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
6287 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
6288 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
6289 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
6290 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
6291 increase memory usage some.
6292
6293 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
6294 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
6295 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
6296 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
6297 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
6298 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
6299 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
6300
6301 This variable is @code{nil} by default.
6302
6303
6304 @node Saving Articles
6305 @section Saving Articles
6306 @cindex saving articles
6307
6308 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
6309 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
6310 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
6311 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
6312 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
6313
6314 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
6315 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
6316 unwanted headers before saving the article.
6317
6318 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
6319 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
6320 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
6321 deleted before saving.
6322
6323 @table @kbd
6324
6325 @item O o
6326 @itemx o
6327 @kindex O o @r{(Summary)}
6328 @kindex o @r{(Summary)}
6329 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
6330 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
6331 Save the current article using the default article saver
6332 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
6333
6334 @item O m
6335 @kindex O m @r{(Summary)}
6336 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
6337 Save the current article in mail format
6338 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
6339
6340 @item O r
6341 @kindex O r @r{(Summary)}
6342 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
6343 Save the current article in rmail format
6344 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
6345
6346 @item O f
6347 @kindex O f @r{(Summary)}
6348 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
6349 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
6350 Save the current article in plain file format
6351 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
6352
6353 @item O F
6354 @kindex O F @r{(Summary)}
6355 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
6356 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
6357 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
6358
6359 @item O b
6360 @kindex O b @r{(Summary)}
6361 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
6362 Save the current article body in plain file format
6363 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
6364
6365 @item O h
6366 @kindex O h @r{(Summary)}
6367 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
6368 Save the current article in mh folder format
6369 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
6370
6371 @item O v
6372 @kindex O v @r{(Summary)}
6373 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
6374 Save the current article in a VM folder
6375 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
6376
6377 @item O p
6378 @kindex O p @r{(Summary)}
6379 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
6380 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
6381 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
6382 @end table
6383
6384 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
6385 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
6386 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
6387 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
6388 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
6389 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
6390 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
6391 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
6392 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
6393 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
6394 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
6395 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
6396 files.
6397
6398
6399 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
6400 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
6401 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the six ready-made
6402 functions below, or you can create your own.
6403
6404 @table @code
6405
6406 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
6407 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
6408 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
6409 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
6410 This is the default format, @dfn{babyl}. Uses the function in the
6411 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
6412 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
6413
6414 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
6415 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
6416 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
6417 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
6418 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
6419 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
6420
6421 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
6422 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
6423 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
6424 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
6425 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
6426 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
6427 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
6428
6429 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
6430 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
6431 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
6432 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
6433 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
6434
6435 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
6436 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
6437 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
6438 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
6439 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
6440 @cindex rcvstore
6441 @cindex MH folders
6442 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
6443 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
6444 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
6445 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
6446 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
6447
6448 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
6449 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
6450 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
6451 reader to use this setting.
6452 @end table
6453
6454 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
6455 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
6456 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
6457 @code{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
6458 default.
6459
6460 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
6461 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
6462 available functions that generate names:
6463
6464 @table @code
6465
6466 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
6467 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
6468 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
6469
6470 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
6471 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
6472 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
6473
6474 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
6475 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
6476 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
6477
6478 @item gnus-plain-save-name
6479 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
6480 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
6481 @end table
6482
6483 @vindex gnus-split-methods
6484 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
6485 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
6486 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
6487 related to VM in @code{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
6488 like:
6489
6490 @lisp
6491 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
6492 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
6493 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
6494 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
6495 @end lisp
6496
6497 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
6498 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
6499 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
6500 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
6501 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
6502 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
6503 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
6504 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
6505 called returns a string or a list of strings.
6506
6507 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
6508 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
6509 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
6510 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
6511
6512 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
6513 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
6514 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
6515 name.
6516
6517 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
6518 lots of mail groups called things like
6519 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
6520 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
6521 following will do just that:
6522
6523 @lisp
6524 (defun my-save-name (group)
6525 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
6526 (substring group (match-end 0))))
6527
6528 (setq gnus-split-methods
6529 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
6530 (my-save-name)))
6531 @end lisp
6532
6533
6534 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
6535 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
6536 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
6537 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
6538 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
6539 all the files in the top level directory
6540 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
6541 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
6542 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
6543 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
6544
6545 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
6546 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
6547 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
6548 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
6549 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
6550 for kill files.
6551
6552 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
6553 a spool, you could
6554
6555 @lisp
6556 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; to get a hierarchy
6557 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
6558 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; no encoding
6559 @end lisp
6560
6561 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
6562 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
6563 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
6564 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
6565
6566
6567 @node Decoding Articles
6568 @section Decoding Articles
6569 @cindex decoding articles
6570
6571 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
6572 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
6573
6574 @menu
6575 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
6576 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
6577 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
6578 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
6579 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
6580 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
6581 @end menu
6582
6583 @cindex series
6584 @cindex article series
6585 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
6586 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
6587 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
6588 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
6589 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
6590
6591 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
6592 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
6593 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
6594
6595 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
6596 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
6597 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
6598
6599 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
6600 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
6601 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
6602
6603
6604 @node Uuencoded Articles
6605 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
6606 @cindex uudecode
6607 @cindex uuencoded articles
6608
6609 @table @kbd
6610
6611 @item X u
6612 @kindex X u @r{(Summary)}
6613 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
6614 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
6615 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
6616
6617 @item X U
6618 @kindex X U @r{(Summary)}
6619 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
6620 Uudecodes and saves the current series
6621 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
6622
6623 @item X v u
6624 @kindex X v u @r{(Summary)}
6625 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
6626 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
6627
6628 @item X v U
6629 @kindex X v U @r{(Summary)}
6630 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
6631 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
6632 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
6633
6634 @end table
6635
6636 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
6637 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
6638 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
6639 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
6640 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
6641
6642 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
6643 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
6644 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
6645 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
6646 @kbd{X u}.
6647
6648 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
6649 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
6650 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
6651 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
6652 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
6653 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
6654 off.
6655
6656
6657 @node Shell Archives
6658 @subsection Shell Archives
6659 @cindex unshar
6660 @cindex shell archives
6661 @cindex shared articles
6662
6663 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
6664 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
6665 some commands to deal with these:
6666
6667 @table @kbd
6668
6669 @item X s
6670 @kindex X s @r{(Summary)}
6671 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
6672 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
6673
6674 @item X S
6675 @kindex X S @r{(Summary)}
6676 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
6677 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
6678
6679 @item X v s
6680 @kindex X v s @r{(Summary)}
6681 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
6682 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
6683
6684 @item X v S
6685 @kindex X v S @r{(Summary)}
6686 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
6687 Unshars, views and saves the current series
6688 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
6689 @end table
6690
6691
6692 @node PostScript Files
6693 @subsection PostScript Files
6694 @cindex PostScript
6695
6696 @table @kbd
6697
6698 @item X p
6699 @kindex X p @r{(Summary)}
6700 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
6701 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
6702
6703 @item X P
6704 @kindex X P @r{(Summary)}
6705 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
6706 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
6707 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
6708
6709 @item X v p
6710 @kindex X v p @r{(Summary)}
6711 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
6712 View the current PostScript series
6713 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
6714
6715 @item X v P
6716 @kindex X v P @r{(Summary)}
6717 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
6718 View and save the current PostScript series
6719 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
6720 @end table
6721
6722
6723 @node Other Files
6724 @subsection Other Files
6725
6726 @table @kbd
6727 @item X o
6728 @kindex X o @r{(Summary)}
6729 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
6730 Save the current series
6731 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
6732
6733 @item X b
6734 @kindex X b @r{(Summary)}
6735 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
6736 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
6737 doesn't really work yet.
6738 @end table
6739
6740
6741 @node Decoding Variables
6742 @subsection Decoding Variables
6743
6744 Adjective, not verb.
6745
6746 @menu
6747 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
6748 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
6749 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
6750 @end menu
6751
6752
6753 @node Rule Variables
6754 @subsubsection Rule Variables
6755 @cindex rule variables
6756
6757 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
6758 variables are of the form
6759
6760 @lisp
6761 (list '(regexp1 command2)
6762 '(regexp2 command2)
6763 ...)
6764 @end lisp
6765
6766 @table @code
6767
6768 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
6769 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
6770 @cindex sox
6771 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
6772 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @samp{.au} sound file, you could
6773 say something like:
6774 @lisp
6775 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
6776 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
6777 @end lisp
6778
6779 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
6780 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
6781 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
6782 user and default view rules.
6783
6784 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
6785 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
6786 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
6787 archives.
6788 @end table
6789
6790
6791 @node Other Decode Variables
6792 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
6793
6794 @table @code
6795 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
6796
6797 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
6798 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
6799 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
6800 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
6801 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
6802
6803 @table @code
6804
6805 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
6806 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
6807 View the file.
6808
6809 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
6810 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
6811 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
6812 @end table
6813
6814 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
6815 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
6816 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
6817 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
6818 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
6819 time.
6820
6821 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
6822 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
6823 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
6824
6825 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
6826 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
6827 Files with a @sc{mime} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
6828 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
6829 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @sc{mime} package (yet), so this is slightly
6830 kludgey.
6831
6832 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
6833 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
6834 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
6835
6836 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
6837 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
6838 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
6839 looking for files to display.
6840
6841 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
6842 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
6843 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
6844 after viewing it.
6845
6846 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
6847 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
6848 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
6849 rules.
6850
6851 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
6852 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
6853 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
6854 unpacking commands.
6855
6856 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
6857 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
6858 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
6859 from articles.
6860
6861 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
6862 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
6863 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
6864 decoded articles as unread.
6865
6866 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
6867 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
6868 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
6869 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
6870
6871 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
6872 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
6873 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
6874
6875 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
6876 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
6877 @cindex metamail
6878 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
6879 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @sc{mime}
6880 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
6881 @code{metamail} for viewing.
6882
6883 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
6884 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
6885 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
6886 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
6887 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
6888 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
6889 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
6890 simply dropped them.
6891
6892 @end table
6893
6894
6895 @node Uuencoding and Posting
6896 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
6897
6898 @table @code
6899
6900 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
6901 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
6902 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
6903 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
6904 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
6905 for you when you post the article.
6906
6907 @item gnus-uu-post-length
6908 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
6909 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
6910 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
6911
6912 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
6913 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
6914 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
6915 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
6916 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
6917 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
6918 think that counts...) Default is @code{nil}.
6919
6920 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
6921 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
6922 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
6923 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
6924 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
6925 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
6926 Default is @code{t}.
6927
6928 @end table
6929
6930
6931 @node Viewing Files
6932 @subsection Viewing Files
6933 @cindex viewing files
6934 @cindex pseudo-articles
6935
6936 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
6937 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
6938 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
6939 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
6940 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
6941 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
6942 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
6943
6944 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
6945 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
6946 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
6947 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
6948
6949 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
6950 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
6951 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
6952
6953 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
6954 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
6955 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
6956 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
6957 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
6958
6959 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
6960 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
6961 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
6962 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
6963 a list of parameters to that command.
6964
6965 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
6966 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
6967 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
6968
6969 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
6970 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
6971 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
6972
6973
6974 @node Article Treatment
6975 @section Article Treatment
6976
6977 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
6978 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
6979 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
6980 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
6981 these articles easier.
6982
6983 @menu
6984 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
6985 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
6986 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
6987 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
6988 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
6989 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
6990 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
6991 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
6992 @end menu
6993
6994
6995 @node Article Highlighting
6996 @subsection Article Highlighting
6997 @cindex highlighting
6998
6999 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
7000 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
7001
7002 @table @kbd
7003
7004 @item W H a
7005 @kindex W H a @r{(Summary)}
7006 @findex gnus-article-highlight
7007 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
7008 Do much highlighting of the current article
7009 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
7010 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
7011
7012 @item W H h
7013 @kindex W H h @r{(Summary)}
7014 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
7015 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
7016 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
7017 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
7018 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
7019 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
7020 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
7021 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
7022 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
7023 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
7024 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
7025
7026 @item W H c
7027 @kindex W H c @r{(Summary)}
7028 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
7029 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
7030
7031 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
7032
7033 @table @code
7034 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
7035
7036 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
7037 If the article size if bigger than this variable (which is 25000 by
7038 default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
7039
7040 @item gnus-cite-prefix-regexp
7041 @vindex gnus-cite-prefix-regexp
7042 Regexp matching the longest possible citation prefix on a line.
7043
7044 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
7045 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
7046 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
7047
7048 @item gnus-cite-face-list
7049 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
7050 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
7051 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
7052 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
7053 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
7054
7055 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
7056 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
7057 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
7058
7059 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
7060 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
7061 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
7062
7063 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
7064 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
7065 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
7066 that it's a citation.
7067
7068 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
7069 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
7070 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
7071
7072 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
7073 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
7074 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
7075
7076 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
7077 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
7078 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
7079 cited text belonging to the attribution.
7080
7081 @end table
7082
7083
7084 @item W H s
7085 @kindex W H s @r{(Summary)}
7086 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
7087 @vindex gnus-signature-face
7088 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
7089 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
7090 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
7091 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
7092 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
7093 default.
7094
7095 @end table
7096
7097 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
7098
7099
7100 @node Article Fontisizing
7101 @subsection Article Fontisizing
7102 @cindex emphasis
7103 @cindex article emphasis
7104
7105 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
7106 @kindex W e @r{(Summary)}
7107 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
7108 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
7109 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
7110 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
7111
7112 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
7113 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
7114 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
7115 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
7116 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
7117 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
7118 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
7119 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
7120 highlighting.
7121
7122 @lisp
7123 (setq gnus-article-emphasis
7124 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
7125 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
7126 @end lisp
7127
7128 @cindex slash
7129 @cindex asterisk
7130 @cindex underline
7131 @cindex /
7132 @cindex *
7133
7134 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
7135 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
7136 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
7137 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
7138 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
7139 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
7140 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
7141 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
7142 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
7143 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
7144 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
7145 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
7146 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
7147
7148 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
7149 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
7150 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
7151 say something like:
7152
7153 @lisp
7154 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
7155 @end lisp
7156
7157 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
7158
7159 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
7160 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
7161 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
7162 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
7163
7164 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
7165
7166
7167 @node Article Hiding
7168 @subsection Article Hiding
7169 @cindex article hiding
7170
7171 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
7172 too much cruft in most articles.
7173
7174 @table @kbd
7175
7176 @item W W a
7177 @kindex W W a @r{(Summary)}
7178 @findex gnus-article-hide
7179 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
7180 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
7181 headers, PGP, cited text and the signature.
7182
7183 @item W W h
7184 @kindex W W h @r{(Summary)}
7185 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
7186 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
7187 Headers}.
7188
7189 @item W W b
7190 @kindex W W b @r{(Summary)}
7191 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
7192 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
7193 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
7194
7195 @item W W s
7196 @kindex W W s @r{(Summary)}
7197 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
7198 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
7199 Signature}.
7200
7201 @item W W l
7202 @kindex W W l @r{(Summary)}
7203 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
7204 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
7205 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
7206 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
7207 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
7208 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
7209 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
7210
7211 @table @code
7212
7213 @item gnus-list-identifiers
7214 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
7215 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
7216 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
7217
7218 @end table
7219
7220 @item W W p
7221 @kindex W W p @r{(Summary)}
7222 @findex gnus-article-hide-pgp
7223 @vindex gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook
7224 Hide @sc{pgp} signatures (@code{gnus-article-hide-pgp}). The
7225 @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook} hook will be run after a @sc{pgp}
7226 signature has been hidden. For example, to automatically verify
7227 articles that have signatures in them do:
7228 @lisp
7229 ;;; Hide pgp cruft if any.
7230
7231 (setq gnus-treat-strip-pgp t)
7232
7233 ;;; After hiding pgp, verify the message;
7234 ;;; only happens if pgp signature is found.
7235
7236 (add-hook 'gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook
7237 (lambda ()
7238 (save-excursion
7239 (set-buffer gnus-original-article-buffer)
7240 (mc-verify))))
7241 @end lisp
7242
7243 @item W W P
7244 @kindex W W P @r{(Summary)}
7245 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
7246 Hide @sc{pem} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
7247 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
7248
7249 @item W W B
7250 @kindex W W B @r{(Summary)}
7251 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
7252 @cindex banner
7253 @cindex OneList
7254 @cindex stripping advertisements
7255 @cindex advertisements
7256 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
7257 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
7258 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
7259 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
7260 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
7261 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
7262 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
7263 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
7264 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
7265 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
7266 used.
7267
7268 @item W W c
7269 @kindex W W c @r{(Summary)}
7270 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
7271 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
7272 customizing the hiding:
7273
7274 @table @code
7275
7276 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
7277 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
7278 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
7279 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
7280 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
7281 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
7282 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
7283 specs are valid:
7284
7285 @table @samp
7286 @item b
7287 Starting point of the hidden text.
7288 @item e
7289 Ending point of the hidden text.
7290 @item l
7291 Number of characters in the hidden region.
7292 @item n
7293 Number of lines of hidden text.
7294 @end table
7295
7296 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
7297 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
7298 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
7299 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
7300 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
7301
7302 @end table
7303
7304 @item W W C-c
7305 @kindex W W C-c @r{(Summary)}
7306 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
7307
7308 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
7309 following two variables:
7310
7311 @table @code
7312 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
7313 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
7314 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
7315 50), hide the cited text.
7316
7317 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
7318 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
7319 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
7320 is hidden.
7321 @end table
7322
7323 @item W W C
7324 @kindex W W C @r{(Summary)}
7325 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
7326 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
7327 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
7328 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
7329 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
7330
7331 @end table
7332
7333 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
7334 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
7335 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
7336
7337 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
7338 citation customization.
7339
7340 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
7341 automatically.
7342
7343
7344 @node Article Washing
7345 @subsection Article Washing
7346 @cindex washing
7347 @cindex article washing
7348
7349 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
7350 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
7351
7352 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
7353 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
7354 Cleaner, perhaps.
7355
7356 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
7357 articles by default.
7358
7359 @table @kbd
7360
7361 @item C-u g
7362 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
7363 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
7364 the server.
7365
7366 @item W l
7367 @kindex W l @r{(Summary)}
7368 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
7369 Remove page breaks from the current article
7370 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
7371 delimiters.
7372
7373 @item W r
7374 @kindex W r @r{(Summary)}
7375 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
7376 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
7377 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
7378 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
7379 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
7380 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
7381
7382 It's commonly called @dfn{rot13} because each letter is rotated 13
7383 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
7384 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
7385 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
7386
7387 @item W t
7388 @item t
7389 @kindex W t @r{(Summary)}
7390 @kindex t @r{(Summary)}
7391 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
7392 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
7393 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
7394
7395 @item W v
7396 @kindex W v @r{(Summary)}
7397 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-header
7398 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
7399 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-header}).
7400
7401 @item W o
7402 @kindex W o @r{(Summary)}
7403 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
7404 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
7405
7406 @item W d
7407 @kindex W d @r{(Summary)}
7408 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
7409 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
7410 @cindex Smartquotes
7411 @cindex M******** sm*rtq**t*s
7412 @cindex Latin 1
7413 Treat M******** sm*rtq**t*s according to
7414 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
7415 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
7416 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
7417 interactively.
7418
7419 In reality, this function is translates a subset of the subset of the
7420 @code{cp1252} (or @code{Windows-1252}) character set that isn't in ISO
7421 Latin-1, including the quote characters @code{\222} and @code{\264}.
7422 Messages in this character set often have a MIME header saying that
7423 they are Latin-1.
7424
7425 @item W w
7426 @kindex W w @r{(Summary)}
7427 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
7428 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
7429
7430 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
7431 when filling.
7432
7433 @item W Q
7434 @kindex W Q @r{(Summary)}
7435 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
7436 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
7437
7438 @item W C
7439 @kindex W C @r{(Summary)}
7440 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
7441 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
7442 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
7443
7444 @item W c
7445 @kindex W c @r{(Summary)}
7446 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
7447 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
7448 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
7449 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
7450 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
7451
7452 @item W q
7453 @kindex W q @r{(Summary)}
7454 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
7455 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
7456 Quoted-Printable is one common @sc{mime} encoding employed when sending
7457 non-ASCII (i. e., 8-bit) articles. It typically makes strings like
7458 @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which doesn't look very
7459 readable to me. Note that the this is usually done automatically by
7460 Gnus if the message in question has a @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding}
7461 header that says that this encoding has been done.
7462
7463 @item W 6
7464 @kindex W 6 @r{(Summary)}
7465 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
7466 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}).
7467 Base64 is one common @sc{mime} encoding employed when sending non-ASCII
7468 (i. e., 8-bit) articles. Note that the this is usually done
7469 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
7470 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding has
7471 been done.
7472
7473 @item W Z
7474 @kindex W Z @r{(Summary)}
7475 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
7476 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
7477 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
7478 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
7479
7480 @item W h
7481 @kindex W h @r{(Summary)}
7482 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
7483 Treat HTML (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}).
7484 Note that the this is usually done automatically by Gnus if the message
7485 in question has a @code{Content-Type} header that says that this type
7486 has been done.
7487
7488 @item W f
7489 @kindex W f @r{(Summary)}
7490 @cindex x-face
7491 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
7492 @findex gnus-article-x-face-command
7493 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
7494 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
7495 @iftex
7496 @iflatex
7497 \include{xface}
7498 @end iflatex
7499 @end iftex
7500 @anchor{X-Face}
7501 Look for and display any X-Face headers
7502 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}). The command executed by this
7503 function is given by the @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} variable.
7504 If this variable is a string, this string will be executed in a
7505 sub-shell. If it is a function, this function will be called with the
7506 face as the argument. If the @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which
7507 is a regexp) matches the @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
7508 The default action under Emacs is to fork off the @code{display}
7509 program@footnote{@code{display} is from the ImageMagick package. For the
7510 @code{uncompface} and @code{icontopbm} programs look for a package
7511 like `compface' or `faces-xface' on a GNU/Linux system.}
7512 to view the face. Under XEmacs or Emacs 21+ with suitable image
7513 support, the default action is to display the face before the
7514 @code{From} header. (It's nicer if XEmacs has been compiled with X-Face
7515 support---that will make display somewhat faster. If there's no native
7516 X-Face support, Gnus will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using
7517 external programs from the @code{pbmplus} package and
7518 friends.@footnote{On a GNU/Linux system look for packages with names
7519 like @code{netpbm} or @code{libgr-progs}.}) If you
7520 want to have this function in the display hook, it should probably come
7521 last.
7522
7523 @item W b
7524 @kindex W b @r{(Summary)}
7525 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
7526 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
7527 @xref{Article Buttons}.
7528
7529 @item W B
7530 @kindex W B @r{(Summary)}
7531 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
7532 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
7533 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
7534
7535 @item W W H
7536 @kindex W W H @r{(Summary)}
7537 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-from-body
7538 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
7539 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-from-body}).
7540
7541 @item W E l
7542 @kindex W E l @r{(Summary)}
7543 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
7544 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
7545 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
7546
7547 @item W E m
7548 @kindex W E m @r{(Summary)}
7549 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
7550 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
7551 lines with a single empty line.
7552 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
7553
7554 @item W E t
7555 @kindex W E t @r{(Summary)}
7556 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
7557 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
7558 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
7559
7560 @item W E a
7561 @kindex W E a @r{(Summary)}
7562 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
7563 Do all the three commands above
7564 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
7565
7566 @item W E A
7567 @kindex W E A @r{(Summary)}
7568 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
7569 Remove all blank lines
7570 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
7571
7572 @item W E s
7573 @kindex W E s @r{(Summary)}
7574 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
7575 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
7576 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
7577
7578 @item W E e
7579 @kindex W E e @r{(Summary)}
7580 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
7581 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
7582 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
7583
7584 @end table
7585
7586 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
7587
7588
7589 @node Article Buttons
7590 @subsection Article Buttons
7591 @cindex buttons
7592
7593 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
7594 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
7595 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @key{RET} or use the middle mouse
7596 button on these references.
7597
7598 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
7599 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses and Message-IDs. This is controlled by
7600 two variables, one that handles article bodies and one that handles
7601 article heads:
7602
7603 @table @code
7604
7605 @item gnus-button-alist
7606 @vindex gnus-button-alist
7607 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
7608
7609 @lisp
7610 (REGEXP BUTTON-PAR USE-P FUNCTION DATA-PAR)
7611 @end lisp
7612
7613 @table @var
7614
7615 @item regexp
7616 All text that match this regular expression will be considered an
7617 external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches embedded URLs:
7618 @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}.
7619
7620 @item button-par
7621 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
7622 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
7623 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
7624
7625 @item use-p
7626 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
7627 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
7628 avoid false matches.
7629
7630 @item function
7631 This function will be called when you click on this button.
7632
7633 @item data-par
7634 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
7635 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
7636
7637 @end table
7638
7639 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
7640
7641 @lisp
7642 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
7643 @end lisp
7644
7645 @item gnus-header-button-alist
7646 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
7647 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
7648 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
7649 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
7650
7651 @lisp
7652 (HEADER REGEXP BUTTON-PAR USE-P FUNCTION DATA-PAR)
7653 @end lisp
7654
7655 @var{header} is a regular expression.
7656
7657 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
7658 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
7659 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
7660 default values of the variables above.
7661
7662 @item gnus-article-button-face
7663 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
7664 Face used on buttons.
7665
7666 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
7667 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
7668 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
7669
7670 @end table
7671
7672 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
7673
7674
7675 @node Article Date
7676 @subsection Article Date
7677
7678 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
7679 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
7680 when the article was sent.
7681
7682 @table @kbd
7683
7684 @item W T u
7685 @kindex W T u @r{(Summary)}
7686 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
7687 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
7688 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
7689
7690 @item W T i
7691 @kindex W T i @r{(Summary)}
7692 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
7693 @cindex ISO 8601
7694 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
7695 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
7696
7697 @item W T l
7698 @kindex W T l @r{(Summary)}
7699 @findex gnus-article-date-local
7700 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
7701
7702 @item W T s
7703 @kindex W T s @r{(Summary)}
7704 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
7705 @findex gnus-article-date-user
7706 @findex format-time-string
7707 Display the date using a user-defined format
7708 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
7709 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
7710 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
7711 for a list of possible format specs.
7712
7713 @item W T e
7714 @kindex W T e @r{(Summary)}
7715 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
7716 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
7717 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
7718 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
7719 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
7720
7721 @example
7722 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
7723 @end example
7724
7725 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
7726 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
7727 replace it.
7728
7729 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
7730 into wonderful absurdities.
7731
7732 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
7733
7734 @lisp
7735 (gnus-start-date-timer)
7736 @end lisp
7737
7738 in your @file{.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
7739 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
7740 command.
7741
7742 @item W T o
7743 @kindex W T o @r{(Summary)}
7744 @findex gnus-article-date-original
7745 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
7746 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
7747 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
7748 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
7749 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
7750
7751 @end table
7752
7753 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
7754 preferred format automatically.
7755
7756
7757 @node Article Signature
7758 @subsection Article Signature
7759 @cindex signatures
7760 @cindex article signature
7761
7762 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
7763 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
7764 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
7765 that says what is to be considered a signature is
7766 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
7767 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
7768 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
7769 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
7770 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
7771
7772 @lisp
7773 (setq gnus-signature-separator
7774 '("^-- $" ; The standard
7775 "^-- *$" ; A common mangling
7776 "^-------*$" ; Many people just use a looong
7777 ; line of dashes. Shame!
7778 "^ *--------*$" ; Double-shame!
7779 "^________*$" ; Underscores are also popular
7780 "^========*$")) ; Pervert!
7781 @end lisp
7782
7783 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
7784 positives.
7785
7786 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
7787 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
7788 signature when displaying articles.
7789
7790 @enumerate
7791 @item
7792 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
7793 that integer.
7794 @item
7795 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
7796 than that number.
7797 @item
7798 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
7799 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
7800 @item
7801 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
7802 in question is not a signature.
7803 @end enumerate
7804
7805 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
7806 listed above. Here's an example:
7807
7808 @lisp
7809 (setq gnus-signature-limit
7810 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
7811 @end lisp
7812
7813 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
7814 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
7815 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
7816 signature after all.
7817
7818
7819 @node Article Miscellanea
7820 @subsection Article Miscellanea
7821
7822 @table @kbd
7823 @item A t
7824 @kindex A t @r{(Summary)}
7825 @findex gnus-article-babel
7826 Translate the article from one language to another
7827 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
7828
7829 @end table
7830
7831
7832 @node MIME Commands
7833 @section @sc{mime} Commands
7834 @cindex MIME decoding
7835 @cindex attachments
7836 @cindex viewing attachments
7837
7838 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
7839 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @sc{mime} part''.
7840
7841 @table @kbd
7842 @item b
7843 @itemx K v
7844 @kindex b @r{(Summary)}
7845 @kindex K v @r{(Summary)}
7846 View the @sc{mime} part.
7847
7848 @item K o
7849 @kindex K o @r{(Summary)}
7850 Save the @sc{mime} part.
7851
7852 @item K c
7853 @kindex K c @r{(Summary)}
7854 Copy the @sc{mime} part.
7855
7856 @item K e
7857 @kindex K e @r{(Summary)}
7858 View the @sc{mime} part externally.
7859
7860 @item K i
7861 @kindex K i @r{(Summary)}
7862 View the @sc{mime} part internally.
7863
7864 @item K |
7865 @kindex K | @r{(Summary)}
7866 Pipe the @sc{mime} part to an external command.
7867 @end table
7868
7869 The rest of these @sc{mime} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
7870 the same manner:
7871
7872 @table @kbd
7873 @item K b
7874 @kindex K b @r{(Summary)}
7875 Make all the @sc{mime} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
7876 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
7877 parts.
7878
7879 @item K m
7880 @kindex K m @r{(Summary)}
7881 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
7882 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
7883 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
7884 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
7885 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
7886
7887 @item X m
7888 @kindex X m @r{(Summary)}
7889 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
7890 Save all parts matching a @sc{mime} type to a directory
7891 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
7892 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
7893
7894 @item M-t
7895 @kindex M-t @r{(Summary)}
7896 @findex gnus-summary-display-buttonized
7897 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
7898 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
7899
7900 @item W M w
7901 @kindex W M w @r{(Summary)}
7902 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
7903 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
7904
7905 @item W M c
7906 @kindex W M c @r{(Summary)}
7907 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
7908 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
7909
7910 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
7911 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
7912 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
7913 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not include
7914 MIME headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic parameter to
7915 the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
7916
7917 @item W M v
7918 @kindex W M v @r{(Summary)}
7919 View all the @sc{mime} parts in the current article
7920 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
7921
7922 @end table
7923
7924 Relevant variables:
7925
7926 @table @code
7927 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
7928 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
7929 This is a list of regexps. @sc{mime} types that match a regexp from
7930 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
7931 @code{nil}.
7932
7933 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
7934
7935 @lisp
7936 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
7937 '("text/x-vcard"))
7938 @end lisp
7939
7940 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
7941 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
7942 This is a list of regexps. @sc{mime} types that match a regexp from
7943 this list won't have @sc{mime} buttons inserted unless they aren't
7944 displayed. The default value is @code{(".*/.*")}.
7945
7946 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
7947 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
7948 For each @sc{mime} part, this function will be called with the @sc{mime}
7949 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
7950 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
7951 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
7952 save all jpegs into some directory).
7953
7954 Here's an example function the does the latter:
7955
7956 @lisp
7957 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
7958 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
7959 (with-temp-buffer
7960 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
7961 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
7962 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
7963 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
7964 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
7965 @end lisp
7966
7967 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
7968 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
7969 Alist of @sc{mime} multipart types and functions to handle them.
7970
7971 @end table
7972
7973
7974 @node Charsets
7975 @section Charsets
7976 @cindex charsets
7977
7978 People use different charsets, and we have @sc{mime} to let us know what
7979 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
7980 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @sc{mime}, and
7981 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
7982 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
7983 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
7984 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp-2}.
7985
7986 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
7987 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
7988 variable, which is an alist of regexps (to match group names) and
7989 default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
7990
7991 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @sc{mime}-aware agents that
7992 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1} even
7993 if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
7994 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
7995 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be set
7996 on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
7997 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit)}, which is
7998 something some agents insist on having in there.
7999
8000 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
8001 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
8002 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @sc{mime}
8003 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
8004 quoted-printable header encoding.
8005
8006 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
8007 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
8008 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
8009
8010 @table @var
8011 @item test
8012 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
8013 variable to query,
8014 @item header
8015 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
8016 means encode all charsets),
8017 @item body-list
8018 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
8019 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
8020 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
8021 @end table
8022
8023 @cindex Russian
8024 @cindex koi8-r
8025 @cindex koi8-u
8026 @cindex iso-8859-5
8027 @cindex coding system aliases
8028 @cindex preferred charset
8029
8030 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
8031
8032 If there are several @sc{mime} charsets that encode the same Emacs
8033 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
8034
8035 @lisp
8036 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
8037 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
8038 @end lisp
8039
8040 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
8041 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @sc{mime} charset.
8042
8043 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
8044
8045 @lisp
8046 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
8047 @end lisp
8048
8049 This will almost do the right thing.
8050
8051 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
8052 something like
8053
8054 @lisp
8055 (codepage-setup 1251)
8056 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
8057 @end lisp
8058
8059 while if you use a non-Latin-1 language environment you could see the
8060 Latin-1 subset of @code{windows-1252} using:
8061
8062 @lisp
8063 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1252 'latin-1)
8064 @end lisp
8065
8066
8067 @node Article Commands
8068 @section Article Commands
8069
8070 @table @kbd
8071
8072 @item A P
8073 @cindex PostScript
8074 @cindex printing
8075 @kindex A P @r{(Summary)}
8076 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
8077 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
8078 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
8079 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will be
8080 run just before printing the buffer.
8081
8082 @end table
8083
8084
8085 @node Summary Sorting
8086 @section Summary Sorting
8087 @cindex summary sorting
8088
8089 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
8090 can't really see why you'd want that.
8091
8092 @table @kbd
8093
8094 @item C-c C-s C-n
8095 @kindex C-c C-s C-n @r{(Summary)}
8096 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
8097 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
8098
8099 @item C-c C-s C-a
8100 @kindex C-c C-s C-a @r{(Summary)}
8101 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
8102 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
8103
8104 @item C-c C-s C-s
8105 @kindex C-c C-s C-s @r{(Summary)}
8106 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
8107 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
8108
8109 @item C-c C-s C-d
8110 @kindex C-c C-s C-d @r{(Summary)}
8111 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
8112 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
8113
8114 @item C-c C-s C-l
8115 @kindex C-c C-s C-l @r{(Summary)}
8116 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
8117 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
8118
8119 @item C-c C-s C-c
8120 @kindex C-c C-s C-c @r{(Summary)}
8121 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
8122 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
8123
8124 @item C-c C-s C-i
8125 @kindex C-c C-s C-i @r{(Summary)}
8126 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
8127 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
8128 @end table
8129
8130 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
8131 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
8132 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
8133 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
8134 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
8135 Commands}).
8136
8137
8138 @node Finding the Parent
8139 @section Finding the Parent
8140 @cindex parent articles
8141 @cindex referring articles
8142
8143 @table @kbd
8144 @item ^
8145 @kindex ^ @r{(Summary)}
8146 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
8147 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
8148 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
8149 if the current group is fetched by @sc{nntp}, the parent hasn't expired
8150 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
8151 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
8152 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
8153 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
8154 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
8155
8156 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
8157 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
8158 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
8159 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
8160 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
8161 article.
8162
8163 @item A R @r{(Summary)}
8164 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
8165 @kindex A R @r{(Summary)}
8166 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
8167 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
8168
8169 @item A T @r{(Summary)}
8170 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
8171 @kindex A T @r{(Summary)}
8172 Display the full thread where the current article appears
8173 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
8174 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
8175 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
8176 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
8177 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
8178 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
8179
8180 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
8181 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
8182 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
8183 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
8184 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
8185 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
8186
8187 @item M-^ @r{(Summary)}
8188 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
8189 @kindex M-^ @r{(Summary)}
8190 @cindex Message-ID
8191 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
8192 You can also ask the @sc{nntp} server for an arbitrary article, no
8193 matter what group it belongs to. @kbd{M-^}
8194 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you for a
8195 @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read thingies
8196 that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}. You
8197 have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
8198 @end table
8199
8200 The current select method will be used when fetching by
8201 @code{Message-ID} from non-news select method, but you can override this
8202 by giving this command a prefix.
8203
8204 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
8205 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
8206 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
8207 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @sc{nntp} method. It
8208 would, perhaps, be best if the @sc{nntp} server you consult is the one
8209 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
8210 necessary.
8211
8212 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
8213 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
8214 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
8215 match.
8216
8217 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
8218 then ask Deja if that fails:
8219
8220 @lisp
8221 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
8222 '(current
8223 (nnweb "refer" (nnweb-type dejanews))))
8224 @end lisp
8225
8226 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but do
8227 not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox} and
8228 @code{nnbabyl} are able to locate articles from any groups, while
8229 @code{nnml} and @code{nnfolder} are only able to locate articles that
8230 have been posted to the current group. (Anything else would be too time
8231 consuming.) @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
8232
8233
8234 @node Alternative Approaches
8235 @section Alternative Approaches
8236
8237 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
8238 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
8239
8240 @menu
8241 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
8242 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
8243 @end menu
8244
8245
8246 @node Pick and Read
8247 @subsection Pick and Read
8248 @cindex pick and read
8249
8250 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
8251 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
8252 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
8253 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
8254
8255 @findex gnus-pick-mode
8256 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
8257 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
8258 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
8259 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
8260 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
8261
8262 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
8263
8264 @table @kbd
8265 @item .
8266 @kindex . (Pick)
8267 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
8268 Pick the article or thread on the current line
8269 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
8270 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
8271 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
8272 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
8273 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
8274 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
8275
8276 @item @key{SPC}
8277 @kindex @key{SPC} (Pick)
8278 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
8279 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
8280 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
8281
8282 @item u
8283 @kindex u (Pick)
8284 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
8285 Unpick the thread or article
8286 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
8287 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
8288 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
8289 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
8290 the thread or article at that line.
8291
8292 @item @key{RET}
8293 @kindex @key{RET} (Pick)
8294 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
8295 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
8296 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
8297 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
8298 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
8299 will still be visible when you are reading.
8300
8301 @end table
8302
8303 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
8304 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
8305 which is mapped to the same function
8306 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
8307
8308 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
8309
8310 @lisp
8311 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
8312 @end lisp
8313
8314 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
8315 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
8316
8317 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
8318 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
8319 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
8320
8321 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
8322 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
8323 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
8324 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
8325 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
8326 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
8327 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
8328
8329
8330 @node Binary Groups
8331 @subsection Binary Groups
8332 @cindex binary groups
8333
8334 @findex gnus-binary-mode
8335 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
8336 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
8337 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @key{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
8338 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
8339 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
8340 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
8341
8342 @kindex g (Binary)
8343 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
8344 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
8345 command, when you have turned on this mode
8346 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
8347
8348 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
8349 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
8350
8351
8352 @node Tree Display
8353 @section Tree Display
8354 @cindex trees
8355
8356 @vindex gnus-use-trees
8357 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
8358 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
8359 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
8360 in the tree buffer.
8361
8362 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
8363
8364 @table @code
8365 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
8366 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
8367 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
8368
8369 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
8370 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
8371 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
8372 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
8373 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
8374
8375 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
8376 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
8377 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
8378 default is @code{modeline}.
8379
8380 @item gnus-tree-line-format
8381 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
8382 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
8383 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
8384 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
8385 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
8386 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
8387
8388 Valid specs are:
8389
8390 @table @samp
8391 @item n
8392 The name of the poster.
8393 @item f
8394 The @code{From} header.
8395 @item N
8396 The number of the article.
8397 @item [
8398 The opening bracket.
8399 @item ]
8400 The closing bracket.
8401 @item s
8402 The subject.
8403 @end table
8404
8405 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
8406
8407 Variables related to the display are:
8408
8409 @table @code
8410 @item gnus-tree-brackets
8411 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
8412 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
8413 ``sparse'' articles. The format is @code{((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
8414 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close}) (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))}, and the
8415 default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
8416
8417 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
8418 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
8419 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
8420 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
8421
8422 @end table
8423
8424 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
8425 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
8426 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
8427 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
8428 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
8429 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
8430 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
8431 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
8432 other windows displayed next to it.
8433
8434 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
8435 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
8436 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
8437 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
8438 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
8439 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
8440 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
8441
8442 @end table
8443
8444 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
8445
8446 @example
8447 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
8448 | \[Jan]
8449 | \[odd]-[Eri]
8450 | \(***)-[Eri]
8451 | \[odd]-[Paa]
8452 \[Bjo]
8453 \[Gun]
8454 \[Gun]-[Jor]
8455 @end example
8456
8457 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
8458
8459 @example
8460 @{***@}
8461 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
8462 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
8463 |--\-----\-----\ |
8464 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
8465 | | |--\
8466 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
8467 |
8468 [Paa]
8469 @end example
8470
8471 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
8472 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
8473 following to your @file{.gnus.el} file:
8474
8475 @lisp
8476 (setq gnus-use-trees t
8477 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
8478 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
8479 (gnus-add-configuration
8480 '(article
8481 (vertical 1.0
8482 (horizontal 0.25
8483 (summary 0.75 point)
8484 (tree 1.0))
8485 (article 1.0))))
8486 @end lisp
8487
8488 @xref{Windows Configuration}.
8489
8490
8491 @node Mail Group Commands
8492 @section Mail Group Commands
8493 @cindex mail group commands
8494
8495 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
8496 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
8497
8498 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
8499 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
8500
8501 @table @kbd
8502
8503 @item B e
8504 @kindex B e @r{(Summary)}
8505 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
8506 Expire all expirable articles in the group
8507 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}).
8508
8509 @item B C-M-e
8510 @kindex B C-M-e @r{(Summary)}
8511 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
8512 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
8513 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
8514 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
8515 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
8516
8517 @item B @key{DEL}
8518 @kindex B @key{DEL} @r{(Summary)}
8519 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
8520 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
8521 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
8522 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
8523 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
8524
8525 @item B m
8526 @kindex B m @r{(Summary)}
8527 @cindex move mail
8528 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
8529 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
8530 Move the article from one mail group to another
8531 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
8532 @var{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
8533
8534 @item B c
8535 @kindex B c @r{(Summary)}
8536 @cindex copy mail
8537 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
8538 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
8539 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
8540 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
8541 @var{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
8542
8543 @item B B
8544 @kindex B B @r{(Summary)}
8545 @cindex crosspost mail
8546 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
8547 Crosspost the current article to some other group
8548 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
8549 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
8550 be properly updated.
8551
8552 @item B i
8553 @kindex B i @r{(Summary)}
8554 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
8555 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
8556 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
8557 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
8558
8559 @item B r
8560 @kindex B r @r{(Summary)}
8561 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
8562 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
8563 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
8564 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
8565 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
8566 Marks will be preserved if @var{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
8567 (which is the default).
8568
8569 @item B w
8570 @itemx e
8571 @kindex B w @r{(Summary)}
8572 @kindex e @r{(Summary)}
8573 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
8574 @kindex C-c C-c @r{(Article)}
8575 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
8576 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
8577 (@kbd{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
8578 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
8579
8580 @item B q
8581 @kindex B q @r{(Summary)}
8582 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
8583 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
8584 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
8585 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
8586
8587 @item B t
8588 @kindex B t @r{(Summary)}
8589 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
8590 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
8591 when repooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
8592
8593 @item B p
8594 @kindex B p @r{(Summary)}
8595 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
8596 Some people have a tendency to send you "courtesy" copies when they
8597 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
8598 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
8599 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
8600 article from your news server (or rather, from
8601 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
8602 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
8603 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
8604 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
8605 just not have arrived yet.
8606
8607 @end table
8608
8609 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
8610 @cindex moving articles
8611 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
8612 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
8613 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
8614 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
8615 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
8616 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
8617 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
8618
8619 @lisp
8620 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
8621 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
8622 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
8623 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
8624 @end lisp
8625
8626
8627 @node Various Summary Stuff
8628 @section Various Summary Stuff
8629
8630 @menu
8631 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
8632 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
8633 * Summary Generation Commands:: (Re)generating the summary buffer.
8634 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
8635 @end menu
8636
8637 @table @code
8638 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
8639 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
8640 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
8641
8642 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
8643 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
8644 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
8645 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
8646 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
8647 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
8648 have been set.
8649
8650 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
8651 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
8652 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
8653 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
8654 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
8655
8656 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
8657 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
8658 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
8659 generated.
8660
8661 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
8662 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
8663 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
8664 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
8665 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
8666 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
8667 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
8668 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
8669 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
8670 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
8671
8672 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
8673 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
8674 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
8675 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
8676 list of articles to be selected.
8677
8678 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
8679 the list in one particular group:
8680
8681 @lisp
8682 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
8683 (if (string= group "some.group")
8684 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
8685 articles))
8686 @end lisp
8687
8688 @end table
8689
8690
8691 @node Summary Group Information
8692 @subsection Summary Group Information
8693
8694 @table @kbd
8695
8696 @item H f
8697 @kindex H f @r{(Summary)}
8698 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
8699 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
8700 Try to fetch the FAQ (list of frequently asked questions) for the
8701 current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the
8702 FAQ from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory
8703 on a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
8704 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
8705 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will probably
8706 be used for fetching the file.
8707
8708 @item H d
8709 @kindex H d @r{(Summary)}
8710 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
8711 Give a brief description of the current group
8712 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
8713 rereading the description from the server.
8714
8715 @item H h
8716 @kindex H h @r{(Summary)}
8717 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
8718 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
8719 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
8720
8721 @item H i
8722 @kindex H i @r{(Summary)}
8723 @findex gnus-info-find-node
8724 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
8725 @end table
8726
8727
8728 @node Searching for Articles
8729 @subsection Searching for Articles
8730
8731 @table @kbd
8732
8733 @item M-s
8734 @kindex M-s @r{(Summary)}
8735 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
8736 Search through all subsequent articles for a regexp
8737 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
8738
8739 @item M-r
8740 @kindex M-r @r{(Summary)}
8741 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
8742 Search through all previous articles for a regexp
8743 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
8744
8745 @item &
8746 @kindex & @r{(Summary)}
8747 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
8748 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
8749 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
8750 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
8751 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
8752 search backward instead.
8753
8754 For instance, @kbd{& @key{RET} some.*string #} will put the process mark on
8755 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
8756
8757 @item M-&
8758 @kindex M-& @r{(Summary)}
8759 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
8760 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
8761 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
8762 @end table
8763
8764 @node Summary Generation Commands
8765 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
8766
8767 @table @kbd
8768
8769 @item Y g
8770 @kindex Y g @r{(Summary)}
8771 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
8772 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
8773
8774 @item Y c
8775 @kindex Y c @r{(Summary)}
8776 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
8777 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
8778 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
8779
8780 @end table
8781
8782
8783 @node Really Various Summary Commands
8784 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
8785
8786 @table @kbd
8787
8788 @item A D
8789 @itemx C-d
8790 @kindex C-d @r{(Summary)}
8791 @kindex A D @r{(Summary)}
8792 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
8793 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
8794 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
8795 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
8796 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
8797 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
8798 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
8799 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
8800 fashion.
8801
8802 @item C-M-d
8803 @kindex C-M-d @r{(Summary)}
8804 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
8805 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
8806 several documents into one biiig group
8807 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
8808 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
8809 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
8810 command understands the process/prefix convention
8811 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
8812
8813 @item C-t
8814 @kindex C-t @r{(Summary)}
8815 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
8816 Toggle truncation of summary lines
8817 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
8818 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
8819 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
8820
8821 @item =
8822 @kindex = @r{(Summary)}
8823 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
8824 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
8825 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
8826
8827 @item C-M-e
8828 @kindex C-M-e @r{(Summary)}
8829 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
8830 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
8831 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
8832
8833 @item C-M-a
8834 @kindex C-M-a @r{(Summary)}
8835 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
8836 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
8837 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
8838
8839 @end table
8840
8841
8842 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
8843 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
8844 @cindex summary exit
8845 @cindex exiting groups
8846
8847 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
8848 group and return you to the group buffer.
8849
8850 @table @kbd
8851
8852 @item Z Z
8853 @itemx q
8854 @kindex Z Z @r{(Summary)}
8855 @kindex q @r{(Summary)}
8856 @findex gnus-summary-exit
8857 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
8858 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
8859 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
8860 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
8861 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
8862 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
8863 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
8864 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
8865 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
8866 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
8867
8868 @item Z E
8869 @itemx Q
8870 @kindex Z E @r{(Summary)}
8871 @kindex Q @r{(Summary)}
8872 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
8873 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
8874 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
8875
8876 @item Z c
8877 @itemx c
8878 @kindex Z c @r{(Summary)}
8879 @kindex c @r{(Summary)}
8880 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
8881 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
8882 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
8883 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
8884
8885 @item Z C
8886 @kindex Z C @r{(Summary)}
8887 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
8888 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
8889 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
8890
8891 @item Z n
8892 @kindex Z n @r{(Summary)}
8893 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
8894 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
8895 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
8896
8897 @item Z R
8898 @kindex Z R @r{(Summary)}
8899 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
8900 Exit this group, and then enter it again
8901 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
8902 all articles, both read and unread.
8903
8904 @item Z G
8905 @itemx M-g
8906 @kindex Z G @r{(Summary)}
8907 @kindex M-g @r{(Summary)}
8908 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
8909 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
8910 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
8911 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
8912 articles, both read and unread.
8913
8914 @item Z N
8915 @kindex Z N @r{(Summary)}
8916 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
8917 Exit the group and go to the next group
8918 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
8919
8920 @item Z P
8921 @kindex Z P @r{(Summary)}
8922 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
8923 Exit the group and go to the previous group
8924 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
8925
8926 @item Z s
8927 @kindex Z s @r{(Summary)}
8928 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
8929 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
8930 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
8931 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
8932 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
8933 @end table
8934
8935 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
8936 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
8937 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
8938 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
8939
8940 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
8941 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
8942 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
8943 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
8944 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
8945 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
8946 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
8947 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
8948 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
8949 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
8950 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
8951 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
8952
8953 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
8954
8955 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
8956 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
8957 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
8958 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
8959 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
8960 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
8961 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
8962 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
8963 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
8964
8965
8966 @node Crosspost Handling
8967 @section Crosspost Handling
8968
8969 @cindex velveeta
8970 @cindex spamming
8971 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
8972 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
8973 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
8974 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
8975 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
8976 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
8977 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
8978
8979 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
8980 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
8981 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
8982 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
8983 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
8984
8985 @cindex cross-posting
8986 @cindex Xref
8987 @cindex @sc{nov}
8988 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
8989 correctly is if you use an @sc{nntp} server that supports @sc{xover}
8990 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
8991 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @sc{nov} lines. This is
8992 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
8993 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
8994 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
8995 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
8996 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
8997 the cross reference mechanism.
8998
8999 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
9000 @cindex overview.fmt
9001 To check whether your @sc{nntp} server includes the @code{Xref} header
9002 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
9003 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
9004 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
9005 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
9006 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
9007 overview files.
9008
9009 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
9010 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
9011 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
9012 considerably.
9013
9014 C'est la vie.
9015
9016 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
9017
9018
9019 @node Duplicate Suppression
9020 @section Duplicate Suppression
9021
9022 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
9023 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
9024 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
9025 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
9026 reasons.
9027
9028 @enumerate
9029 @item
9030 The @sc{nntp} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
9031 is evil and not very common.
9032
9033 @item
9034 The @sc{nntp} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
9035 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
9036
9037 @item
9038 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
9039 different @sc{nntp} servers.
9040
9041 @item
9042 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
9043 @end enumerate
9044
9045 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
9046 well, but these four are the most common situations.
9047
9048 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
9049 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
9050 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
9051 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
9052 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
9053 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
9054 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
9055 once.
9056
9057 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
9058 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
9059 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
9060 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
9061 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
9062 saw the article in.
9063
9064 @table @code
9065 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
9066 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
9067 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
9068
9069 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
9070 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
9071 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
9072 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
9073 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
9074 session are suppressed.
9075
9076 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
9077 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
9078 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
9079 suppression list. The default is 10000.
9080
9081 @item gnus-duplicate-file
9082 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
9083 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
9084 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
9085 @end table
9086
9087 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
9088 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
9089 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
9090 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
9091 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
9092 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
9093 to you to figure out, I think.
9094
9095
9096 @node The Article Buffer
9097 @chapter The Article Buffer
9098 @cindex article buffer
9099
9100 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
9101 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
9102 tell Gnus otherwise.
9103
9104 @menu
9105 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
9106 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @sc{mime} before reading them.
9107 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
9108 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
9109 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
9110 @end menu
9111
9112
9113 @node Hiding Headers
9114 @section Hiding Headers
9115 @cindex hiding headers
9116 @cindex deleting headers
9117
9118 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
9119 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
9120
9121 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
9122 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
9123 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
9124 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
9125 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
9126 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
9127 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseum---and you'll probably want to get rid
9128 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
9129 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
9130
9131 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
9132
9133 @table @code
9134
9135 @item gnus-visible-headers
9136 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
9137 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
9138 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
9139 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
9140
9141 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
9142 the article and the subject, you'd say:
9143
9144 @lisp
9145 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
9146 @end lisp
9147
9148 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
9149 remain visible.
9150
9151 @item gnus-ignored-headers
9152 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
9153 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
9154 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
9155 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
9156 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
9157
9158 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
9159 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
9160
9161 @lisp
9162 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
9163 @end lisp
9164
9165 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
9166 be removed.
9167
9168 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
9169 variable will have no effect.
9170
9171 @end table
9172
9173 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
9174 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
9175 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
9176 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
9177 the headers are to be displayed.
9178
9179 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
9180 and then the subject, you might say something like:
9181
9182 @lisp
9183 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
9184 @end lisp
9185
9186 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
9187 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
9188
9189 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
9190 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
9191 You can hide further boring headers by setting
9192 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-header} to @code{head}. What this function
9193 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
9194 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead is
9195 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
9196 from sight.
9197
9198 These conditions are:
9199 @table @code
9200 @item empty
9201 Remove all empty headers.
9202 @item followup-to
9203 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
9204 @code{Newsgroups} header.
9205 @item reply-to
9206 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same address as the
9207 @code{From} header.
9208 @item newsgroups
9209 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
9210 name.
9211 @item date
9212 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
9213 old.
9214 @item long-to
9215 Remove the @code{To} header if it is very long.
9216 @item many-to
9217 Remove all @code{To} headers if there are more than one.
9218 @end table
9219
9220 To include the four three elements, you could say something like;
9221
9222 @lisp
9223 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
9224 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
9225 @end lisp
9226
9227 This is also the default value for this variable.
9228
9229
9230 @node Using MIME
9231 @section Using @sc{mime}
9232 @cindex @sc{mime}
9233
9234 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
9235 while people stand around yawning.
9236
9237 @sc{mime}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
9238 while all newsreaders die of fear.
9239
9240 @sc{mime} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
9241 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
9242 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
9243
9244 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
9245 @findex gnus-display-mime
9246 Gnus pushes @sc{mime} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
9247 to display the @sc{mime} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
9248 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
9249 display, save and manipulate the @sc{mime} objects.
9250
9251 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
9252 @sc{mime} button:
9253
9254 @table @kbd
9255 @findex gnus-article-press-button
9256 @item @key{RET} @r{(Article)}
9257 @itemx Mouse-2 @r{(Article)}
9258 Toggle displaying of the @sc{mime} object
9259 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}).
9260
9261 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
9262 @item M-@key{RET} @r{(Article)}
9263 @itemx v @r{(Article)}
9264 Prompt for a method, and then view the @sc{mime} object using this
9265 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
9266
9267 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
9268 @item o @r{(Article)}
9269 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @sc{mime} object
9270 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
9271
9272 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
9273 @item c @r{(Article)}
9274 Copy the @sc{mime} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
9275 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}).
9276
9277 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
9278 @item t @r{(Article)}
9279 View the @sc{mime} object as if it were a different @sc{mime} media type
9280 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
9281
9282 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
9283 @item | @r{(Article)}
9284 Output the @sc{mime} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
9285
9286 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
9287 @item i @r{(Article)}
9288 Insert the contents of the @sc{mime} object into the buffer
9289 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
9290 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
9291 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
9292 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @pxref{Paging the
9293 Article}).
9294
9295 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
9296 @item . @r{(Article)}
9297 Interactively run an action on the @sc{mime} object
9298 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
9299
9300 @end table
9301
9302 Gnus will display some @sc{mime} objects automatically. The way Gnus
9303 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs MIME
9304 manual.
9305
9306 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
9307 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
9308 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @sc{mime} has
9309 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
9310 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
9311 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
9312 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
9313 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
9314 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
9315
9316 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
9317
9318 Also see @pxref{MIME Commands}.
9319
9320
9321 @node Customizing Articles
9322 @section Customizing Articles
9323 @cindex article customization
9324
9325 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
9326 exist. You can call these functions interactively, or you can have them
9327 called automatically when you select the articles.
9328
9329 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
9330 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
9331 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
9332 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
9333
9334 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
9335 for sensible values.
9336
9337 @enumerate
9338 @item
9339 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
9340
9341 @item
9342 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
9343
9344 @item
9345 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
9346
9347 @item
9348 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
9349
9350 @item
9351 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
9352 than this number.
9353
9354 @item
9355 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
9356 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
9357 regexps in the list.
9358
9359 @item
9360 A list where the first element is not a string:
9361
9362 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
9363 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
9364 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
9365
9366 @lisp
9367 (or last
9368 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
9369 @end lisp
9370
9371 @end enumerate
9372
9373 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
9374 to the fact that some messages are @sc{mime} multipart articles that may
9375 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
9376 considered to contain just a single part.
9377
9378 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
9379 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
9380 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
9381 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
9382 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
9383 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
9384 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
9385
9386 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
9387 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
9388 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
9389 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
9390
9391 @table @code
9392 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last)
9393 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
9394 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
9395 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
9396 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
9397 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
9398 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
9399 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
9400 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
9401 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
9402 @item gnus-treat-strip-pgp (t, last, integer)
9403 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
9404 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
9405 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
9406 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
9407 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
9408 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
9409 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
9410 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
9411 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
9412 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
9413 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
9414 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
9415 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
9416 @item gnus-treat-display-xface (head)
9417 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
9418 @item gnus-treat-display-picons (head)
9419 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
9420 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
9421 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
9422 @item gnus-treat-translate
9423 @end table
9424
9425 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
9426 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
9427 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
9428 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
9429 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
9430 everything.
9431
9432
9433 @node Article Keymap
9434 @section Article Keymap
9435
9436 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
9437 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
9438 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
9439 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
9440 buffer.
9441
9442 A few additional keystrokes are available:
9443
9444 @table @kbd
9445
9446 @item @key{SPC}
9447 @kindex @key{SPC} @r{(Article)}
9448 @findex gnus-article-next-page
9449 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
9450
9451 @item @key{DEL}
9452 @kindex @key{DEL} @r{(Article)}
9453 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
9454 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
9455
9456 @item C-c ^
9457 @kindex C-c ^ @r{(Article)}
9458 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
9459 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
9460 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
9461 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
9462
9463 @item C-c C-m
9464 @kindex C-c C-m @r{(Article)}
9465 @findex gnus-article-mail
9466 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
9467 given a prefix, include the mail.
9468
9469 @item s
9470 @kindex s @r{(Article)}
9471 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
9472 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
9473 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
9474
9475 @item ?
9476 @kindex ? @r{(Article)}
9477 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
9478 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
9479 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
9480
9481 @item TAB
9482 @kindex TAB @r{(Article)}
9483 @findex gnus-article-next-button
9484 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
9485 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
9486
9487 @item M-TAB
9488 @kindex M-TAB @r{(Article)}
9489 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
9490 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
9491
9492 @end table
9493
9494
9495 @node Misc Article
9496 @section Misc Article
9497
9498 @table @code
9499
9500 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
9501 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
9502 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
9503 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
9504 article buffer.
9505
9506 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
9507 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
9508 @cindex MIME
9509 Hook used to decode @sc{mime} articles. The default value is
9510 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
9511
9512 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
9513 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
9514 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
9515 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
9516 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
9517 the contents of the article buffer.
9518
9519 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
9520 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
9521 Hook called in article mode buffers.
9522
9523 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
9524 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
9525 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
9526 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
9527
9528 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
9529 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
9530 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
9531 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
9532 accepts the same format specifications as that variable, with two
9533 extensions:
9534
9535 @table @samp
9536 @item w
9537 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
9538 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
9539 performed.
9540 @item m
9541 The number of @sc{mime} parts in the article.
9542 @end table
9543
9544 @vindex gnus-break-pages
9545
9546 @item gnus-break-pages
9547 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
9548 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
9549 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
9550 paging will not be done.
9551
9552 @item gnus-page-delimiter
9553 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
9554 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
9555 (formfeed).
9556 @end table
9557
9558
9559 @node Composing Messages
9560 @chapter Composing Messages
9561 @cindex composing messages
9562 @cindex messages
9563 @cindex mail
9564 @cindex sending mail
9565 @cindex reply
9566 @cindex followup
9567 @cindex post
9568
9569 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
9570 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
9571 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
9572 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Top, message, The
9573 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
9574 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
9575
9576 @menu
9577 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
9578 * Posting Server:: What server should you post via?
9579 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
9580 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
9581 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
9582 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
9583 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
9584 @end menu
9585
9586 Also see @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
9587 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
9588
9589
9590 @node Mail
9591 @section Mail
9592
9593 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
9594
9595 @table @code
9596 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
9597 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
9598 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
9599 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched.
9600
9601 @item gnus-add-to-list
9602 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
9603 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
9604 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
9605
9606 @end table
9607
9608
9609 @node Posting Server
9610 @section Posting Server
9611
9612 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
9613 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
9614
9615 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
9616
9617 @vindex gnus-post-method
9618
9619 It can be quite complicated. Normally, Gnus will use the same native
9620 server. However. If your native server doesn't allow posting, just
9621 reading, you probably want to use some other server to post your
9622 (extremely intelligent and fabulously interesting) articles. You can
9623 then set the @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
9624
9625 @lisp
9626 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
9627 @end lisp
9628
9629 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
9630 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
9631 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
9632 the ``current'' server for posting.
9633
9634 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
9635 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
9636
9637 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
9638 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
9639 for posting.
9640
9641 Finally, if you want to always post using the same select method as
9642 you're reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
9643 groups from different private servers), you can set this variable to
9644 @code{current}.
9645
9646
9647 @node Mail and Post
9648 @section Mail and Post
9649
9650 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
9651 posting:
9652
9653 @table @code
9654 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
9655 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
9656 @cindex mailing lists
9657
9658 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
9659 gatewayed to the @sc{nntp} server, you can read those groups without
9660 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
9661 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
9662 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
9663 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
9664 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
9665 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
9666 still a pain, though.
9667
9668 @end table
9669
9670 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
9671 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
9672 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
9673
9674 @cindex ispell
9675 @findex ispell-message
9676 @lisp
9677 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
9678 @end lisp
9679
9680 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
9681 you're in, you could say something like the following:
9682
9683 @lisp
9684 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
9685 (lambda ()
9686 (cond
9687 ((string-match "^de\\." gnus-newsgroup-name)
9688 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
9689 (t
9690 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
9691 @end lisp
9692
9693 Modify to suit your needs.
9694
9695
9696 @node Archived Messages
9697 @section Archived Messages
9698 @cindex archived messages
9699 @cindex sent messages
9700
9701 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
9702 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
9703 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
9704 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
9705 is the default.
9706
9707 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
9708 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
9709 use to store sent messages. The default is:
9710
9711 @lisp
9712 (nnfolder "archive"
9713 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
9714 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
9715 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
9716 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
9717 @end lisp
9718
9719 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
9720 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
9721 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
9722 directory chosen, you could say something like:
9723
9724 @lisp
9725 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
9726 '(nnfolder "archive"
9727 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
9728 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
9729 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
9730 @end lisp
9731
9732 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
9733 @cindex Gcc
9734 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
9735 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
9736 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
9737
9738 This variable can be used to do the following:
9739
9740 @itemize @bullet
9741 @item a string
9742 Messages will be saved in that group.
9743
9744 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
9745 message will not be stored in the select method given by
9746 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
9747 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
9748 has the default value shown above. Then setting
9749 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
9750 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
9751 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
9752 @samp{nnml:foo}.
9753 @item a list of strings
9754 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
9755 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
9756 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
9757 @item @code{nil}
9758 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
9759 @end itemize
9760
9761 Let's illustrate:
9762
9763 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
9764 @lisp
9765 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
9766 @end lisp
9767
9768 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
9769 @lisp
9770 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
9771 @end lisp
9772
9773 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
9774 @lisp
9775 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
9776 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
9777 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
9778 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
9779 @end lisp
9780
9781 More complex stuff:
9782 @lisp
9783 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
9784 '((if (message-news-p)
9785 "misc-news"
9786 "misc-mail")))
9787 @end lisp
9788
9789 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
9790 messages in one file per month:
9791
9792 @lisp
9793 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
9794 '((if (message-news-p)
9795 "misc-news"
9796 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
9797 @end lisp
9798
9799 (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
9800 use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
9801
9802 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
9803 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
9804 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
9805 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
9806 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
9807 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
9808 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
9809 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
9810 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
9811 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
9812
9813 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
9814 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
9815 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
9816 this will disable archiving.
9817
9818 @table @code
9819 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
9820 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
9821 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
9822 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
9823 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
9824 group names.
9825
9826 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
9827 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
9828 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
9829 of names).
9830
9831 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
9832 but the latter is the preferred method.
9833 @end table
9834
9835
9836 @node Posting Styles
9837 @section Posting Styles
9838 @cindex posting styles
9839 @cindex styles
9840
9841 All them variables, they make my head swim.
9842
9843 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
9844 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
9845 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
9846 on?
9847
9848 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
9849 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
9850 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
9851 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
9852 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
9853 variable:
9854
9855 @lisp
9856 ((".*"
9857 (signature "Peace and happiness")
9858 (organization "What me?"))
9859 ("^comp"
9860 (signature "Death to everybody"))
9861 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
9862 (organization "Emacs is it")))
9863 @end lisp
9864
9865 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
9866 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
9867 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
9868 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
9869 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
9870 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
9871 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
9872 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
9873
9874 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
9875 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
9876 If it is the symbol @code{header}, then Gnus will look for header that
9877 match the next element in the match, and compare that to the last header
9878 in the match. If it's a function symbol, that function will be called
9879 with no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
9880 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
9881 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is said
9882 to @dfn{match}.
9883
9884 Each style may contain a arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
9885 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} . @var{value})} pair. The
9886 attribute name can be one of @code{signature}, @code{signature-file},
9887 @code{organization}, @code{address}, @code{name} or @code{body}. The
9888 attribute name can also be a string. In that case, this will be used as
9889 a header name, and the value will be inserted in the headers of the
9890 article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header name will be removed.
9891 If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form is evaluated, and the
9892 result is thrown away.
9893
9894 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
9895 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
9896 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
9897 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
9898 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
9899 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable.
9900
9901 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
9902 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
9903 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
9904
9905 @findex message-mail-p
9906 @findex message-news-p
9907
9908 So here's a new example:
9909
9910 @lisp
9911 (setq gnus-posting-styles
9912 '((".*"
9913 (signature-file "~/.signature")
9914 (name "User Name")
9915 ("X-Home-Page" (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
9916 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
9917 ("^rec.humor"
9918 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
9919 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly")
9920 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
9921 ((message-news-p)
9922 (signature my-news-signature))
9923 (header "From\\|To" "larsi.*org"
9924 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
9925 ((posting-from-work-p)
9926 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
9927 (address "user@@bar.foo")
9928 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
9929 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
9930 ("nnml:.*"
9931 (From (save-excursion
9932 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
9933 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
9934 ("^nn.+:"
9935 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
9936 @end lisp
9937
9938 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
9939 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
9940 if you fill many roles.
9941
9942
9943 @node Drafts
9944 @section Drafts
9945 @cindex drafts
9946
9947 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
9948 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
9949 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
9950 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
9951 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
9952
9953 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
9954 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
9955 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
9956 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
9957 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
9958 group.)
9959
9960 @cindex nndraft
9961 @vindex nndraft-directory
9962 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
9963 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
9964 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
9965 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
9966 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
9967 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
9968
9969 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
9970 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
9971 unsubscribe it.
9972
9973 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
9974 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
9975 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
9976 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
9977 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
9978 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
9979 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
9980 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
9981 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
9982 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
9983 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
9984 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
9985 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
9986 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
9987 @c
9988 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
9989 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
9990 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
9991
9992 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
9993 @kindex D e (Draft)
9994 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
9995 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
9996 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
9997
9998 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
9999 Articles}).
10000
10001 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
10002 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
10003 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
10004 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
10005 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
10006 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
10007 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
10008 in the buffer.
10009
10010 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
10011 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
10012 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
10013
10014
10015 @node Rejected Articles
10016 @section Rejected Articles
10017 @cindex rejected articles
10018
10019 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
10020 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
10021 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
10022 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
10023
10024 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
10025 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
10026 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
10027 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
10028 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
10029
10030 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
10031 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
10032 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
10033
10034
10035 @node Select Methods
10036 @chapter Select Methods
10037 @cindex foreign groups
10038 @cindex select methods
10039
10040 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
10041 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
10042 @sc{nntp} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
10043 personal mail group.
10044
10045 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
10046 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
10047 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
10048 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
10049 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
10050 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
10051
10052 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
10053 we do just that (@pxref{The Server Buffer}).
10054
10055 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
10056 group as.
10057
10058 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @sc{nntp} server
10059 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
10060 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
10061 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
10062 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
10063
10064 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
10065
10066 @menu
10067 * The Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
10068 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
10069 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
10070 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
10071 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
10072 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
10073 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
10074 @end menu
10075
10076
10077 @node The Server Buffer
10078 @section The Server Buffer
10079
10080 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
10081 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
10082 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
10083 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
10084 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
10085 back end represents a virtual server.
10086
10087 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
10088 different actual @sc{nntp} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
10089 on the same actual @sc{nntp} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
10090 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
10091
10092 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
10093 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
10094 @sc{nntp} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
10095 hangs if queried for @sc{nov} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
10096 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
10097 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
10098 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
10099
10100 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
10101 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
10102
10103 @menu
10104 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
10105 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
10106 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
10107 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
10108 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
10109 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
10110 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
10111 @end menu
10112
10113 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
10114 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
10115
10116
10117 @node Server Buffer Format
10118 @subsection Server Buffer Format
10119 @cindex server buffer format
10120
10121 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
10122 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
10123 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
10124 variable, with some simple extensions:
10125
10126 @table @samp
10127
10128 @item h
10129 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
10130
10131 @item n
10132 The name of this server.
10133
10134 @item w
10135 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
10136
10137 @item s
10138 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
10139 @end table
10140
10141 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
10142 The mode line can also be customized by using the
10143 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
10144 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
10145
10146 @table @samp
10147 @item S
10148 Server name.
10149
10150 @item M
10151 Server method.
10152 @end table
10153
10154 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
10155
10156
10157 @node Server Commands
10158 @subsection Server Commands
10159 @cindex server commands
10160
10161 @table @kbd
10162
10163 @item a
10164 @kindex a (Server)
10165 @findex gnus-server-add-server
10166 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
10167
10168 @item e
10169 @kindex e (Server)
10170 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
10171 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
10172
10173 @item @key{SPC}
10174 @kindex @key{SPC} (Server)
10175 @findex gnus-server-read-server
10176 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
10177
10178 @item q
10179 @kindex q (Server)
10180 @findex gnus-server-exit
10181 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
10182
10183 @item k
10184 @kindex k (Server)
10185 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
10186 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
10187
10188 @item y
10189 @kindex y (Server)
10190 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
10191 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
10192
10193 @item c
10194 @kindex c (Server)
10195 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
10196 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
10197
10198 @item l
10199 @kindex l (Server)
10200 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
10201 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
10202
10203 @item s
10204 @kindex s (Server)
10205 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
10206 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
10207 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
10208 servers.
10209
10210 @item g
10211 @kindex g (Server)
10212 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
10213 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
10214 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
10215 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
10216
10217 @end table
10218
10219
10220 @node Example Methods
10221 @subsection Example Methods
10222
10223 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
10224
10225 @lisp
10226 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
10227 @end lisp
10228
10229 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
10230
10231 @lisp
10232 (nnspool "")
10233 @end lisp
10234
10235 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
10236 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
10237 will.
10238
10239 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
10240 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
10241
10242 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
10243 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
10244 look like then:
10245
10246 @lisp
10247 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
10248 @end lisp
10249
10250 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
10251 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
10252
10253 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
10254 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
10255 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
10256 your private mail:
10257
10258 @lisp
10259 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
10260 @end lisp
10261
10262 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
10263 that.)
10264
10265 Here's the method for a public spool:
10266
10267 @lisp
10268 (nnmh "public"
10269 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
10270 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
10271 @end lisp
10272
10273 @cindex proxy
10274 @cindex firewall
10275
10276 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @sc{nntp}
10277 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
10278 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @sc{nntp} server.
10279 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
10280 should probably look something like this:
10281
10282 @lisp
10283 (nntp "firewall"
10284 (nntp-address "the.firewall.machine")
10285 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-rlogin)
10286 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
10287 (nntp-rlogin-parameters
10288 ("telnet" "the.real.nntp.host" "nntp")))
10289 @end lisp
10290
10291 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
10292 compressed connection over the modem line, you could create a virtual
10293 server that would look something like this:
10294
10295 @lisp
10296 (nntp "news"
10297 (nntp-address "copper.uio.no")
10298 (nntp-rlogin-program "ssh")
10299 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-rlogin)
10300 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
10301 (nntp-rlogin-parameters
10302 ("telnet" "news.uio.no" "nntp")))
10303 @end lisp
10304
10305 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
10306 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
10307 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
10308 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
10309
10310
10311 @node Creating a Virtual Server
10312 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
10313
10314 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
10315 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
10316
10317 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
10318 would probably be best to use @code{nnspool} to read the cache. You
10319 could also use @code{nnml} or @code{nnmh}, though.
10320
10321 Type @kbd{a nnspool @key{RET} cache @key{RET}}.
10322
10323 You should now have a brand new @code{nnspool} virtual server called
10324 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
10325 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
10326 will contain the following:
10327
10328 @lisp
10329 (nnspool "cache")
10330 @end lisp
10331
10332 Change that to:
10333
10334 @lisp
10335 (nnspool "cache"
10336 (nnspool-spool-directory "~/News/cache/")
10337 (nnspool-nov-directory "~/News/cache/")
10338 (nnspool-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
10339 @end lisp
10340
10341 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
10342 @key{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
10343 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
10344
10345
10346 @node Server Variables
10347 @subsection Server Variables
10348
10349 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
10350 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
10351 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
10352 change the "base" variable after the variables have been loaded, you
10353 won't change the "derived" variables.
10354
10355 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
10356 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
10357 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
10358 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
10359 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
10360 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
10361 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
10362 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
10363 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
10364
10365 @lisp
10366 (nnml "public"
10367 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
10368 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
10369 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
10370 @end lisp
10371
10372
10373 @node Servers and Methods
10374 @subsection Servers and Methods
10375
10376 Wherever you would normally use a select method
10377 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
10378 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
10379 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
10380 over.
10381
10382
10383 @node Unavailable Servers
10384 @subsection Unavailable Servers
10385
10386 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
10387 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
10388 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
10389 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
10390 actually the case or not.
10391
10392 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
10393 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
10394 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
10395 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
10396 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
10397 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
10398 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
10399 it will regard that server as ``down''.
10400
10401 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
10402 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
10403
10404 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{The Server Buffer}) and poke it
10405 with the following commands:
10406
10407 @table @kbd
10408
10409 @item O
10410 @kindex O (Server)
10411 @findex gnus-server-open-server
10412 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
10413 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
10414
10415 @item C
10416 @kindex C (Server)
10417 @findex gnus-server-close-server
10418 Close the connection (if any) to the server
10419 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
10420
10421 @item D
10422 @kindex D (Server)
10423 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
10424 Mark the current server as unreachable
10425 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
10426
10427 @item M-o
10428 @kindex M-o (Server)
10429 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
10430 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
10431 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
10432
10433 @item M-c
10434 @kindex M-c (Server)
10435 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
10436 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
10437 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
10438
10439 @item R
10440 @kindex R (Server)
10441 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
10442 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
10443 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
10444
10445 @end table
10446
10447
10448 @node Getting News
10449 @section Getting News
10450 @cindex reading news
10451 @cindex news back ends
10452
10453 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
10454 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @sc{nntp} server,
10455 or it can read from a local spool.
10456
10457 @menu
10458 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @sc{nntp} server.
10459 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
10460 @end menu
10461
10462
10463 @node NNTP
10464 @subsection @sc{nntp}
10465 @cindex nntp
10466
10467 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @sc{nntp} server is rather easy.
10468 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @sc{nntp}
10469 server as the, uhm, address.
10470
10471 If the @sc{nntp} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
10472 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
10473 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
10474 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
10475
10476 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
10477 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
10478 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
10479
10480 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
10481 server:
10482
10483 @table @code
10484
10485 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
10486 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
10487 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
10488 @cindex authinfo
10489 @cindex authentication
10490 @cindex nntp authentication
10491 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
10492 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
10493 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
10494 commands to the @sc{nntp} server after it has been contacted. By
10495 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
10496 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
10497 present in this hook.
10498
10499 @item nntp-authinfo-function
10500 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
10501 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
10502 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
10503 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @sc{nntp}
10504 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
10505 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
10506 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
10507 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
10508 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
10509 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
10510 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
10511
10512 @enumerate
10513 @item
10514 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
10515
10516 @item
10517 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
10518
10519 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
10520 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
10521 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
10522 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
10523 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
10524 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
10525 @samp{force} is explained below.
10526
10527 @end enumerate
10528
10529 Here's an example file:
10530
10531 @example
10532 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
10533 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
10534 @end example
10535
10536 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
10537 have to be first, for instance.
10538
10539 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
10540 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
10541 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
10542 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
10543 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
10544 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
10545 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
10546
10547 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
10548 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
10549
10550 @example
10551 default force yes
10552 @end example
10553
10554 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
10555 previously mentioned.
10556
10557 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
10558
10559 @item nntp-server-action-alist
10560 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
10561 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
10562 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
10563 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
10564
10565 @lisp
10566 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
10567 '(("innd" (ding))))
10568 @end lisp
10569
10570 You probably don't want to do that, though.
10571
10572 The default value is
10573
10574 @lisp
10575 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
10576 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
10577 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
10578 @end lisp
10579
10580 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
10581 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
10582
10583 @item nntp-maximum-request
10584 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
10585 If the @sc{nntp} server doesn't support @sc{nov} headers, this back end
10586 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
10587 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
10588 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
10589 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
10590 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
10591
10592 @item nntp-connection-timeout
10593 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
10594 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
10595 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @sc{nntp} servers not
10596 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
10597 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
10598 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
10599 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
10600 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
10601 no timeouts are done.
10602
10603 @c @item nntp-command-timeout
10604 @c @vindex nntp-command-timeout
10605 @c @cindex PPP connections
10606 @c @cindex dynamic IP addresses
10607 @c If you're running Gnus on a machine that has a dynamically assigned
10608 @c address, Gnus may become confused. If the address of your machine
10609 @c changes after connecting to the @sc{nntp} server, Gnus will simply sit
10610 @c waiting forever for replies from the server. To help with this
10611 @c unfortunate problem, you can set this command to a number. Gnus will
10612 @c then, if it sits waiting for a reply from the server longer than that
10613 @c number of seconds, shut down the connection, start a new one, and resend
10614 @c the command. This should hopefully be transparent to the user. A
10615 @c likely number is 30 seconds.
10616 @c
10617 @c @item nntp-retry-on-break
10618 @c @vindex nntp-retry-on-break
10619 @c If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you can also @kbd{C-g} if Gnus
10620 @c hangs. This will have much the same effect as the command timeout
10621 @c described above.
10622
10623 @item nntp-server-hook
10624 @vindex nntp-server-hook
10625 This hook is run as the last step when connecting to an @sc{nntp}
10626 server.
10627
10628 @findex nntp-open-rlogin
10629 @findex nntp-open-telnet
10630 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
10631 @item nntp-open-connection-function
10632 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
10633 This function is used to connect to the remote system. Four pre-made
10634 functions are supplied:
10635
10636 @table @code
10637 @item nntp-open-network-stream
10638 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
10639 remote system.
10640
10641 @item nntp-open-rlogin
10642 Does an @samp{rlogin} on the
10643 remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet} to the @sc{nntp} server
10644 available there.
10645
10646 @code{nntp-open-rlogin}-related variables:
10647
10648 @table @code
10649
10650 @item nntp-rlogin-program
10651 @vindex nntp-rlogin-program
10652 Program used to log in on remote machines. The default is @samp{rsh},
10653 but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
10654
10655 @item nntp-rlogin-parameters
10656 @vindex nntp-rlogin-parameters
10657 This list will be used as the parameter list given to @code{rsh}.
10658
10659 @item nntp-rlogin-user-name
10660 @vindex nntp-rlogin-user-name
10661 User name on the remote system.
10662
10663 @end table
10664
10665 @item nntp-open-telnet
10666 Does a @samp{telnet} to the remote system and then another @samp{telnet}
10667 to get to the @sc{nntp} server.
10668
10669 @code{nntp-open-telnet}-related variables:
10670
10671 @table @code
10672 @item nntp-telnet-command
10673 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
10674 Command used to start @code{telnet}.
10675
10676 @item nntp-telnet-switches
10677 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
10678 List of strings to be used as the switches to the @code{telnet} command.
10679
10680 @item nntp-telnet-user-name
10681 @vindex nntp-telnet-user-name
10682 User name for log in on the remote system.
10683
10684 @item nntp-telnet-passwd
10685 @vindex nntp-telnet-passwd
10686 Password to use when logging in.
10687
10688 @item nntp-telnet-parameters
10689 @vindex nntp-telnet-parameters
10690 A list of strings executed as a command after logging in
10691 via @code{telnet}.
10692
10693 @item nntp-telnet-shell-prompt
10694 @vindex nntp-telnet-shell-prompt
10695 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the remote machine. The default is
10696 @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
10697
10698 @item nntp-open-telnet-envuser
10699 @vindex nntp-open-telnet-envuser
10700 If non-@code{nil}, the @code{telnet} session (client and server both)
10701 will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for login name.
10702 This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
10703
10704 @end table
10705
10706 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
10707 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
10708 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use this
10709 you must have SSLeay installed
10710 (@uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL}, and you also need
10711 @file{ssl.el} (from the W3 distribution, for instance). You then
10712 define a server as follows:
10713
10714 @lisp
10715 ;; Type `C-c C-c' after you've finished editing.
10716 ;;
10717 ;; "snews" is port 563 and is predefined
10718 ;; in our /etc/services
10719 ;;
10720 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
10721 (nntp-open-connection-function
10722 nntp-open-ssl-stream)
10723 (nntp-port-number "snews")
10724 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
10725 @end lisp
10726
10727 @end table
10728
10729 @item nntp-end-of-line
10730 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
10731 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @sc{nntp}
10732 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
10733 using @code{rlogin} to talk to the server.
10734
10735 @item nntp-rlogin-user-name
10736 @vindex nntp-rlogin-user-name
10737 User name on the remote system when using the @code{rlogin} connect
10738 function.
10739
10740 @item nntp-address
10741 @vindex nntp-address
10742 The address of the remote system running the @sc{nntp} server.
10743
10744 @item nntp-port-number
10745 @vindex nntp-port-number
10746 Port number to connect to when using the @code{nntp-open-network-stream}
10747 connect function.
10748
10749 @item nntp-buggy-select
10750 @vindex nntp-buggy-select
10751 Set this to non-@code{nil} if your select routine is buggy.
10752
10753 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
10754 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
10755 If the @sc{nntp} server does not support @sc{nov}, you could set this
10756 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @sc{nov}
10757 can be used.
10758
10759 @item nntp-xover-commands
10760 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
10761 @cindex nov
10762 @cindex XOVER
10763 List of strings used as commands to fetch @sc{nov} lines from a
10764 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
10765 "XOVERVIEW")}.
10766
10767 @item nntp-nov-gap
10768 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
10769 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @sc{nov} lines to
10770 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
10771 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
10772 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @sc{nov}
10773 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
10774 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
10775 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
10776 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
10777 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
10778 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
10779
10780 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
10781 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
10782 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @sc{nntp} server.
10783
10784 @item nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
10785 @vindex nntp-warn-about-losing-connection
10786 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, some noise will be made when a
10787 server closes connection.
10788
10789 @item nntp-record-commands
10790 @vindex nntp-record-commands
10791 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
10792 @sc{nntp} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
10793 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@sc{nntp} connection
10794 that doesn't seem to work.
10795
10796 @end table
10797
10798
10799 @node News Spool
10800 @subsection News Spool
10801 @cindex nnspool
10802 @cindex news spool
10803
10804 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
10805 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
10806 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
10807 instance.
10808
10809 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
10810 anything else) as the address.
10811
10812 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
10813 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
10814 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
10815 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
10816
10817 @table @code
10818
10819 @item nnspool-inews-program
10820 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
10821 Program used to post an article.
10822
10823 @item nnspool-inews-switches
10824 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
10825 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
10826
10827 @item nnspool-spool-directory
10828 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
10829 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
10830 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
10831
10832 @item nnspool-nov-directory
10833 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
10834 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @sc{nov} files. This is normally
10835 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
10836
10837 @item nnspool-lib-dir
10838 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
10839 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
10840
10841 @item nnspool-active-file
10842 @vindex nnspool-active-file
10843 The name of the active file.
10844
10845 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
10846 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
10847 The name of the group descriptions file.
10848
10849 @item nnspool-history-file
10850 @vindex nnspool-history-file
10851 The name of the news history file.
10852
10853 @item nnspool-active-times-file
10854 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
10855 The name of the active date file.
10856
10857 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
10858 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
10859 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @sc{nov} files
10860 that it finds.
10861
10862 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
10863 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
10864 @cindex sed
10865 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
10866 relevant portion from the overview file. If nil, @code{nnspool} will
10867 load the entire file into a buffer and process it there.
10868
10869 @end table
10870
10871
10872 @node Getting Mail
10873 @section Getting Mail
10874 @cindex reading mail
10875 @cindex mail
10876
10877 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
10878 course.
10879
10880 @menu
10881 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
10882 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
10883 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
10884 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
10885 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
10886 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
10887 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
10888 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
10889 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
10890 * Washing Mail:: Removing gruft from the mail you get.
10891 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
10892 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
10893 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
10894 @end menu
10895
10896
10897 @node Mail in a Newsreader
10898 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
10899
10900 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
10901 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
10902 of a culture shock.
10903
10904 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
10905 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
10906
10907 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
10908 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
10909 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
10910 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
10911
10912 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
10913
10914 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
10915 deleted? How awful!
10916
10917 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
10918 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
10919 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
10920 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @pxref{Expiring
10921 Mail}.
10922
10923 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
10924 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
10925 they want to treat a message.
10926
10927 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
10928 via SMTP, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
10929 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
10930 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
10931 archived somewhere else.
10932
10933 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
10934 These are transported via @sc{nntp}, and are therefore news. But we may need
10935 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
10936 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
10937 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
10938
10939 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
10940 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
10941 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
10942
10943 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
10944 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
10945 differently.
10946
10947 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
10948 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
10949 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
10950 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
10951 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
10952
10953 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
10954 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
10955 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
10956 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
10957 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
10958 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
10959 You Do.)
10960
10961
10962 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
10963 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
10964
10965 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
10966 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
10967 and things will happen automatically.
10968
10969 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a "one file per
10970 mail" back end), you could put the following in your @file{.gnus} file:
10971
10972 @lisp
10973 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
10974 '((nnml "private")))
10975 @end lisp
10976
10977 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
10978 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
10979 directory, which is @code{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
10980 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
10981 like any other group.
10982
10983 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
10984
10985 @lisp
10986 (setq nnmail-split-methods
10987 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
10988 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
10989 ("other" "")))
10990 @end lisp
10991
10992 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
10993 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
10994 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
10995 last group.
10996
10997 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
10998 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
10999 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
11000
11001
11002 @node Splitting Mail
11003 @subsection Splitting Mail
11004 @cindex splitting mail
11005 @cindex mail splitting
11006
11007 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
11008 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
11009 to be split into groups.
11010
11011 @lisp
11012 (setq nnmail-split-methods
11013 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
11014 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
11015 ("mail.other" "")))
11016 @end lisp
11017
11018 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
11019 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
11020 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
11021 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
11022 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
11023 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
11024 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
11025
11026 @lisp
11027 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
11028 @end lisp
11029
11030 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
11031 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
11032 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
11033 mail belongs in that group.
11034
11035 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
11036 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{} so that it matches any mails
11037 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
11038 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first
11039 rule to make a match will "win", unless you have crossposting enabled.
11040 In that case, all matching rules will "win".)
11041
11042 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
11043 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
11044 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
11045 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
11046 thinks should carry this mail message.
11047
11048 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
11049 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
11050 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
11051 @samp{From } line to something else.
11052
11053 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
11054 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
11055 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
11056 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
11057 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{}) group.
11058
11059 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
11060 @cindex crosspost
11061 @cindex links
11062 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
11063 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
11064 links. If that's the case for you, set
11065 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
11066 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
11067
11068 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
11069 @kindex nnmail-split-history
11070 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
11071 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
11072 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
11073 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
11074 Group Commands}).
11075
11076 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
11077 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
11078 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
11079 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
11080 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
11081 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
11082 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
11083 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
11084 month's rent money.
11085
11086
11087 @node Mail Sources
11088 @subsection Mail Sources
11089
11090 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from a
11091 POP mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a maildir, for
11092 instance.
11093
11094 @menu
11095 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
11096 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
11097 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
11098 @end menu
11099
11100
11101 @node Mail Source Specifiers
11102 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
11103 @cindex POP
11104 @cindex mail server
11105 @cindex procmail
11106 @cindex mail spool
11107 @cindex mail source
11108
11109 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
11110 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
11111
11112 Here's an example:
11113
11114 @lisp
11115 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
11116 @end lisp
11117
11118 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
11119 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
11120 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
11121 default values.
11122
11123 The following mail source types are available:
11124
11125 @table @code
11126 @item file
11127 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
11128
11129 Keywords:
11130
11131 @table @code
11132 @item :path
11133 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @code{MAIL}
11134 environment variable or @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}.
11135 @end table
11136
11137 An example file mail source:
11138
11139 @lisp
11140 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
11141 @end lisp
11142
11143 Or using the default file name:
11144
11145 @lisp
11146 (file)
11147 @end lisp
11148
11149 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best to
11150 use POP or @sc{imap} or the like to fetch the mail. You can not use ange-ftp
11151 file names here---it has no way to lock the mail spool while moving the
11152 mail.
11153
11154 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
11155
11156 @lisp
11157 (setq mail-sources
11158 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
11159 @end lisp
11160
11161 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
11162
11163 @example
11164 #!/bin/sh
11165 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
11166 # flu@@iki.fi
11167
11168 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
11169 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
11170 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
11171 @end example
11172
11173 Alter this script to fit find the @samp{movemail} you want to use.
11174
11175
11176 @item directory
11177 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used when
11178 you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files. Setting
11179 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-nil force Gnus to
11180 scan the mail source only once.
11181
11182 Keywords:
11183
11184 @table @code
11185 @item :path
11186 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
11187 value.
11188
11189 @item :suffix
11190 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
11191 @samp{.spool}.
11192
11193 @item :predicate
11194 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
11195 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
11196 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
11197 predicate are considered.
11198
11199 @item :prescript
11200 @itemx :postscript
11201 Script run before/after fetching mail.
11202
11203 @end table
11204
11205 An example directory mail source:
11206
11207 @lisp
11208 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
11209 :suffix ".prcml")
11210 @end lisp
11211
11212 @item pop
11213 Get mail from a POP server.
11214
11215 Keywords:
11216
11217 @table @code
11218 @item :server
11219 The name of the POP server. The default is taken from the
11220 @code{MAILHOST} environment variable.
11221
11222 @item :port
11223 The port number of the POP server. This can be a number (e.g.@:
11224 @samp{:port 110}) or a string (e.g.@: @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
11225 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
11226 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
11227 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
11228
11229 @item :user
11230 The user name to give to the POP server. The default is the login
11231 name.
11232
11233 @item :password
11234 The password to give to the POP server. If not specified, the user is
11235 prompted.
11236
11237 @item :program
11238 The program to use to fetch mail from the POP server. This should be
11239 a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
11240
11241 @example
11242 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
11243 @end example
11244
11245 The valid format specifier characters are:
11246
11247 @table @samp
11248 @item t
11249 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
11250 included in this string.
11251
11252 @item s
11253 The name of the server.
11254
11255 @item P
11256 The port number of the server.
11257
11258 @item u
11259 The user name to use.
11260
11261 @item p
11262 The password to use.
11263 @end table
11264
11265 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
11266 corresponding keywords.
11267
11268 @item :prescript
11269 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
11270 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
11271
11272 @item :postscript
11273 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
11274 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
11275
11276 @item :function
11277 The function to use to fetch mail from the POP server. The function is
11278 called with one parameter---the name of the file where the mail should
11279 be moved to.
11280
11281 @item :authentication
11282 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
11283 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
11284 @code{password}.
11285
11286 @end table
11287
11288 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
11289 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used.
11290
11291 Here are some examples. Fetch from the default POP server, using the
11292 default user name, and default fetcher:
11293
11294 @lisp
11295 (pop)
11296 @end lisp
11297
11298 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
11299
11300 @lisp
11301 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
11302 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
11303 @end lisp
11304
11305 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
11306
11307 @lisp
11308 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
11309 @end lisp
11310
11311 @item maildir
11312 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
11313 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
11314 contains exactly one mail.
11315
11316 Keywords:
11317
11318 @table @code
11319 @item :path
11320 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
11321 taken from the @code{MAILDIR} environment variable or
11322 @samp{~/Maildir/}.
11323 @item :subdirs
11324 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
11325 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
11326
11327 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
11328 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
11329 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
11330 @c below.
11331
11332 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
11333 from locking problems).
11334
11335 @end table
11336
11337 Two example maildir mail sources:
11338
11339 @lisp
11340 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
11341 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
11342 @end lisp
11343
11344 @lisp
11345 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
11346 :subdirs ("new"))
11347 @end lisp
11348
11349 @item imap
11350 Get mail from a @sc{imap} server. If you don't want to use @sc{imap}
11351 as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie with nnimap), for
11352 some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar to a POP server
11353 and fetches articles from a given @sc{imap} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for
11354 more information.
11355
11356 Keywords:
11357
11358 @table @code
11359 @item :server
11360 The name of the @sc{imap} server. The default is taken from the
11361 @code{MAILHOST} environment variable.
11362
11363 @item :port
11364 The port number of the @sc{imap} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
11365 @samp{993} for SSL connections.
11366
11367 @item :user
11368 The user name to give to the @sc{imap} server. The default is the login
11369 name.
11370
11371 @item :password
11372 The password to give to the @sc{imap} server. If not specified, the user is
11373 prompted.
11374
11375 @item :stream
11376 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
11377 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
11378 @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{ssl} or the default @samp{network}.
11379
11380 @item :authentication
11381 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is one
11382 of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now, this
11383 means @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default
11384 @samp{login}.
11385
11386 @item :program
11387 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
11388 mapped into the `imap-shell-program' variable. This should be a
11389 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
11390
11391 @example
11392 ssh %s imapd
11393 @end example
11394
11395 The valid format specifier characters are:
11396
11397 @table @samp
11398 @item s
11399 The name of the server.
11400
11401 @item l
11402 User name from `imap-default-user'.
11403
11404 @item p
11405 The port number of the server.
11406 @end table
11407
11408 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
11409 corresponding keywords.
11410
11411 @item :mailbox
11412 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
11413 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
11414
11415 @item :predicate
11416 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
11417 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
11418 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @sc{imap} client and mark some
11419 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{nil}.
11420 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
11421 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 §6.4.4.
11422
11423 @item :fetchflag
11424 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
11425 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
11426 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
11427 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 §2.3.2.
11428
11429 @item :dontexpunge
11430 If non-nil, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the mailbox
11431 after finishing the fetch.
11432
11433 @end table
11434
11435 An example @sc{imap} mail source:
11436
11437 @lisp
11438 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
11439 :stream kerberos4
11440 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
11441 @end lisp
11442
11443 @item webmail
11444 Get mail from a webmail server, such as www.hotmail.com,
11445 webmail.netscape.com, www.netaddress.com, www.my-deja.com.
11446
11447 NOTE: Now mail.yahoo.com provides POP3 service, so @sc{pop} mail source
11448 is suggested.
11449
11450 NOTE: Webmail largely depends cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
11451 required for url "4.0pre.46".
11452
11453 WARNING: Mails may lost. NO WARRANTY.
11454
11455 Keywords:
11456
11457 @table @code
11458 @item :subtype
11459 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
11460 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
11461
11462 @item :user
11463 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
11464 name.
11465
11466 @item :password
11467 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
11468 prompted.
11469
11470 @item :dontexpunge
11471 If non-nil, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to trash
11472 folder after finishing the fetch.
11473
11474 @end table
11475
11476 An example webmail source:
11477
11478 @lisp
11479 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
11480 :user "user-name"
11481 :password "secret")
11482 @end lisp
11483 @end table
11484
11485 @table @dfn
11486 @item Common Keywords
11487 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
11488
11489 Keywords:
11490
11491 @table @code
11492 @item :plugged
11493 If non-nil, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you use
11494 directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this example:
11495
11496 @lisp
11497 (setq mail-sources
11498 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
11499 :suffix ""
11500 :plugged t)))
11501 @end lisp
11502
11503 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
11504 useful when you use local mail and news.
11505
11506 @end table
11507 @end table
11508
11509 @subsubsection Function Interface
11510
11511 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
11512 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
11513 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
11514 consider the following mail-source setting:
11515
11516 @lisp
11517 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
11518 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
11519 @end lisp
11520
11521 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
11522 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
11523 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
11524 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
11525 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
11526
11527 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
11528
11529
11530 @node Mail Source Customization
11531 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
11532
11533 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
11534 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
11535 variables.
11536
11537 @table @code
11538 @item mail-source-crash-box
11539 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
11540 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is
11541 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
11542
11543 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
11544 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
11545 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them.
11546
11547 @item mail-source-directory
11548 @vindex mail-source-directory
11549 Directory where files (if any) will be stored. The default is
11550 @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for is to say
11551 where the incoming files will be stored if the previous variable is
11552 @code{nil}.
11553
11554 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
11555 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
11556 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
11557 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
11558 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
11559 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil}.
11560
11561 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
11562 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
11563 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
11564
11565 @end table
11566
11567
11568 @node Fetching Mail
11569 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
11570
11571 @vindex mail-sources
11572 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
11573 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
11574 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
11575 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
11576
11577 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
11578 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
11579 themselves.
11580
11581 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a POP
11582 mail server, you'd say something like:
11583
11584 @lisp
11585 (setq mail-sources
11586 '((file)
11587 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11588 :password "secret")))
11589 @end lisp
11590
11591 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
11592
11593 @lisp
11594 (setq mail-sources
11595 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
11596 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11597 :user "user-name"
11598 :port "pop3"
11599 :password "secret")))
11600 @end lisp
11601
11602
11603 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
11604 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
11605 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
11606 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
11607 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
11608 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
11609
11610
11611
11612 @node Mail Back End Variables
11613 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
11614
11615 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
11616 mail back ends.
11617
11618 @table @code
11619 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
11620 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
11621 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
11622 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
11623
11624 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
11625 @item nnmail-split-hook
11626 @findex article-decode-encoded-words
11627 @findex RFC 1522 decoding
11628 @findex RFC 2047 decoding
11629 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
11630 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
11631 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
11632 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
11633 in the buffer will show up in any files.
11634 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
11635 to this hook.
11636
11637 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
11638 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
11639 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
11640 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
11641 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
11642 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
11643 starting to handle the new mail) and
11644 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
11645 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
11646 default file modes the new mail files get:
11647
11648 @lisp
11649 (add-hook 'gnus-pre-get-new-mail-hook
11650 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
11651
11652 (add-hook 'gnus-post-get-new-mail-hook
11653 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
11654 @end lisp
11655
11656 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
11657 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
11658 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
11659 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
11660 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
11661 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
11662 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
11663
11664 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
11665 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
11666 @findex delete-file
11667 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
11668
11669 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
11670 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
11671 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
11672 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
11673 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
11674
11675 @end table
11676
11677
11678 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
11679 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
11680 @cindex mail splitting
11681 @cindex fancy mail splitting
11682
11683 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
11684 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
11685 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
11686 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
11687 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
11688 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
11689
11690 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
11691
11692 @lisp
11693 ;; Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of
11694 ;; the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group
11695 ;; from real errors.
11696 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
11697 "mail.misc"))
11698 ;; Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant
11699 ;; groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the
11700 ;; (ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.
11701 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
11702 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
11703 ;; Other mailing lists...
11704 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
11705 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
11706 ;; Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent
11707 ;; cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to
11708 ;; the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the
11709 ;; message was really cross-posted.
11710 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
11711 (any "mypackage@@somewhere\" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
11712 ;; People...
11713 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
11714 ;; Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.
11715 "misc.misc")
11716 @end lisp
11717
11718 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a (possibly)
11719 recursive structure where each split may contain other splits. Here are
11720 the five possible split syntaxes:
11721
11722 @enumerate
11723
11724 @item
11725 @samp{group}: If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group
11726 name. Normal regexp match expansion will be done. See below for
11727 examples.
11728
11729 @item
11730 @code{(@var{field} @var{value} @code{[-} @var{restrict}
11731 @code{[@dots{}]}@code{]} @var{split})}: If the split is a list, the
11732 first element of which is a string, then store the message as
11733 specified by @var{split}, if header @var{field} (a regexp) contains
11734 @var{value} (also a regexp). If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp)
11735 matches some string after @var{field} and before the end of the
11736 matched @var{value}, the @var{split} is ignored. If none of the
11737 @var{restrict} clauses match, @var{split} is processed.
11738
11739 @item
11740 @code{(| @var{split}@dots{})}: If the split is a list, and the first
11741 element is @code{|} (vertical bar), then process each @var{split} until
11742 one of them matches. A @var{split} is said to match if it will cause
11743 the mail message to be stored in one or more groups.
11744
11745 @item
11746 @code{(& @var{split}@dots{})}: If the split is a list, and the first
11747 element is @code{&}, then process all @var{split}s in the list.
11748
11749 @item
11750 @code{junk}: If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save
11751 this message. Use with extreme caution.
11752
11753 @item
11754 @code{(: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})}: If the split is
11755 a list, and the first element is @code{:}, then the second element will
11756 be called as a function with @var{args} given as arguments. The
11757 function should return a @var{split}.
11758
11759 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
11760 body of the messages:
11761
11762 @lisp
11763 (defun split-on-body ()
11764 (save-excursion
11765 (set-buffer " *nnmail incoming*")
11766 (goto-char (point-min))
11767 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
11768 "string.group")))
11769 @end lisp
11770
11771 @item
11772 @code{(! @var{func} @var{split})}: If the split is a list, and the first
11773 element is @code{!}, then SPLIT will be processed, and FUNC will be
11774 called as a function with the result of SPLIT as argument. FUNC should
11775 return a split.
11776
11777 @item
11778 @code{nil}: If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
11779
11780 @end enumerate
11781
11782 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
11783 @var{value} must match a complete word according to the fundamental mode
11784 syntax table. You can use @code{.*} in the regexps to match partial
11785 field names or words. In other words, all @var{value}'s are wrapped in
11786 @samp{\<} and @samp{\>} pairs.
11787
11788 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
11789 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be lisp symbols, in that case they
11790 are expanded as specified by the variable
11791 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells, where
11792 the @code{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @code{cdr} contains the associated
11793 value.
11794
11795 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
11796 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
11797 when all this splitting is performed.
11798
11799 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
11800 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
11801 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
11802
11803 @example
11804 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
11805 @end example
11806
11807 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
11808 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
11809
11810 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
11811 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
11812 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
11813 groupings 1 through 9.
11814
11815 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
11816 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
11817 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
11818 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
11819 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
11820 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
11821 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
11822 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
11823 it once per thread.
11824
11825 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to a
11826 non-nil value. And then you can include
11827 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} using the colon feature, like so:
11828 @lisp
11829 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
11830 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
11831 ;; other splits go here
11832 ))
11833 @end lisp
11834
11835 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
11836 non-nil, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees in the
11837 file specified by the variable @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file},
11838 together with the group it is in (the group is omitted for non-mail
11839 messages). When mail splitting is invoked, the function
11840 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks at the References (and
11841 In-Reply-To) header of each message to split and searches the file
11842 specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file} for the message ids.
11843 When it has found a parent, it returns the corresponding group name. It
11844 is recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
11845 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
11846 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some 300
11847 kBytes in size.)
11848 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
11849 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
11850 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
11851 messages goes into the new group.
11852
11853
11854 @node Group Mail Splitting
11855 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
11856 @cindex mail splitting
11857 @cindex group mail splitting
11858
11859 @findex gnus-group-split
11860 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
11861 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
11862 You just have to set @var{to-list} and/or @var{to-address} in group
11863 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
11864 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
11865 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
11866 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @var{to-list} or
11867 @var{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
11868
11869 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
11870 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @var{extra-aliases} group
11871 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
11872 rather use a regular expression, set @var{split-regexp}.
11873
11874 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
11875 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
11876 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
11877 @var{to-list}, @var{to-address}, all of @var{extra-aliases} and all
11878 matches of @var{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
11879 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
11880 @var{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
11881
11882 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
11883 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
11884 parameter @var{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
11885 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
11886 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @var{split-spec} may be set to
11887 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
11888 @code{gnus-group-split}.
11889
11890 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
11891 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
11892 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
11893 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
11894 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
11895 some group has @var{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
11896 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
11897 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
11898 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
11899 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
11900 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
11901 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
11902 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
11903
11904 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
11905 been defined:
11906
11907 @example
11908 nnml:mail.bar:
11909 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
11910 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
11911 nnml:mail.foo:
11912 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
11913 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
11914 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
11915 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
11916 nnml:mail.others:
11917 ((split-spec . catch-all))
11918 @end example
11919
11920 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
11921 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
11922 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
11923
11924 @lisp
11925 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
11926 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
11927 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
11928 "mail.others")
11929 @end lisp
11930
11931 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
11932 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
11933 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
11934 splits like this:
11935
11936 @lisp
11937 (: gnus-mlsplt-fancy GROUPS NO-CROSSPOST CATCH-ALL)
11938 @end lisp
11939
11940 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
11941 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
11942 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
11943 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fallback
11944 fancy split, used like @var{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
11945 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @var{split-regexp} matches the
11946 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
11947 Otherwise, if some group has @var{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
11948 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
11949
11950 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
11951 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
11952 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
11953 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
11954 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
11955 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
11956 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
11957 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
11958 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
11959
11960 @findex gnus-group-split-update
11961 However, if you change group parameters, you have to update
11962 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
11963 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
11964 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
11965 you. For example, add to your @file{.gnus}:
11966
11967 @lisp
11968 (gnus-group-split-setup AUTO-UPDATE CATCH-ALL)
11969 @end lisp
11970
11971 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
11972 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
11973 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
11974 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
11975 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
11976 value.
11977
11978 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
11979 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
11980 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
11981 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
11982
11983 @node Incorporating Old Mail
11984 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
11985
11986 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
11987 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
11988 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
11989 your mail groups.
11990
11991 Doing so can be quite easy.
11992
11993 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
11994 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
11995 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
11996 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
11997 your @code{nnml} groups.
11998
11999 Here's how:
12000
12001 @enumerate
12002 @item
12003 Go to the group buffer.
12004
12005 @item
12006 Type @kbd{G f} and give the name of the mbox file when prompted to create an
12007 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12008
12009 @item
12010 Type @key{SPC} to enter the newly created group.
12011
12012 @item
12013 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
12014 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
12015
12016 @item
12017 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
12018 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
12019 @end enumerate
12020
12021 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
12022 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
12023 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
12024 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
12025 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
12026
12027 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
12028 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
12029 using the new mail back end.
12030
12031
12032 @node Expiring Mail
12033 @subsection Expiring Mail
12034 @cindex article expiry
12035
12036 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
12037 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
12038 different approach to mail reading.
12039
12040 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
12041 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
12042 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
12043 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
12044 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
12045 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
12046 course.
12047
12048 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
12049 articles as @dfn{expirable}. This does not mean that the articles will
12050 disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
12051 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
12052 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
12053 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
12054 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
12055 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
12056
12057 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
12058 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Groups that
12059 match the regular expression @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will
12060 have all articles that you read marked as expirable automatically. All
12061 articles marked as expirable have an @samp{E} in the first
12062 column in the summary buffer.
12063
12064 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
12065 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
12066 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
12067 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
12068 @file{.gnus} file:
12069
12070 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
12071 @lisp
12072 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
12073 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
12074 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
12075 @end lisp
12076
12077 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
12078 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
12079 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
12080 groups expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
12081 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
12082
12083 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
12084 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
12085
12086 @lisp
12087 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
12088 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
12089 @end lisp
12090
12091 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
12092 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
12093
12094 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
12095 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
12096 don't really mix very well.
12097
12098 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
12099 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
12100 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
12101 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
12102 days.
12103
12104 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
12105 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
12106 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
12107 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
12108 everywhere else:
12109
12110 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
12111 @lisp
12112 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
12113 (lambda (group)
12114 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
12115 31)
12116 ((string= group "mail.junk")
12117 1)
12118 ((string= group "important")
12119 'never)
12120 (t
12121 6))))
12122 @end lisp
12123
12124 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
12125 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
12126
12127 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
12128 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
12129 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
12130 @code{never}.
12131
12132 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
12133 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
12134
12135 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
12136 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
12137 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them to
12138 other groups instead of deleting them. The variable @code{nnmail-expiry-target}
12139 (and the @code{expiry-target} group parameter) controls this. The
12140 variable supplies a default value for all groups, which can be
12141 overridden for specific groups by the group parameter.
12142 default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a string (which
12143 should be the name of the group the message should be moved to), or a
12144 function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to the message in
12145 question, and with the name of the group being moved from as its
12146 parameter) which should return a target -- either a group name or
12147 @code{delete}.
12148
12149 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
12150 @lisp
12151 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
12152 @end lisp
12153
12154
12155 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
12156 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
12157 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
12158 easier for procmail users.
12159
12160 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
12161 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
12162 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
12163 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
12164 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
12165 caution. Even more dangerous is the
12166 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
12167 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
12168 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
12169 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
12170 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
12171 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
12172 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
12173 with! So there!
12174
12175 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
12176
12177 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
12178 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
12179 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
12180 auto-expire turned on.
12181
12182
12183 @node Washing Mail
12184 @subsection Washing Mail
12185 @cindex mail washing
12186 @cindex list server brain damage
12187 @cindex incoming mail treatment
12188
12189 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
12190 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
12191 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
12192 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
12193 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
12194 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
12195
12196 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
12197 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
12198 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
12199 laugh.
12200
12201 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
12202 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
12203 storing the mail to disc. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
12204 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
12205
12206 @table @code
12207 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
12208 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
12209 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
12210 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
12211 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
12212
12213 @table @code
12214 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
12215 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
12216 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
12217 Emacs running on MS machines.
12218
12219 @end table
12220
12221 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
12222 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
12223 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
12224 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
12225
12226 @table @code
12227 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
12228 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
12229 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
12230 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
12231
12232 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
12233 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
12234 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
12235 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
12236 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
12237 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
12238 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
12239 @code{\\(..\\)}.
12240
12241 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
12242 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
12243
12244 @lisp
12245 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
12246 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
12247 @end lisp
12248
12249 This can also be done non-destructively with
12250 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
12251
12252 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
12253 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
12254 Translate all tab characters into space characters.
12255
12256 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
12257 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
12258 @cindex Eudora
12259 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
12260 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
12261 @code{References} headers.
12262
12263 @end table
12264
12265 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
12266 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
12267 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
12268 include:
12269
12270 @table @code
12271 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
12272 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
12273 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
12274
12275 @end table
12276 @end table
12277
12278
12279 @node Duplicates
12280 @subsection Duplicates
12281
12282 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
12283 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
12284 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
12285 @cindex duplicate mails
12286 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
12287 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
12288 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
12289 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
12290 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
12291 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
12292 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
12293 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
12294 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
12295 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
12296 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
12297 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
12298 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
12299
12300 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
12301 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
12302 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
12303 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
12304
12305 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
12306 @code{nil}.
12307
12308 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
12309 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
12310 methods:
12311
12312 @lisp
12313 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
12314 '(| ;; Messages duplicates go to a separate group.
12315 ("gnus-warning" "duplication of message" "duplicate")
12316 ;; Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.
12317 (any mail "mail.misc")
12318 ;; Other rules.
12319 [ ... ] ))
12320 @end lisp
12321
12322 Or something like:
12323 @lisp
12324 (setq nnmail-split-methods
12325 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:")
12326 ;; Other rules.
12327 [...]))
12328 @end lisp
12329
12330 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
12331 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
12332 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
12333 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
12334 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
12335
12336
12337 @node Not Reading Mail
12338 @subsection Not Reading Mail
12339
12340 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
12341 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
12342 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
12343
12344 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
12345 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
12346 mail, which should help.
12347
12348 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
12349 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
12350 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
12351 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
12352 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
12353 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
12354 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old @sc{rmail}
12355 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
12356 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
12357 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
12358 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
12359
12360 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
12361 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
12362 incoming mail.
12363
12364
12365 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
12366 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
12367
12368 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
12369 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
12370 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
12371
12372 There are five different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
12373 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
12374 (because it is the fastest and most flexible) is @code{nnml}
12375 (@pxref{Mail Spool}).
12376
12377 @menu
12378 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
12379 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the rmail babyl format.
12380 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
12381 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
12382 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
12383 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
12384 @end menu
12385
12386
12387 @node Unix Mail Box
12388 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
12389 @cindex nnmbox
12390 @cindex unix mail box
12391
12392 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
12393 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
12394 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
12395 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
12396 which group it belongs in.
12397
12398 Virtual server settings:
12399
12400 @table @code
12401 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
12402 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
12403 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory.
12404
12405 @item nnmbox-active-file
12406 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
12407 The name of the active file for the mail box.
12408
12409 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
12410 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
12411 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
12412 into groups.
12413 @end table
12414
12415
12416 @node Rmail Babyl
12417 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
12418 @cindex nnbabyl
12419 @cindex rmail mbox
12420
12421 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
12422 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
12423 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{rmail
12424 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
12425 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
12426
12427 Virtual server settings:
12428
12429 @table @code
12430 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
12431 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
12432 The name of the rmail mbox file.
12433
12434 @item nnbabyl-active-file
12435 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
12436 The name of the active file for the rmail box.
12437
12438 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
12439 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
12440 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail.
12441 @end table
12442
12443
12444 @node Mail Spool
12445 @subsubsection Mail Spool
12446 @cindex nnml
12447 @cindex mail @sc{nov} spool
12448
12449 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
12450 format. It should be used with some caution.
12451
12452 @vindex nnml-directory
12453 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
12454 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
12455 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
12456 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
12457
12458 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
12459 care of all that.
12460
12461 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
12462 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
12463 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
12464 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
12465 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
12466 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
12467 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
12468 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
12469
12470 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
12471 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
12472 @sc{nov} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it the fastest
12473 back end when it comes to reading mail.
12474
12475 Virtual server settings:
12476
12477 @table @code
12478 @item nnml-directory
12479 @vindex nnml-directory
12480 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory.
12481
12482 @item nnml-active-file
12483 @vindex nnml-active-file
12484 The active file for the @code{nnml} server.
12485
12486 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
12487 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
12488 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
12489 Format}.
12490
12491 @item nnml-get-new-mail
12492 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
12493 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail.
12494
12495 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
12496 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
12497 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{nov} files.
12498
12499 @item nnml-nov-file-name
12500 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
12501 The name of the @sc{nov} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
12502
12503 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
12504 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
12505 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
12506
12507 @end table
12508
12509 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
12510 If your @code{nnml} groups and @sc{nov} files get totally out of whack,
12511 you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
12512 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
12513 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
12514 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
12515 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
12516 Commands}).
12517
12518
12519 @node MH Spool
12520 @subsubsection MH Spool
12521 @cindex nnmh
12522 @cindex mh-e mail spool
12523
12524 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
12525 @sc{nov} databases and it doesn't keep an active file. This makes
12526 @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than @code{nnml}, but it also
12527 makes it easier to write procmail scripts for.
12528
12529 Virtual server settings:
12530
12531 @table @code
12532 @item nnmh-directory
12533 @vindex nnmh-directory
12534 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory.
12535
12536 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
12537 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
12538 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail.
12539
12540 @item nnmh-be-safe
12541 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
12542 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
12543 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks they
12544 are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
12545 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
12546 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not have
12547 to set this variable to @code{t}.
12548 @end table
12549
12550
12551 @node Mail Folders
12552 @subsubsection Mail Folders
12553 @cindex nnfolder
12554 @cindex mbox folders
12555 @cindex mail folders
12556
12557 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a separate
12558 file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format. @code{nnfolder}
12559 will add extra headers to keep track of article numbers and arrival
12560 dates.
12561
12562 Virtual server settings:
12563
12564 @table @code
12565 @item nnfolder-directory
12566 @vindex nnfolder-directory
12567 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this directory.
12568
12569 @item nnfolder-active-file
12570 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
12571 The name of the active file.
12572
12573 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
12574 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
12575 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File Format}.
12576
12577 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
12578 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
12579 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail.
12580
12581 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
12582 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
12583 @cindex backup files
12584 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
12585 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If you
12586 wish to switch this off, you could say something like the following in
12587 your @file{.emacs} file:
12588
12589 @lisp
12590 (defun turn-off-backup ()
12591 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
12592
12593 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
12594 @end lisp
12595
12596 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
12597 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
12598 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
12599 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
12600 extract some information from it before removing it.
12601
12602 @end table
12603
12604
12605 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
12606 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
12607 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
12608 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
12609 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
12610 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
12611 though.
12612
12613 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
12614 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
12615
12616 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
12617 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
12618 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
12619 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
12620 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
12621
12622 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
12623 typically done by @sc{nntp} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
12624 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
12625 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @sc{nntp} server), and
12626 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
12627 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
12628 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
12629 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
12630 via NFS).
12631
12632 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
12633 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
12634 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
12635 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
12636
12637 @table @code
12638 @item nnmbox
12639
12640 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
12641 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
12642 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
12643 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
12644 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
12645 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
12646 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
12647 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
12648 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
12649 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
12650 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
12651 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
12652 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
12653 what's where.
12654
12655 @item nnbabyl
12656
12657 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
12658 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
12659 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
12660 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
12661 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
12662 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
12663 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
12664 RMAIL was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
12665 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote RMAIL
12666 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
12667 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
12668 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
12669 headers/status bits stuff. RMAIL itself still exists as well, of
12670 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
12671
12672 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
12673 filesystem, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
12674 look at your mail.
12675
12676 @item nnml
12677
12678 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
12679 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
12680 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
12681 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
12682 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
12683 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
12684 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
12685 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
12686 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
12687 @sc{nntp} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
12688 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
12689 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
12690 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
12691 provided by the active file and overviews.
12692
12693 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
12694 resource which defines available places in the filesystem to put new
12695 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
12696 tight, shared filesystems. But if you live on a personal machine where
12697 the filesystem is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
12698 wins big.
12699
12700 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
12701 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
12702 tiny files.
12703
12704 @item nnmh
12705
12706 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
12707 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
12708 individual files, but with little or no indexing support -- @code{nnmh}
12709 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
12710 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
12711 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
12712 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
12713
12714 @item nnfolder
12715
12716 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
12717 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
12718 itself puts *all* one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
12719 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
12720 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
12721 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
12722 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
12723 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
12724 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
12725
12726 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
12727 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
12728 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
12729 friendly mail back end all over.
12730
12731 @end table
12732
12733
12734 @node Browsing the Web
12735 @section Browsing the Web
12736 @cindex web
12737 @cindex browsing the web
12738 @cindex www
12739 @cindex http
12740
12741 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
12742 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
12743 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
12744 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
12745 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
12746 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
12747 even know what a news group is.
12748
12749 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
12750 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
12751 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
12752 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
12753 you mad in the end.
12754
12755 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
12756 to do it instead?
12757
12758 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
12759 interfaces to these sources.
12760
12761 @menu
12762 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
12763 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
12764 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
12765 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
12766 * Customizing w3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/w3 from Gnus.
12767 @end menu
12768
12769 All the web sources require Emacs/w3 and the url library to work.
12770
12771 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
12772 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @sc{html} data
12773 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
12774 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
12775 though, you should be ok.
12776
12777 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
12778 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
12779 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
12780 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
12781 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
12782
12783
12784 @node Web Searches
12785 @subsection Web Searches
12786 @cindex nnweb
12787 @cindex DejaNews
12788 @cindex Alta Vista
12789 @cindex InReference
12790 @cindex Usenet searches
12791 @cindex searching the Usenet
12792
12793 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
12794 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
12795 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
12796 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
12797 searches without having to use a browser.
12798
12799 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
12800 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
12801 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
12802 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
12803 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
12804
12805 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
12806 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
12807 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
12808 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
12809 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
12810 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
12811 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
12812 engines (DejaNews, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
12813 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
12814 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
12815 group as read.
12816
12817 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
12818 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
12819 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
12820 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
12821 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
12822 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
12823
12824 You must have the @code{url} and @code{w3} package installed to be able
12825 to use @code{nnweb}.
12826
12827 Virtual server variables:
12828
12829 @table @code
12830 @item nnweb-type
12831 @vindex nnweb-type
12832 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
12833 are @code{dejanews}, @code{dejanewsold}, @code{altavista} and
12834 @code{reference}.
12835
12836 @item nnweb-search
12837 @vindex nnweb-search
12838 The search string to feed to the search engine.
12839
12840 @item nnweb-max-hits
12841 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
12842 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
12843 100.
12844
12845 @item nnweb-type-definition
12846 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
12847 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
12848 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
12849 present:
12850
12851 @table @code
12852 @item article
12853 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
12854 understands.
12855
12856 @item map
12857 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
12858
12859 @item search
12860 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
12861
12862 @item address
12863 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
12864 to.
12865
12866 @item id
12867 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
12868 @end table
12869
12870 @end table
12871
12872
12873 @node Slashdot
12874 @subsection Slashdot
12875 @cindex Slashdot
12876 @cindex nnslashdot
12877
12878 Slashdot (@uref{http://slashdot.org/}) is a popular news site, with
12879 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
12880 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
12881
12882 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
12883 following in your @file{.gnus.el} file:
12884
12885 @lisp
12886 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
12887 '((nnslashdot "")))
12888 @end lisp
12889
12890 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
12891 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
12892 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
12893 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
12894 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
12895 Methods}).
12896
12897 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G @key{DEL}}
12898 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12899
12900 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
12901 comments), some light @sc{html}izations will be performed. In
12902 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
12903 @code{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @code{br} added to
12904 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @sc{html}
12905 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
12906 @sc{html} forms.
12907
12908 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
12909
12910 @table @code
12911 @item nnslashdot-threaded
12912 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
12913 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
12914 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
12915 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
12916 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
12917 but much, much slower than untreaded.
12918
12919 @item nnslashdot-login-name
12920 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
12921 The login name to use when posting.
12922
12923 @item nnslashdot-password
12924 @vindex nnslashdot-password
12925 The password to use when posting.
12926
12927 @item nnslashdot-directory
12928 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
12929 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
12930 @samp{~/News/slashdot/}.
12931
12932 @item nnslashdot-active-url
12933 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
12934 The @sc{url} format string that will be used to fetch the information on
12935 news articles and comments. Default:
12936 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
12937
12938 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
12939 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
12940 The @sc{url} format string that will be used to fetch comments. The
12941 default is
12942 @samp{http://slashdot.org/comments.pl?sid=%s&threshold=%d&commentsort=%d&mode=flat&startat=%d}.
12943
12944 @item nnslashdot-article-url
12945 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
12946 The @sc{url} format string that will be used to fetch the news article. The
12947 default is
12948 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
12949
12950 @item nnslashdot-threshold
12951 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
12952 The score threshold. The default is -1.
12953
12954 @item nnslashdot-group-number
12955 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
12956 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
12957 updated. The default is 0.
12958
12959 @end table
12960
12961
12962
12963 @node Ultimate
12964 @subsection Ultimate
12965 @cindex nnultimate
12966 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
12967
12968 The Ultimate Bulletin Board (@uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/}) is
12969 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
12970 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
12971 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
12972
12973 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
12974 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate @key{RET}
12975 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ @key{RET}}. (Substitute the @sc{url}
12976 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
12977 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
12978 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
12979 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
12980
12981 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
12982
12983 @table @code
12984 @item nnultimate-directory
12985 @vindex nnultimate-directory
12986 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is
12987 @samp{~/News/ultimate/}.
12988 @end table
12989
12990
12991 @node Web Archive
12992 @subsection Web Archive
12993 @cindex nnwarchive
12994 @cindex Web Archive
12995
12996 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
12997 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
12998 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
12999 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
13000 groups updated.
13001
13002 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
13003 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
13004 gnus-group-make-warchive-group @key{RET} an_egroup @key{RET} egroups @key{RET}
13005 www.egroups.com @key{RET} your@@email.address @key{RET}}. (Substitute the
13006 @sc{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
13007 @sc{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
13008 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive @key{RET} mail-archive @key{RET}}.
13009
13010 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
13011
13012 @table @code
13013 @item nnwarchive-directory
13014 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
13015 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is
13016 @samp{~/News/warchive/}.
13017
13018 @item nnwarchive-login
13019 @vindex nnwarchive-login
13020 The account name on the web server.
13021
13022 @item nnwarchive-passwd
13023 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
13024 The password for your account on the web server.
13025 @end table
13026
13027
13028 @node Customizing w3
13029 @subsection Customizing w3
13030 @cindex w3
13031 @cindex html
13032 @cindex url
13033 @cindex Netscape
13034
13035 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/w3 to display web
13036 pages. Emacs/w3 is documented in its own manual, but there are some
13037 things that may be more relevant for Gnus users.
13038
13039 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/w3 follow links
13040 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
13041 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
13042
13043 @lisp
13044 (eval-after-load "w3"
13045 '(progn
13046 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
13047 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
13048 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
13049 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
13050 (browse-url url)
13051 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
13052 @end lisp
13053
13054 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in w3-rendered
13055 @sc{html} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
13056 follow the link.
13057
13058
13059 @node Other Sources
13060 @section Other Sources
13061
13062 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
13063 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
13064 newsgroups.
13065
13066 @menu
13067 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
13068 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
13069 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
13070 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
13071 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
13072 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @sc{imap} client.
13073 @end menu
13074
13075
13076 @node Directory Groups
13077 @subsection Directory Groups
13078 @cindex nndir
13079 @cindex directory groups
13080
13081 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
13082 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
13083 names, of course.
13084
13085 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
13086 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
13087 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
13088 back end to read directories. Big deal.
13089
13090 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
13091 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
13092 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
13093 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
13094 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
13095
13096 @code{nndir} will use @sc{nov} files if they are present.
13097
13098 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
13099 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
13100 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
13101 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
13102
13103
13104 @node Anything Groups
13105 @subsection Anything Groups
13106 @cindex nneething
13107
13108 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
13109 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
13110 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
13111 true.
13112
13113 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
13114 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
13115 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
13116 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
13117 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
13118 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
13119 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
13120 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
13121 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
13122 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
13123 elements.
13124
13125 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
13126 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
13127 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
13128 in the article buffer, just as usual.
13129
13130 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
13131 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
13132 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
13133 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
13134
13135 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
13136 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
13137 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
13138 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
13139 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
13140 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
13141 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
13142 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
13143
13144 Some variables:
13145
13146 @table @code
13147 @item nneething-map-file-directory
13148 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
13149 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
13150 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
13151
13152 @item nneething-exclude-files
13153 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
13154 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
13155 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
13156
13157 @item nneething-include-files
13158 @vindex nneething-include-files
13159 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
13160 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
13161
13162 @item nneething-map-file
13163 @vindex nneething-map-file
13164 Name of the map files.
13165 @end table
13166
13167
13168 @node Document Groups
13169 @subsection Document Groups
13170 @cindex nndoc
13171 @cindex documentation group
13172 @cindex help group
13173
13174 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
13175 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
13176
13177 @table @code
13178 @cindex babyl
13179 @cindex rmail mbox
13180
13181 @item babyl
13182 The babyl (rmail) mail box.
13183 @cindex mbox
13184 @cindex Unix mbox
13185
13186 @item mbox
13187 The standard Unix mbox file.
13188
13189 @cindex MMDF mail box
13190 @item mmdf
13191 The MMDF mail box format.
13192
13193 @item news
13194 Several news articles appended into a file.
13195
13196 @item rnews
13197 @cindex rnews batch files
13198 The rnews batch transport format.
13199 @cindex forwarded messages
13200
13201 @item forward
13202 Forwarded articles.
13203
13204 @item nsmail
13205 Netscape mail boxes.
13206
13207 @item mime-parts
13208 MIME multipart messages.
13209
13210 @item standard-digest
13211 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
13212
13213 @item slack-digest
13214 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
13215 @end table
13216
13217 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
13218 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
13219 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
13220 file is.
13221
13222 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
13223 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
13224 group. And that's it.
13225
13226 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
13227 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
13228 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
13229 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
13230 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
13231 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
13232 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
13233 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
13234 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
13235 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
13236
13237 Virtual server variables:
13238
13239 @table @code
13240 @item nndoc-article-type
13241 @vindex nndoc-article-type
13242 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
13243 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
13244 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
13245 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail} or @code{guess}.
13246
13247 @item nndoc-post-type
13248 @vindex nndoc-post-type
13249 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
13250 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
13251 and @code{news}.
13252 @end table
13253
13254 @menu
13255 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
13256 @end menu
13257
13258
13259 @node Document Server Internals
13260 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
13261
13262 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
13263 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
13264 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
13265 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
13266
13267 First, here's an example document type definition:
13268
13269 @example
13270 (mmdf
13271 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
13272 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
13273 @end example
13274
13275 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
13276 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
13277 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
13278 types can be defined with very few settings:
13279
13280 @table @code
13281 @item first-article
13282 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
13283 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
13284 totally ignored.
13285
13286 @item article-begin
13287 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
13288 says what the beginning of each article looks like.
13289
13290 @item head-begin-function
13291 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
13292 the article.
13293
13294 @item nndoc-head-begin
13295 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
13296 article.
13297
13298 @item nndoc-head-end
13299 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
13300 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
13301
13302 @item body-begin-function
13303 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
13304 of the article.
13305
13306 @item body-begin
13307 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
13308 to @samp{^\n}.
13309
13310 @item body-end-function
13311 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
13312 the article.
13313
13314 @item body-end
13315 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article.
13316
13317 @item file-end
13318 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
13319 regexp will be totally ignored.
13320
13321 @end table
13322
13323 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
13324 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
13325 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
13326 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
13327 something that's palatable for Gnus:
13328
13329 @table @code
13330 @item prepare-body-function
13331 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
13332 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
13333 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
13334
13335 @item article-transform-function
13336 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
13337 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
13338 body of the article.
13339
13340 @item generate-head-function
13341 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
13342 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
13343 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
13344 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
13345
13346 @end table
13347
13348 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
13349 digests:
13350
13351 @example
13352 (standard-digest
13353 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
13354 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
13355 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
13356 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
13357 (head-end . "^ ?$")
13358 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
13359 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
13360 (subtype digest guess))
13361 @end example
13362
13363 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
13364 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
13365 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
13366 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
13367 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
13368
13369 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
13370 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first is
13371 the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says where in
13372 the document type definition alist to put this definition. The alist is
13373 traversed sequentially, and @code{nndoc-TYPE-type-p} is called for a given type @code{TYPE}. So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document
13374 is of @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
13375 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it is
13376 of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
13377 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number means
13378 low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
13379
13380
13381 @node SOUP
13382 @subsection SOUP
13383 @cindex SOUP
13384 @cindex offline
13385
13386 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
13387 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
13388 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
13389
13390 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
13391 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
13392 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
13393 newsreaders.
13394
13395 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
13396 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
13397 that interested in doing things properly.
13398
13399 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
13400 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
13401 fiddly.
13402
13403 First some terminology:
13404
13405 @table @dfn
13406
13407 @item server
13408 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
13409 get news and/or mail from.
13410
13411 @item home machine
13412 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
13413 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
13414
13415 @item packet
13416 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
13417 of packets:
13418
13419 @table @dfn
13420 @item message packets
13421 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
13422 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
13423 default, where @var{x} is a number.
13424
13425 @item response packets
13426 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
13427 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
13428 default, where @var{x} is a number.
13429
13430 @end table
13431
13432 @end table
13433
13434
13435 @enumerate
13436
13437 @item
13438 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
13439 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
13440 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
13441 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
13442
13443 @item
13444 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
13445
13446 @item
13447 You put the packet in your home directory.
13448
13449 @item
13450 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
13451 the native or secondary server.
13452
13453 @item
13454 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
13455 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
13456
13457 @item
13458 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
13459 packet.
13460
13461 @item
13462 You transfer this packet to the server.
13463
13464 @item
13465 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
13466
13467 @item
13468 You then repeat until you die.
13469
13470 @end enumerate
13471
13472 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
13473 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
13474
13475 @menu
13476 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
13477 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
13478 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
13479 @end menu
13480
13481
13482 @node SOUP Commands
13483 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
13484
13485 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
13486
13487 @table @kbd
13488 @item G s b
13489 @kindex G s b @r{(Group)}
13490 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
13491 Pack all unread articles in the current group
13492 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
13493 process/prefix convention.
13494
13495 @item G s w
13496 @kindex G s w @r{(Group)}
13497 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
13498 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
13499
13500 @item G s s
13501 @kindex G s s @r{(Group)}
13502 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
13503 Send all replies from the replies packet
13504 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
13505
13506 @item G s p
13507 @kindex G s p @r{(Group)}
13508 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
13509 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
13510
13511 @item G s r
13512 @kindex G s r @r{(Group)}
13513 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
13514 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
13515
13516 @item O s
13517 @kindex O s @r{(Summary)}
13518 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
13519 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
13520 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
13521 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
13522
13523 @end table
13524
13525
13526 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
13527 thingies:
13528
13529 @table @code
13530
13531 @item gnus-soup-directory
13532 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
13533 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
13534 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
13535
13536 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
13537 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
13538 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
13539 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
13540
13541 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
13542 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
13543 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
13544 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
13545
13546 @item gnus-soup-packer
13547 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
13548 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
13549 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
13550
13551 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
13552 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
13553 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
13554 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
13555
13556 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
13557 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
13558 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
13559
13560 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
13561 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
13562 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
13563 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
13564
13565 @end table
13566
13567
13568 @node SOUP Groups
13569 @subsubsection @sc{soup} Groups
13570 @cindex nnsoup
13571
13572 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
13573 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
13574 you can read them at leisure.
13575
13576 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
13577
13578 @table @code
13579
13580 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
13581 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
13582 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
13583 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
13584
13585 @item nnsoup-directory
13586 @vindex nnsoup-directory
13587 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
13588 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
13589
13590 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
13591 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
13592 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
13593 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/"}.
13594
13595 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
13596 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
13597 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
13598 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
13599 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
13600
13601 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
13602 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
13603 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
13604 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
13605
13606 @item nnsoup-active-file
13607 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
13608 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
13609 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
13610 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
13611 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
13612
13613 @item nnsoup-packer
13614 @vindex nnsoup-packer
13615 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
13616 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
13617
13618 @item nnsoup-unpacker
13619 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
13620 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
13621 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
13622
13623 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
13624 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
13625 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
13626 @file{~/}.
13627
13628 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
13629 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
13630 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
13631 @samp{Soupout}.
13632
13633 @item nnsoup-always-save
13634 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
13635 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
13636
13637 @end table
13638
13639
13640 @node SOUP Replies
13641 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
13642
13643 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
13644 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
13645 more for that to happen.
13646
13647 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
13648 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
13649 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
13650 @sc{soup} system.
13651
13652 In specific, this is what it does:
13653
13654 @lisp
13655 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
13656 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
13657 @end lisp
13658
13659 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
13660 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
13661 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
13662
13663
13664 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
13665 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
13666 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
13667 @cindex gateways
13668
13669 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
13670 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
13671 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
13672
13673 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
13674 used to post with.
13675
13676 Server variables:
13677
13678 @table @code
13679 @item nngateway-address
13680 @vindex nngateway-address
13681 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
13682
13683 @item nngateway-header-transformation
13684 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
13685 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
13686 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
13687 transformation should be called, and defaults to
13688 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
13689 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
13690 gateway address.
13691
13692 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
13693 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
13694 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
13695
13696 @example
13697 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
13698 @end example
13699
13700 will get this @code{From} header inserted:
13701
13702 @example
13703 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
13704 @end example
13705
13706 The following pre-defined functions exist:
13707
13708 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
13709 @table @code
13710
13711 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
13712 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
13713 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
13714
13715 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
13716
13717 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
13718 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
13719 @code{nngateway-address}.
13720
13721 Here's an example:
13722
13723 @lisp
13724 (setq gnus-post-method
13725 '(nngateway
13726 "mail2news@@replay.com"
13727 (nngateway-header-transformation
13728 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
13729 @end lisp
13730
13731 @end table
13732
13733
13734 @end table
13735
13736 So, to use this, simply say something like:
13737
13738 @lisp
13739 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
13740 @end lisp
13741
13742
13743
13744 @node IMAP
13745 @subsection @sc{imap}
13746 @cindex nnimap
13747 @cindex @sc{imap}
13748
13749 @sc{imap} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or@dots{}),
13750 think of it as a modernized @sc{nntp}. Connecting to a @sc{imap}
13751 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
13752 specify the network address of the server.
13753
13754 @sc{imap} has two properties. First, @sc{imap} can do everything that
13755 POP can, it can hence be viewed as POP++. Secondly, @sc{imap} is a
13756 mail storage protocol, similar to @sc{nntp} being a news storage
13757 protocol. (@sc{imap} offers more features than @sc{nntp} because news
13758 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.)
13759
13760 If you want to use @sc{imap} as POP++, use an imap entry in
13761 mail-sources. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from the @sc{imap}
13762 server and store them on the local disk. This is not the usage
13763 described in this section. @xref{Mail Sources}.
13764
13765 If you want to use @sc{imap} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
13766 entry in gnus-secondary-select-methods. With this, Gnus will
13767 manipulate mails stored on the @sc{imap} server. This is the kind of
13768 usage explained in this section.
13769
13770 A server configuration in @code{~/.gnus} with a few @sc{imap} servers
13771 might look something like this:
13772
13773 @lisp
13774 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
13775 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; no special configuration
13776 ; perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:
13777 (nnimap "dolk"
13778 (nnimap-address "localhost")
13779 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
13780 ; a UW server running on localhost
13781 (nnimap "barbar"
13782 (nnimap-server-port 143)
13783 (nnimap-address "localhost")
13784 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
13785 ; anonymous public cyrus server:
13786 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
13787 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
13788 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
13789 (nnimap-stream network))
13790 ; a ssl server on a non-standard port:
13791 (nnimap "vic20"
13792 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
13793 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
13794 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
13795 @end lisp
13796
13797 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
13798 server:
13799
13800 @table @code
13801
13802 @item nnimap-address
13803 @vindex nnimap-address
13804
13805 The address of the remote @sc{imap} server. Defaults to the virtual
13806 server name if not specified.
13807
13808 @item nnimap-server-port
13809 @vindex nnimap-server-port
13810 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for SSL.
13811
13812 Note that this should be a integer, example server specification:
13813
13814 @lisp
13815 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
13816 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
13817 @end lisp
13818
13819 @item nnimap-list-pattern
13820 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
13821 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
13822 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
13823 interested in a few -- some servers export your home directory via
13824 @sc{imap}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
13825 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
13826
13827 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
13828 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
13829 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
13830 mailbox.
13831
13832 Example server specification:
13833
13834 @lisp
13835 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
13836 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
13837 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
13838 @end lisp
13839
13840 @item nnimap-stream
13841 @vindex nnimap-stream
13842 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
13843 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
13844 of SSL. (SSL is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can be automatically
13845 detected, but it's not widely deployed yet).
13846
13847 Example server specification:
13848
13849 @lisp
13850 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
13851 (nnimap-stream ssl))
13852 @end lisp
13853
13854 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
13855
13856 @itemize @bullet
13857 @item
13858 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
13859 @command{imtest} program.
13860 @item
13861 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the
13862 @command{imtest} program.
13863 @item
13864 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
13865 SSL)@. Requires the library @file{starttls.el} and program
13866 @command{starttls}.
13867 @item
13868 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through SSL@. Requires OpenSSL (the
13869 program @command{openssl}) or SSLeay (@command{s_client}).
13870 @item
13871 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start an @sc{imap} connection.
13872 @item
13873 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
13874 @end itemize
13875
13876 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
13877 The @command{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD@. Nnimap supports
13878 both @command{imtest} version 1.5.x and version 1.6.x. The variable
13879 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contains parameters to pass to the
13880 @command{imtest} program.
13881
13882 @vindex imap-ssl-program
13883 For SSL connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
13884 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
13885 and nnimap supports it too. However, the most recent versions of
13886 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
13887 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
13888 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contains parameters to pass
13889 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
13890
13891 @vindex imap-shell-program
13892 @vindex imap-shell-host
13893 For @sc{imap} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
13894 @code{imap-shell-program} specifies what program to call.
13895
13896 @item nnimap-authenticator
13897 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
13898
13899 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
13900 will use the most secure authenticator your server supports.
13901
13902 Example server specification:
13903
13904 @lisp
13905 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
13906 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
13907 @end lisp
13908
13909 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
13910
13911 @itemize @bullet
13912 @item
13913 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5) authentication. Requires the
13914 external program @command{imtest}.
13915 @item
13916 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos authentication. Requires the external program
13917 @command{imtest}.
13918 @item
13919 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5@. Requires
13920 external library @command{digest-md5.el}.
13921 @item
13922 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
13923 @item
13924 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
13925 @item
13926 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as `anonymous', supplying your email address as
13927 password.
13928 @end itemize
13929
13930 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
13931 @cindex Expunging
13932 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
13933 Unlike Parmenides, the @sc{imap} designers decided that things that
13934 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @sc{imap} has
13935 the concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
13936 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
13937 nnimap does when you delete a article in Gnus (with @kbd{G @key{DEL}} or
13938 similar).
13939
13940 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
13941 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
13942 running in circles yet?
13943
13944 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
13945 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
13946 variable.
13947
13948 The possible options are:
13949
13950 @table @code
13951
13952 @item always
13953 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as "Deleted" when
13954 closing a mailbox.
13955 @item never
13956 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
13957 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @sc{imap} clients
13958 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
13959 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
13960 @item ask
13961 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
13962 articles or not.
13963
13964 @end table
13965
13966 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
13967 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
13968
13969 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format
13970 is (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See
13971 `nntp-authinfo-file' for exact syntax.
13972
13973 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
13974 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
13975 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
13976 @xref{NNTP}.
13977
13978 @end table
13979
13980 @menu
13981 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
13982 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
13983 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a "compress mailbox" button.
13984 @end menu
13985
13986
13987
13988 @node Splitting in IMAP
13989 @subsubsection Splitting in @sc{imap}
13990 @cindex splitting imap mail
13991
13992 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
13993 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on; not many
13994 @sc{imap} servers have server side splitting and those that have splitting
13995 seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that @sc{imap}
13996 support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
13997
13998 And it does.
13999
14000 Here are the variables of interest:
14001
14002 @table @code
14003
14004 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
14005 @cindex splitting, crosspost
14006 @cindex crosspost
14007 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
14008
14009 If non-nil, do crossposting if several split methods match the mail. If
14010 nil, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule} found will be used.
14011
14012 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
14013
14014 @item nnimap-split-inbox
14015 @cindex splitting, inbox
14016 @cindex inbox
14017 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
14018
14019 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @sc{imap}
14020 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
14021 splitting is disabled!
14022
14023 @lisp
14024 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
14025 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
14026 @end lisp
14027
14028 No nnmail equivalent.
14029
14030 @item nnimap-split-rule
14031 @cindex Splitting, rules
14032 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
14033
14034 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
14035 this variable.
14036
14037 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
14038 sublist gives the name of the @sc{imap} mailbox to move articles
14039 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
14040 Neither did I, we need examples.
14041
14042 @lisp
14043 (setq nnimap-split-rule
14044 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
14045 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
14046 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
14047 ("INBOX.private" "")))
14048 @end lisp
14049
14050 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
14051 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
14052 into INBOX.spam and everything else in INBOX.private.
14053
14054 The first string may contain @samp{\\@var{digit}} forms, like the ones used by
14055 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
14056 instance:
14057
14058 @lisp
14059 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
14060 @end lisp
14061
14062 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14063 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
14064 containing the headers of the article. It should return a non-nil value
14065 if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
14066
14067 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
14068 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
14069 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
14070 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
14071 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
14072 them every time you fetch new mail.)
14073
14074 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
14075 end. The first rule to make a match will `win', unless you have
14076 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will `win'.
14077
14078 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
14079 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group to where
14080 it thinks the article should be split. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
14081
14082 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs too.
14083
14084 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
14085 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
14086 the syntax of this variable has been extended along the lines of:
14087
14088 @lisp
14089 (setq nnimap-split-rule
14090 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
14091 ("junk" "From:.*Simon")))
14092 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
14093 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
14094 ("junk" my-junk-func)))))
14095 @end lisp
14096
14097 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
14098 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
14099 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
14100 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
14101 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
14102 group/function elements.
14103
14104 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
14105
14106 @item nnimap-split-predicate
14107 @cindex splitting
14108 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
14109
14110 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
14111 split; it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
14112
14113 This might be useful if you use another @sc{imap} client to read mail in
14114 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
14115 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
14116 @samp{UNDELETED}.
14117
14118 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14119 @cindex splitting, fancy
14120 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
14121 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
14122
14123 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
14124 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
14125 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14126
14127 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
14128 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
14129 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
14130 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
14131
14132 Example:
14133
14134 @lisp
14135 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
14136 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
14137 @end lisp
14138
14139 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14140
14141 @end table
14142
14143 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
14144 @subsubsection Editing @sc{imap} ACLs
14145 @cindex editing imap acls
14146 @cindex Access Control Lists
14147 @cindex Editing @sc{imap} ACLs
14148 @kindex G l
14149 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
14150
14151 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @sc{imap} for
14152 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
14153 @sc{imap} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
14154 doesn't.
14155
14156 To edit a ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
14157 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with a ACL
14158 editing window with detailed instructions.
14159
14160 Some possible uses:
14161
14162 @itemize @bullet
14163 @item
14164 Giving "anyone" the "lrs" rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
14165 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
14166 follow the list without subscribing to it.
14167 @item
14168 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
14169 "anyone" posting ("p") capabilities to have "plussing" work (that is,
14170 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @sc{imap} mailbox
14171 INBOX.mailbox).
14172 @end itemize
14173
14174 @node Expunging mailboxes
14175 @subsubsection Expunging mailboxes
14176 @cindex expunging
14177
14178 @cindex Expunge
14179 @cindex Manual expunging
14180 @kindex G x
14181 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
14182
14183 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-close},
14184 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
14185 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
14186
14187 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
14188 delete them.
14189
14190
14191
14192 @node Combined Groups
14193 @section Combined Groups
14194
14195 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
14196 groups.
14197
14198 @menu
14199 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
14200 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
14201 @end menu
14202
14203
14204 @node Virtual Groups
14205 @subsection Virtual Groups
14206 @cindex nnvirtual
14207 @cindex virtual groups
14208 @cindex merging groups
14209
14210 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
14211 other groups.
14212
14213 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
14214 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
14215 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
14216
14217 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
14218 regexp to match component groups.
14219
14220 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
14221 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
14222 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it came.
14223 (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be shown in
14224 the virtual group.)
14225
14226 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
14227 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
14228
14229 @lisp
14230 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
14231 @end lisp
14232
14233 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
14234 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
14235
14236 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
14237 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
14238 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
14239 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
14240
14241 @example
14242 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
14243 @end example
14244
14245 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
14246 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
14247 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
14248
14249 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
14250 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
14251 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
14252 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
14253 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
14254
14255 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
14256 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
14257 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
14258
14259 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
14260 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} is non-@code{nil},
14261 @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread articles when
14262 entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
14263 default) and you read articles in a component group after the virtual
14264 group has been activated, the read articles from the component group
14265 will show up when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this
14266 effect if you have two virtual groups that have a component group in
14267 common. If that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}.
14268 Or you can just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before
14269 you enter it---it'll have much the same effect.
14270
14271 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
14272 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
14273 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
14274 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
14275 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
14276 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
14277 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
14278
14279 @kbd{C-c C-t} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
14280 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
14281
14282
14283
14284 @node Kibozed Groups
14285 @subsection Kibozed Groups
14286 @cindex nnkiboze
14287 @cindex kibozing
14288
14289 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by @sc{oed} as ``grepping through (parts of)
14290 the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will do this for
14291 you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @sc{nntp} server down to a halt
14292 with useless requests! Oh happiness!
14293
14294 @kindex G k @r{(Group)}
14295 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
14296 buffer.
14297
14298 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
14299 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
14300 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between @code{nnkiboze}
14301 and @code{nnvirtual} end.
14302
14303 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an @code{nnkiboze} group
14304 must have a score file to say what articles are to be included in
14305 the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
14306
14307 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
14308 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
14309 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
14310 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time. Lots of
14311 time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the headers from
14312 all the articles in all the component groups and run them through the
14313 scoring process to determine if there are any articles in the groups
14314 that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
14315
14316 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
14317 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
14318 @sc{nntp} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
14319 Stranger things have happened.
14320
14321 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
14322 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
14323
14324 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
14325 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
14326 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/} by default. One
14327 contains the @sc{nov} header lines for all the articles in the group,
14328 and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store information
14329 on what groups have been searched through to find component articles.
14330
14331 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
14332 their @sc{nov} lines removed from the @sc{nov} file.
14333
14334
14335 @node Gnus Unplugged
14336 @section Gnus Unplugged
14337 @cindex offline
14338 @cindex unplugged
14339 @cindex Agent
14340 @cindex Gnus Agent
14341 @cindex Gnus Unplugged
14342
14343 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
14344 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
14345 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
14346 read news. Believe it or not.
14347
14348 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
14349 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
14350 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
14351 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
14352 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
14353
14354 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
14355 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
14356 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
14357 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
14358 reading news on a machine.
14359
14360 Using Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple.
14361
14362 @itemize @bullet
14363 @item
14364 First, set up Gnus as you would do if you were running it on a machine
14365 that has full connection to the net. Go ahead. I'll still be waiting
14366 here.
14367
14368 @item
14369 Then, put the following magical incantation at the end of your
14370 @file{.gnus.el} file:
14371
14372 @lisp
14373 (gnus-agentize)
14374 @end lisp
14375 @end itemize
14376
14377 That's it. Gnus is now an ``offline'' newsreader.
14378
14379 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
14380
14381 @menu
14382 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
14383 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
14384 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
14385 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
14386 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with IMAP.
14387 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
14388 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
14389 * Example Setup:: An example @file{.gnus.el} file for offline people.
14390 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
14391 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
14392 @end menu
14393
14394
14395 @node Agent Basics
14396 @subsection Agent Basics
14397
14398 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
14399
14400 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
14401 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
14402 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
14403 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
14404
14405 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
14406 connected to the net continuously.
14407
14408 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
14409 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
14410
14411 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
14412
14413 @itemize @bullet
14414
14415 @item
14416 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
14417 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
14418 already fetched while in this mode.
14419
14420 @item
14421 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
14422 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
14423 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
14424 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode, see (@pxref{Mail
14425 Source Specifiers}).
14426
14427 @item
14428 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the news
14429 onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press @kbd{g}
14430 to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J
14431 s} to fetch all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus
14432 know which articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}.)
14433
14434 @item
14435 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
14436 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
14437 then you read the news offline.
14438
14439 @item
14440 And then you go to step 2.
14441 @end itemize
14442
14443 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
14444 the Agent.
14445
14446 @itemize @bullet
14447
14448 @item
14449 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
14450 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
14451 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
14452 @kbd{J a} the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
14453 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}). This will typically be only the
14454 primary select method, which is listed on the bottom in the buffer.
14455
14456 @item
14457 Decide on download policy. @xref{Agent Categories}.
14458
14459 @item
14460 Uhm... that's it.
14461 @end itemize
14462
14463
14464 @node Agent Categories
14465 @subsection Agent Categories
14466
14467 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
14468 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
14469 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
14470 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
14471 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
14472 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
14473 you're interested in the articles anyway.
14474
14475 The main way to control what is to be downloaded is to create a
14476 @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all) groups to this category.
14477 Groups that do not belong in any other category belong to the
14478 @code{default} category. Gnus has its own buffer for creating and
14479 managing categories.
14480
14481 @menu
14482 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
14483 * The Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
14484 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
14485 @end menu
14486
14487
14488 @node Category Syntax
14489 @subsubsection Category Syntax
14490
14491 A category consists of two things.
14492
14493 @enumerate
14494 @item
14495 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
14496 are eligible for downloading; and
14497
14498 @item
14499 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
14500 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
14501 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
14502 @end enumerate
14503
14504 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
14505 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
14506 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
14507 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
14508
14509 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
14510 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
14511 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
14512
14513 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
14514 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
14515 operators sprinkled in between.
14516
14517 Perhaps some examples are in order.
14518
14519 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
14520 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
14521
14522 @lisp
14523 short
14524 @end lisp
14525
14526 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
14527 short (for some value of ``short'').
14528
14529 Here's a more complex predicate:
14530
14531 @lisp
14532 (or high
14533 (and
14534 (not low)
14535 (not long)))
14536 @end lisp
14537
14538 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
14539 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
14540 drift.
14541
14542 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
14543 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
14544 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
14545
14546 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
14547 you want to do, you can write your own.
14548
14549 @table @code
14550 @item short
14551 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
14552 lines; default 100.
14553
14554 @item long
14555 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
14556 lines; default 200.
14557
14558 @item low
14559 True iff the article has a download score less than
14560 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
14561
14562 @item high
14563 True iff the article has a download score greater than
14564 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
14565
14566 @item spam
14567 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
14568 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
14569 checksum and sees whether articles match.
14570
14571 @item true
14572 Always true.
14573
14574 @item false
14575 Always false.
14576 @end table
14577
14578 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
14579 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
14580 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
14581 useful values.
14582
14583 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
14584 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
14585 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
14586 something along the lines of the following:
14587
14588 @lisp
14589 (defun my-article-old-p ()
14590 "Say whether an article is old."
14591 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
14592 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
14593 @end lisp
14594
14595 with the predicate then defined as:
14596
14597 @lisp
14598 (not my-article-old-p)
14599 @end lisp
14600
14601 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
14602 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
14603 wherever. (Note: this would have to be at a point *after*
14604 @code{gnus-agent} has been loaded via @code{(gnus-agentize)})
14605
14606 @lisp
14607 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
14608 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
14609 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
14610 @end lisp
14611
14612 and simply specify your predicate as:
14613
14614 @lisp
14615 (not old)
14616 @end lisp
14617
14618 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
14619 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
14620 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
14621 just don't give a damn.
14622
14623 The above predicates apply to *all* the groups which belong to the
14624 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
14625 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
14626 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in it's group
14627 parameters like so:
14628
14629 @lisp
14630 (agent-predicate . short)
14631 @end lisp
14632
14633 This is the group parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
14634 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
14635 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
14636
14637 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
14638
14639 @lisp
14640 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
14641 @end lisp
14642
14643 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
14644 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
14645 predicate is assumed to be a list.
14646
14647
14648 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
14649 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
14650 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
14651 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
14652 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
14653 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
14654
14655 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
14656 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
14657 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
14658 if it's to be specific to that group.
14659
14660 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
14661 three forms:
14662
14663 @enumerate
14664 @item
14665 Score rule
14666
14667 This has the same syntax as a normal gnus score file except only a
14668 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
14669
14670 example:
14671
14672 @itemize @bullet
14673 @item
14674 Category specification
14675
14676 @lisp
14677 (("from"
14678 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
14679 ("lines"
14680 (500 -100 nil <)))
14681 @end lisp
14682
14683 @item
14684 Group Parameter specification
14685
14686 @lisp
14687 (agent-score ("from"
14688 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
14689 ("lines"
14690 (500 -100 nil <)))
14691 @end lisp
14692
14693 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
14694 @end itemize
14695
14696 @item
14697 Agent score file
14698
14699 These score files must *only* contain the permitted scoring keywords
14700 stated above.
14701
14702 example:
14703
14704 @itemize @bullet
14705 @item
14706 Category specification
14707
14708 @lisp
14709 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
14710 @end lisp
14711
14712 or perhaps
14713
14714 @lisp
14715 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
14716 @end lisp
14717
14718 @item
14719 Group Parameter specification
14720
14721 @lisp
14722 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
14723 @end lisp
14724
14725 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
14726 about parenthesis?
14727 @end itemize
14728
14729 @item
14730 Use @code{normal} score files
14731
14732 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
14733 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
14734 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
14735 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
14736
14737 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
14738 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
14739 files for a group, *filtering out* those sections that do not
14740 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
14741
14742 @itemize @bullet
14743 @item
14744 Category Specification
14745
14746 @lisp
14747 file
14748 @end lisp
14749
14750 @item
14751 Group Parameter specification
14752
14753 @lisp
14754 (agent-score . file)
14755 @end lisp
14756 @end itemize
14757 @end enumerate
14758
14759 @node The Category Buffer
14760 @subsubsection The Category Buffer
14761
14762 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
14763 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
14764 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
14765
14766 The following commands are available in this buffer:
14767
14768 @table @kbd
14769 @item q
14770 @kindex q (Category)
14771 @findex gnus-category-exit
14772 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
14773
14774 @item k
14775 @kindex k (Category)
14776 @findex gnus-category-kill
14777 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
14778
14779 @item c
14780 @kindex c (Category)
14781 @findex gnus-category-copy
14782 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
14783
14784 @item a
14785 @kindex a (Category)
14786 @findex gnus-category-add
14787 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
14788
14789 @item p
14790 @kindex p (Category)
14791 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
14792 Edit the predicate of the current category
14793 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
14794
14795 @item g
14796 @kindex g (Category)
14797 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
14798 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
14799 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
14800
14801 @item s
14802 @kindex s (Category)
14803 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
14804 Edit the download score rule of the current category
14805 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
14806
14807 @item l
14808 @kindex l (Category)
14809 @findex gnus-category-list
14810 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
14811 @end table
14812
14813
14814 @node Category Variables
14815 @subsubsection Category Variables
14816
14817 @table @code
14818 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
14819 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
14820 Hook run in category buffers.
14821
14822 @item gnus-category-line-format
14823 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
14824 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
14825 Variables}). Valid elements are:
14826
14827 @table @samp
14828 @item c
14829 The name of the category.
14830
14831 @item g
14832 The number of groups in the category.
14833 @end table
14834
14835 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
14836 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
14837 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
14838
14839 @item gnus-agent-short-article
14840 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
14841 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
14842
14843 @item gnus-agent-long-article
14844 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
14845 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
14846
14847 @item gnus-agent-low-score
14848 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
14849 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
14850 0.
14851
14852 @item gnus-agent-high-score
14853 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
14854 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
14855 0.
14856
14857 @end table
14858
14859
14860 @node Agent Commands
14861 @subsection Agent Commands
14862
14863 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
14864 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged} command works in all modes, and
14865 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
14866
14867
14868 @menu
14869 * Group Agent Commands::
14870 * Summary Agent Commands::
14871 * Server Agent Commands::
14872 @end menu
14873
14874 You can run a complete batch fetch from the command line with the
14875 following incantation:
14876
14877 @cindex gnus-agent-batch-fetch
14878 @example
14879 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch-fetch
14880 @end example
14881
14882
14883
14884 @node Group Agent Commands
14885 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
14886
14887 @table @kbd
14888 @item J u
14889 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
14890 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
14891 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
14892 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
14893
14894 @item J c
14895 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
14896 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
14897 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
14898
14899 @item J s
14900 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
14901 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
14902 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
14903 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
14904
14905 @item J S
14906 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
14907 @findex gnus-group-send-drafts
14908 Send all sendable messages in the draft group
14909 (@code{gnus-group-send-drafts}). @xref{Drafts}.
14910
14911 @item J a
14912 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
14913 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
14914 Add the current group to an Agent category
14915 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
14916 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
14917
14918 @item J r
14919 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
14920 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
14921 Remove the current group from its category, if any
14922 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
14923 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
14924
14925 @item J Y
14926 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
14927 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
14928 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
14929
14930
14931 @end table
14932
14933
14934 @node Summary Agent Commands
14935 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
14936
14937 @table @kbd
14938 @item J #
14939 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
14940 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
14941 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
14942
14943 @item J M-#
14944 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
14945 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
14946 Remove the downloading mark from the article
14947 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
14948
14949 @item @@
14950 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
14951 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
14952 Toggle whether to download the article (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}).
14953
14954 @item J c
14955 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
14956 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
14957 Mark all undownloaded articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}).
14958
14959 @end table
14960
14961
14962 @node Server Agent Commands
14963 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
14964
14965 @table @kbd
14966 @item J a
14967 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
14968 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
14969 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
14970 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
14971
14972 @item J r
14973 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
14974 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
14975 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
14976 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
14977
14978 @end table
14979
14980
14981 @node Agent Expiry
14982 @subsection Agent Expiry
14983
14984 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
14985 @findex gnus-agent-expire
14986 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
14987 @cindex Agent expiry
14988 @cindex Gnus Agent expiry
14989 @cindex expiry
14990
14991 @code{nnagent} doesn't handle expiry. Instead, there's a special
14992 @code{gnus-agent-expire} command that will expire all read articles that
14993 are older than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. It can be run
14994 whenever you feel that you're running out of space. It's not
14995 particularly fast or efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to
14996 interrupt it (with @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started it.
14997
14998 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
14999 if @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, this command will
15000 expire all articles---unread, read, ticked and dormant. If @code{nil}
15001 (which is the default), only read articles are eligible for expiry, and
15002 unread, ticked and dormant articles will be kept indefinitely.
15003
15004
15005 @node Agent and IMAP
15006 @subsection Agent and IMAP
15007
15008 The Agent work with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
15009 since there are some conceptual differences between @sc{nntp} and
15010 @sc{imap}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
15011 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @sc{imap} Disconnected Mode client.
15012
15013 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
15014 are kept on the @sc{imap} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
15015 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
15016 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
15017
15018 Gnus keep track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
15019 Agent by default. When you plug back in, by default Gnus will check if
15020 you have any changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these
15021 with the server. This behavior is customizable with
15022 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
15023
15024 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
15025 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
15026 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, the
15027 default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so ask if
15028 you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has any other
15029 value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
15030
15031 If you do not wish to automatically synchronize flags when you
15032 re-connect, this can be done manually with the
15033 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
15034 in the group buffer by default.
15035
15036 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
15037 expect from a disconnected @sc{imap} client, including:
15038
15039 @itemize @bullet
15040
15041 @item
15042 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
15043
15044 @item
15045 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
15046
15047 @end itemize
15048
15049 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by "pushing"
15050 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
15051 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
15052 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on a article, quit the group and
15053 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
15054 removed from the server when you "synchronize". The queued flag
15055 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
15056 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
15057
15058
15059 @node Outgoing Messages
15060 @subsection Outgoing Messages
15061
15062 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
15063 stored in the draft groups (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view them there
15064 after posting, and edit them at will.
15065
15066 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
15067 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
15068 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
15069 messages in the draft group.
15070
15071
15072
15073 @node Agent Variables
15074 @subsection Agent Variables
15075
15076 @table @code
15077 @item gnus-agent-directory
15078 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
15079 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
15080 @file{~/News/agent/}.
15081
15082 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
15083 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
15084 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
15085 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
15086 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
15087 by default.
15088
15089 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
15090 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
15091 Hook run when connecting to the network.
15092
15093 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
15094 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
15095 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
15096
15097 @end table
15098
15099
15100 @node Example Setup
15101 @subsection Example Setup
15102
15103 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
15104 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
15105 @file{.gnus.el} file to get started.
15106
15107 @lisp
15108 ;;; Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @sc{nntp}
15109 ;;; from your ISP's server.
15110 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
15111
15112 ;;; Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from
15113 ;;; your ISP's POP server.
15114 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
15115
15116 ;;; Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.
15117 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
15118
15119 ;;; Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.
15120 (gnus-agentize)
15121 @end lisp
15122
15123 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
15124 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
15125 gnus}.
15126
15127 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
15128 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
15129 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
15130 @sc{nntp} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
15131 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
15132 once.
15133
15134 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
15135 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
15136 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
15137 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
15138 back all the killed groups.)
15139
15140 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
15141 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
15142 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
15143
15144
15145 @node Batching Agents
15146 @subsection Batching Agents
15147
15148 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
15149 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
15150 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
15151
15152 @example
15153 #!/bin/sh
15154 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null
15155 @end example
15156
15157
15158 @node Agent Caveats
15159 @subsection Agent Caveats
15160
15161 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
15162 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
15163 may ask:
15164
15165 @table @dfn
15166 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the
15167 Agent?
15168
15169 @strong{No.}
15170
15171 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists
15172 in the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
15173
15174 @strong{Yes.}
15175
15176 @end table
15177
15178 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
15179 articles; when it's plugged, it only talks to your ISP.
15180
15181
15182 @node Scoring
15183 @chapter Scoring
15184 @cindex scoring
15185
15186 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
15187 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
15188 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
15189 attention!
15190
15191 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
15192 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
15193 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
15194 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
15195 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
15196
15197 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
15198 before generating the summary buffer.
15199
15200 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
15201 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
15202 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
15203
15204 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
15205 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
15206 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
15207 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
15208
15209 @menu
15210 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
15211 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
15212 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
15213 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
15214 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
15215 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
15216 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
15217 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
15218 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
15219 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
15220 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
15221 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
15222 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
15223 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
15224 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
15225 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
15226 @end menu
15227
15228
15229 @node Summary Score Commands
15230 @section Summary Score Commands
15231 @cindex score commands
15232
15233 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
15234 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
15235 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
15236 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
15237 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
15238
15239 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
15240 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
15241 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
15242 score file the current one.
15243
15244 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
15245
15246 @table @kbd
15247
15248 @item V s
15249 @kindex V s @r{(Summary)}
15250 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
15251 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
15252
15253 @item V S
15254 @kindex V S @r{(Summary)}
15255 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
15256 Display the score of the current article
15257 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
15258
15259 @item V t
15260 @kindex V t @r{(Summary)}
15261 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
15262 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
15263 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}).
15264
15265 @item V R
15266 @kindex V R @r{(Summary)}
15267 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
15268 Run the current summary through the scoring process
15269 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
15270 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
15271 effect you're having.
15272
15273 @item V c
15274 @kindex V c @r{(Summary)}
15275 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
15276 Make a different score file the current
15277 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
15278
15279 @item V e
15280 @kindex V e @r{(Summary)}
15281 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
15282 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
15283 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
15284 File Editing}).
15285
15286 @item V f
15287 @kindex V f @r{(Summary)}
15288 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
15289 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
15290 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
15291
15292 @item V F
15293 @kindex V F @r{(Summary)}
15294 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
15295 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
15296 after editing score files.
15297
15298 @item V C
15299 @kindex V C @r{(Summary)}
15300 @findex gnus-score-customize
15301 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
15302 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
15303
15304 @end table
15305
15306 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
15307
15308 @table @kbd
15309
15310 @item V m
15311 @kindex V m @r{(Summary)}
15312 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
15313 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
15314 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
15315
15316 @item V x
15317 @kindex V x @r{(Summary)}
15318 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
15319 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
15320 expunge all articles below this score
15321 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
15322 @end table
15323
15324 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
15325 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
15326 them.)
15327
15328 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
15329 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
15330
15331 @enumerate
15332 @item
15333 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
15334 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
15335 @item
15336 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
15337 keys are available:
15338 @table @kbd
15339
15340 @item a
15341 Score on the author name.
15342
15343 @item s
15344 Score on the subject line.
15345
15346 @item x
15347 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
15348
15349 @item r
15350 Score on the @code{References} line.
15351
15352 @item d
15353 Score on the date.
15354
15355 @item l
15356 Score on the number of lines.
15357
15358 @item i
15359 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
15360
15361 @item f
15362 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
15363 the followups to this author.
15364
15365 @item b
15366 Score on the body.
15367
15368 @item h
15369 Score on the head.
15370
15371 @item t
15372 Score on thread.
15373
15374 @end table
15375
15376 @item
15377 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
15378 what headers you are scoring on.
15379
15380 @table @code
15381
15382 @item strings
15383
15384 @table @kbd
15385
15386 @item e
15387 Exact matching.
15388
15389 @item s
15390 Substring matching.
15391
15392 @item f
15393 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
15394
15395 @item r
15396 Regexp matching
15397 @end table
15398
15399 @item date
15400 @table @kbd
15401
15402 @item b
15403 Before date.
15404
15405 @item a
15406 After date.
15407
15408 @item n
15409 This date.
15410 @end table
15411
15412 @item number
15413 @table @kbd
15414
15415 @item <
15416 Less than number.
15417
15418 @item =
15419 Equal to number.
15420
15421 @item >
15422 Greater than number.
15423 @end table
15424 @end table
15425
15426 @item
15427 The fourth and final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e., expiring)
15428 score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry, or whether
15429 it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score file.
15430 @table @kbd
15431
15432 @item t
15433 Temporary score entry.
15434
15435 @item p
15436 Permanent score entry.
15437
15438 @item i
15439 Immediately scoring.
15440 @end table
15441
15442 @end enumerate
15443
15444 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
15445 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
15446 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
15447 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
15448
15449 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
15450 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
15451 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
15452 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
15453 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
15454
15455 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
15456 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
15457 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
15458 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
15459 current score file.
15460
15461 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
15462 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
15463 pretend they are keymaps or not.
15464
15465
15466 @node Group Score Commands
15467 @section Group Score Commands
15468 @cindex group score commands
15469
15470 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
15471
15472 @table @kbd
15473
15474 @item W f
15475 @kindex W f @r{(Group)}
15476 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
15477 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
15478 all the time. This command will flush the cache
15479 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
15480
15481 @end table
15482
15483 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
15484
15485 @findex gnus-batch-score
15486 @cindex batch scoring
15487 @example
15488 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
15489 @end example
15490
15491
15492 @node Score Variables
15493 @section Score Variables
15494 @cindex score variables
15495
15496 @table @code
15497
15498 @item gnus-use-scoring
15499 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
15500 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
15501 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
15502
15503 @item gnus-kill-killed
15504 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
15505 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
15506 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
15507 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
15508 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
15509 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
15510 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
15511
15512 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
15513 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
15514 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
15515 initialized from the @code{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
15516 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
15517
15518 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
15519 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
15520 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
15521 (@samp{SCORE} by default.)
15522
15523 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
15524 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
15525 @cindex score cache
15526 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
15527 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
15528 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
15529 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
15530 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
15531 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
15532 be cached.
15533
15534 @item gnus-save-score
15535 @vindex gnus-save-score
15536 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
15537 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
15538 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
15539
15540 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
15541 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
15542 across group visits.
15543
15544 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
15545 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
15546 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
15547 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
15548 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
15549 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
15550 manually entered data.
15551
15552 @item gnus-summary-default-score
15553 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
15554 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
15555
15556 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
15557 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
15558 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
15559 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
15560 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
15561 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
15562
15563 @item gnus-score-over-mark
15564 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
15565 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
15566 default. Default is @samp{+}.
15567
15568 @item gnus-score-below-mark
15569 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
15570 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
15571 default. Default is @samp{-}.
15572
15573 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
15574 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
15575 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
15576 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
15577
15578 Predefined functions available are:
15579 @table @code
15580
15581 @item gnus-score-find-single
15582 @findex gnus-score-find-single
15583 Only apply the group's own score file.
15584
15585 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
15586 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
15587 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
15588 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
15589 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
15590 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
15591 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
15592 then a regexp match is done.
15593
15594 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
15595 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
15596
15597 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
15598 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
15599 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
15600 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
15601
15602 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
15603 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
15604 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
15605 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
15606 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
15607 server.
15608
15609 @end table
15610 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all these
15611 functions will be called with the group name as argument, and all the
15612 returned lists of score files will be applied. These functions can also
15613 return lists of score alists directly. In that case, the functions that
15614 return these non-file score alists should probably be placed before the
15615 ``real'' score file functions, to ensure that the last score file
15616 returned is the local score file. Phu.
15617
15618 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
15619 overall score file, you could use the value
15620 @example
15621 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
15622 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
15623 @end example
15624
15625 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
15626 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
15627 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
15628 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
15629 are expired. It's 7 by default.
15630
15631 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
15632 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
15633 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, matching score entries will have
15634 their dates updated. (This is how Gnus controls expiry---all
15635 non-matching entries will become too old while matching entries will
15636 stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this variable to @code{nil},
15637 even matching entries will grow old and will have to face that oh-so
15638 grim reaper.
15639
15640 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
15641 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
15642 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
15643
15644 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
15645 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
15646 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be simplified
15647 for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
15648 threading---according to the current value of
15649 gnus-simplify-subject-functions. If the scoring entry uses
15650 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
15651 simplified in this manner.
15652
15653 @end table
15654
15655
15656 @node Score File Format
15657 @section Score File Format
15658 @cindex score file format
15659
15660 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
15661 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
15662 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
15663
15664 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
15665
15666 @lisp
15667 (("from"
15668 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
15669 ("Per Abrahamsen")
15670 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
15671 ("subject"
15672 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
15673 ("xref"
15674 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
15675 ("lines"
15676 (2 -100 nil <))
15677 (mark 0)
15678 (expunge -1000)
15679 (mark-and-expunge -10)
15680 (read-only nil)
15681 (orphan -10)
15682 (adapt t)
15683 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
15684 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
15685 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
15686 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
15687 (eval (ding)))
15688 @end lisp
15689
15690 This example demonstrates most score file elements. For a different
15691 approach, see @pxref{Advanced Scoring}.
15692
15693 Even though this looks much like lisp code, nothing here is actually
15694 @code{eval}ed. The lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
15695 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
15696
15697 Six keys are supported by this alist:
15698
15699 @table @code
15700
15701 @item STRING
15702 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
15703 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
15704 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
15705 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
15706 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
15707 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
15708 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
15709 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
15710 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
15711 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
15712 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
15713 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
15714 to articles that matches these score entries.
15715
15716 Following this key is a arbitrary number of score entries, where each
15717 score entry has one to four elements.
15718 @enumerate
15719
15720 @item
15721 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
15722 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
15723 integer.
15724
15725 @item
15726 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
15727 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
15728 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
15729 is successful. If this element is not present, the
15730 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
15731 instead. This is 1000 by default.
15732
15733 @item
15734 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
15735 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
15736 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
15737 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
15738 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
15739
15740 @item
15741 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
15742 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
15743 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
15744 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
15745 @table @dfn
15746
15747 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
15748 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
15749 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
15750 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
15751 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
15752 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
15753 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
15754 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
15755 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
15756 instead, if you feel like.
15757
15758 @item Lines, Chars
15759 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
15760 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
15761
15762 These predicates are true if
15763
15764 @example
15765 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
15766 @end example
15767
15768 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
15769 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
15770 following form:
15771
15772 @lisp
15773 (< header-value 4)
15774 @end lisp
15775
15776 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
15777 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
15778 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
15779 it's not. I think.)
15780
15781 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
15782 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
15783 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
15784 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
15785
15786 @item Date
15787 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
15788 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
15789 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
15790 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
15791 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
15792 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
15793 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
15794
15795 @cindex ISO8601
15796 @cindex date
15797 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
15798 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
15799 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
15800 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
15801 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
15802 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
15803 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
15804 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
15805 whole family, eh?)
15806
15807 @item Head, Body, All
15808 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
15809 header uses.
15810
15811 @item Followup
15812 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
15813 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
15814 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
15815 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
15816 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
15817 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
15818 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
15819 files.)
15820
15821 @item Thread
15822 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
15823 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
15824 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
15825 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
15826 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
15827 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
15828 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
15829 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
15830 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
15831 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
15832 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
15833 @end table
15834 @end enumerate
15835
15836 @cindex Score File Atoms
15837 @item mark
15838 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
15839 lower than this number will be marked as read.
15840
15841 @item expunge
15842 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
15843 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
15844
15845 @item mark-and-expunge
15846 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
15847 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
15848 summary buffer.
15849
15850 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
15851 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
15852 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
15853 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
15854 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
15855
15856 @item files
15857 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
15858 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
15859 this one was.
15860
15861 @item exclude-files
15862 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
15863 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
15864 other.
15865
15866 @item eval
15867 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
15868 ignored when handling global score files.
15869
15870 @item read-only
15871 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
15872 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
15873 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
15874 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
15875
15876 @item orphan
15877 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
15878 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
15879 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
15880 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
15881
15882 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
15883
15884 @example
15885 (orphan -500)
15886 (mark-and-expunge -100)
15887 @end example
15888
15889 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
15890 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
15891 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
15892 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
15893 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
15894
15895 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where there
15896 exist a few interesting threads which can't be found automatically by
15897 ordinary scoring rules.
15898
15899 @item adapt
15900 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
15901 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
15902 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
15903 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
15904 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
15905 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
15906 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
15907 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
15908 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
15909 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
15910 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
15911 it.
15912
15913 @item adapt-file
15914 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
15915 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
15916 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
15917 file for a number of groups.
15918
15919 @item local
15920 @cindex local variables
15921 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(VAR VALUE)} pairs.
15922 Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the current summary buffer,
15923 and set to the value specified. This is a convenient, if somewhat
15924 strange, way of setting variables in some groups if you don't like hooks
15925 much. Note that the @var{value} won't be evaluated.
15926 @end table
15927
15928
15929 @node Score File Editing
15930 @section Score File Editing
15931
15932 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
15933 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
15934 with a mode for that.
15935
15936 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
15937 additional commands:
15938
15939 @table @kbd
15940
15941 @item C-c C-c
15942 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
15943 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
15944 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
15945 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
15946
15947 @item C-c C-d
15948 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
15949 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
15950 Insert the current date in numerical format
15951 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
15952 you were wondering.
15953
15954 @item C-c C-p
15955 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
15956 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
15957 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
15958 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
15959 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
15960 you.
15961
15962 @end table
15963
15964 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
15965
15966 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
15967 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
15968
15969 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f} and @kbd{V
15970 e} to begin editing score files.
15971
15972
15973 @node Adaptive Scoring
15974 @section Adaptive Scoring
15975 @cindex adaptive scoring
15976
15977 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
15978 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
15979 stupidity, to be precise.
15980
15981 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
15982 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
15983 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
15984 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
15985 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
15986 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
15987 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
15988 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
15989 variable to @code{(word line)}.
15990
15991 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
15992 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
15993 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
15994 might look something like this:
15995
15996 @lisp
15997 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
15998 '((gnus-unread-mark)
15999 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
16000 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
16001 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
16002 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
16003 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
16004 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
16005 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
16006 (gnus-ancient-mark)
16007 (gnus-low-score-mark)
16008 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
16009 @end lisp
16010
16011 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
16012 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
16013 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
16014 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
16015 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
16016 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
16017 entries.
16018
16019 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
16020 will be applied to each article.
16021
16022 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
16023 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{D}) will have a
16024 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
16025 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
16026
16027 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
16028 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
16029 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
16030 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
16031
16032 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
16033 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
16034 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
16035 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
16036
16037 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
16038 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
16039 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
16040 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
16041 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
16042 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
16043
16044 You can also score on @code{thread}, which will try to score all
16045 articles that appear in a thread. @code{thread} matches uses a
16046 @code{Message-ID} to match on the @code{References} header of the
16047 article. If the match is made, the @code{Message-ID} of the article is
16048 added to the @code{thread} rule. (Think about it. I'd recommend two
16049 aspirins afterwards.)
16050
16051 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
16052 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
16053 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
16054
16055 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
16056 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
16057 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
16058
16059 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
16060 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
16061 let you use different rules in different groups.
16062
16063 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
16064 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
16065 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
16066 is @samp{ADAPT}.
16067
16068 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
16069 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
16070 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
16071 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
16072 the length of the match is less than
16073 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
16074 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
16075 this problem.
16076
16077 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
16078 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
16079 headers. If you adapt on words, the
16080 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
16081 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
16082
16083 @lisp
16084 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
16085 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
16086 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
16087 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
16088 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
16089 @end lisp
16090
16091 This is the default value. If you adapt on words, every
16092 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
16093 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
16094 score with 30 points.
16095
16096 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
16097 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
16098 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
16099 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
16100 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
16101
16102 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
16103 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
16104 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
16105 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
16106
16107 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
16108 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
16109 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
16110 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
16111
16112 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
16113 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
16114 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
16115 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
16116 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
16117
16118 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
16119 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
16120 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
16121
16122 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
16123 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
16124 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
16125 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
16126
16127
16128 @node Home Score File
16129 @section Home Score File
16130
16131 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
16132 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
16133 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
16134 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
16135
16136 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
16137 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
16138 could perhaps use the same home score file.
16139
16140 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
16141 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
16142 be:
16143
16144 @enumerate
16145 @item
16146 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
16147 groups.
16148
16149 @item
16150 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
16151 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
16152 parameter.
16153
16154 @item
16155 A list. The elements in this list can be:
16156
16157 @enumerate
16158 @item
16159 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
16160 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
16161
16162 @item
16163 A function. If the function returns non-nil, the result will be used as
16164 the home score file.
16165
16166 @item
16167 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
16168 @end enumerate
16169
16170 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
16171 for matches.
16172
16173 @end enumerate
16174
16175 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
16176
16177 @lisp
16178 (setq gnus-home-score-file
16179 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
16180 @end lisp
16181
16182 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
16183 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
16184
16185 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
16186 @lisp
16187 (setq gnus-home-score-file
16188 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
16189 @end lisp
16190
16191 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
16192 Other functions include
16193
16194 @table @code
16195 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
16196 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
16197 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
16198 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
16199
16200 @end table
16201
16202 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
16203 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
16204 their own home score files:
16205
16206 @lisp
16207 (setq gnus-home-score-file
16208 ;; All groups that match the regexp "\\.emacs"
16209 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
16210 ;; All the comp groups in one score file
16211 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
16212 @end lisp
16213
16214 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
16215 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
16216 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
16217 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
16218 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
16219
16220 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
16221 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
16222 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
16223 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
16224 precedence over this variable.
16225
16226
16227 @node Followups To Yourself
16228 @section Followups To Yourself
16229
16230 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
16231 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
16232 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
16233 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
16234 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
16235 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
16236
16237 @table @code
16238
16239 @item gnus-score-followup-article
16240 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
16241 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
16242 article.
16243
16244 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
16245 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
16246 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
16247 your own article.
16248 @end table
16249
16250 @vindex message-sent-hook
16251 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
16252 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
16253 @lisp
16254 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
16255 @end lisp
16256
16257
16258 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
16259 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
16260 mine:
16261
16262 @example
16263 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
16264 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
16265 @end example
16266
16267 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
16268 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
16269 myself:
16270
16271 @lisp
16272 ("references"
16273 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
16274 1000 nil r))
16275 @end lisp
16276
16277 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
16278 is system-dependent.
16279
16280
16281 @node Scoring Tips
16282 @section Scoring Tips
16283 @cindex scoring tips
16284
16285 @table @dfn
16286
16287 @item Crossposts
16288 @cindex crossposts
16289 @cindex scoring crossposts
16290 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
16291 the @code{Xref} header.
16292 @lisp
16293 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
16294 @end lisp
16295
16296 @item Multiple crossposts
16297 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
16298 more than, say, 3 groups:
16299 @lisp
16300 ("xref"
16301 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
16302 -1000 nil r))
16303 @end lisp
16304
16305 @item Matching on the body
16306 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
16307 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
16308 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
16309 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
16310 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
16311 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
16312 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
16313 the matches.
16314
16315 @item Marking as read
16316 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
16317 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
16318 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
16319 @lisp
16320 ((mark -100))
16321 @end lisp
16322 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
16323
16324 @item Negated character classes
16325 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
16326 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
16327 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
16328 @end table
16329
16330
16331 @node Reverse Scoring
16332 @section Reverse Scoring
16333 @cindex reverse scoring
16334
16335 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
16336 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
16337 like this in your score file:
16338
16339 @lisp
16340 (("subject"
16341 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
16342 (mark 1)
16343 (expunge 1))
16344 @end lisp
16345
16346 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
16347 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
16348
16349
16350 @node Global Score Files
16351 @section Global Score Files
16352 @cindex global score files
16353
16354 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
16355 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
16356 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
16357
16358 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
16359 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
16360 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
16361
16362 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
16363 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
16364 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
16365 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
16366 files are applicable to which group.
16367
16368 To use the score file
16369 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
16370 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
16371 say this:
16372
16373 @lisp
16374 (setq gnus-global-score-files
16375 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
16376 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
16377 @end lisp
16378
16379 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
16380 @noindent
16381 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
16382 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
16383 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
16384 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
16385
16386 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
16387 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
16388
16389 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
16390 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
16391 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
16392 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
16393 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
16394 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
16395
16396 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
16397 head:
16398
16399 @itemize @bullet
16400
16401 @item
16402 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
16403 @item
16404 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
16405 @item
16406 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
16407 @item
16408 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
16409 lowered out of existence.
16410 @item
16411 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
16412 articles completely.
16413
16414 @item
16415 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
16416 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
16417 old articles for a long time.
16418 @end itemize
16419
16420 ... I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
16421 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
16422 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
16423 holding our breath yet?
16424
16425
16426 @node Kill Files
16427 @section Kill Files
16428 @cindex kill files
16429
16430 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
16431 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
16432 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
16433
16434 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
16435 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
16436 files into score files.
16437
16438 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
16439 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
16440 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
16441 that isn't a very good idea.
16442
16443 Normal kill files look like this:
16444
16445 @lisp
16446 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
16447 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
16448 (gnus-expunge "X")
16449 @end lisp
16450
16451 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
16452 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
16453
16454 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
16455 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
16456 interpreting it.
16457
16458 Two summary functions for editing a GNUS kill file:
16459
16460 @table @kbd
16461
16462 @item M-k
16463 @kindex M-k @r{(Summary)}
16464 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
16465 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
16466
16467 @item M-K
16468 @kindex M-K @r{(Summary)}
16469 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
16470 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
16471 @end table
16472
16473 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
16474
16475 @table @kbd
16476
16477 @item M-k
16478 @kindex M-k @r{(Group)}
16479 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
16480 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
16481
16482 @item M-K
16483 @kindex M-K @r{(Group)}
16484 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
16485 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
16486 @end table
16487
16488 Kill file variables:
16489
16490 @table @code
16491 @item gnus-kill-file-name
16492 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
16493 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
16494 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
16495 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
16496 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
16497 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
16498
16499 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
16500 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
16501 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
16502 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
16503 kills.
16504
16505 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
16506 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
16507 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
16508 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
16509 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
16510 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
16511 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
16512 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
16513 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
16514
16515 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
16516 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
16517 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
16518
16519 @end table
16520
16521
16522 @node Converting Kill Files
16523 @section Converting Kill Files
16524 @cindex kill files
16525 @cindex converting kill files
16526
16527 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
16528 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
16529 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
16530 by hand.
16531
16532 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
16533 You can fetch it from
16534 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
16535
16536 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
16537 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
16538 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
16539 before.
16540
16541
16542 @node GroupLens
16543 @section GroupLens
16544 @cindex GroupLens
16545
16546 GroupLens is a collaborative filtering system that helps you work
16547 together with other people to find the quality news articles out of the
16548 huge volume of news articles generated every day.
16549
16550 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
16551 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
16552 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
16553 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
16554 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
16555 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
16556 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
16557 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
16558 article.
16559
16560 @menu
16561 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
16562 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
16563 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
16564 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
16565 @end menu
16566
16567
16568 @node Using GroupLens
16569 @subsection Using GroupLens
16570
16571 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local Better
16572 Bit Bureau (BBB).
16573 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html} is the only
16574 better bit in town at the moment.
16575
16576 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
16577
16578 @table @code
16579
16580 @item gnus-use-grouplens
16581 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
16582 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
16583 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
16584
16585 @item grouplens-pseudonym
16586 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
16587 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
16588 with the Better Bit Bureau.
16589
16590 @item grouplens-newsgroups
16591 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
16592 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
16593
16594 @end table
16595
16596 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
16597 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
16598 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
16599 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
16600 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
16601 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
16602
16603
16604 @node Rating Articles
16605 @subsection Rating Articles
16606
16607 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
16608 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
16609 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
16610 yourself is, "on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
16611 like this one?"
16612
16613 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
16614
16615 @table @kbd
16616
16617 @item r
16618 @kindex r (GroupLens)
16619 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
16620 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
16621
16622 @item k
16623 @kindex k (GroupLens)
16624 @findex grouplens-score-thread
16625 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
16626 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
16627 threads in rec.humor.
16628
16629 @end table
16630
16631 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
16632 the score of the article you're reading.
16633
16634 @table @kbd
16635
16636 @item 1-5 n
16637 @kindex n (GroupLens)
16638 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
16639 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
16640
16641 @item 1-5 ,
16642 @kindex , (GroupLens)
16643 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
16644 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
16645
16646 @end table
16647
16648 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
16649 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
16650
16651
16652 @node Displaying Predictions
16653 @subsection Displaying Predictions
16654
16655 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
16656 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
16657 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
16658 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
16659 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
16660
16661 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
16662 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
16663 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
16664 regular gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
16665 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
16666 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
16667 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
16668 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
16669 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
16670 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
16671 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
16672 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
16673 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
16674
16675 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
16676 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
16677 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
16678 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
16679
16680 The following are valid values for that variable.
16681
16682 @table @code
16683 @item prediction-spot
16684 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
16685 displayed.
16686
16687 @item confidence-interval
16688 A numeric confidence interval.
16689
16690 @item prediction-bar
16691 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
16692
16693 @item confidence-bar
16694 Numerical confidence.
16695
16696 @item confidence-spot
16697 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
16698
16699 @item prediction-num
16700 Plain-old numeric value.
16701
16702 @item confidence-plus-minus
16703 Prediction +/- confidence.
16704
16705 @end table
16706
16707
16708 @node GroupLens Variables
16709 @subsection GroupLens Variables
16710
16711 @table @code
16712
16713 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
16714 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
16715 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
16716 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-20,20n%]%)
16717 %s\n}.
16718
16719 @item grouplens-bbb-host
16720 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
16721 default.
16722
16723 @item grouplens-bbb-port
16724 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
16725
16726 @item grouplens-score-offset
16727 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
16728 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
16729 default is 0.
16730
16731 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
16732 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
16733 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
16734
16735 @end table
16736
16737
16738 @node Advanced Scoring
16739 @section Advanced Scoring
16740
16741 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
16742 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
16743 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
16744 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
16745 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
16746
16747 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
16748 scoring patterns.
16749
16750 @menu
16751 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
16752 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
16753 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
16754 @end menu
16755
16756
16757 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
16758 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
16759
16760 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
16761 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
16762 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
16763 non-@code{nil} value.
16764
16765 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
16766 operator, and various match operators.
16767
16768 Logical operators:
16769
16770 @table @code
16771 @item &
16772 @itemx and
16773 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
16774 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
16775 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
16776 @code{true}.
16777
16778 @item |
16779 @itemx or
16780 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
16781 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
16782 then this operator will return @code{false}.
16783
16784 @item !
16785 @itemx not
16786 @itemx ¬
16787 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
16788 logical negation of the value of its argument.
16789
16790 @end table
16791
16792 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
16793 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
16794 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
16795 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
16796 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
16797 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
16798 the ancestry you want to go.
16799
16800 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
16801 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
16802 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
16803 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
16804 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
16805
16806
16807 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
16808 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
16809
16810 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
16811 when he's talking about Gnus:
16812
16813 @example
16814 ((&
16815 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
16816 ("subject" "Gnus"))
16817 1000)
16818 @end example
16819
16820 Quite simple, huh?
16821
16822 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
16823
16824 @example
16825 ((&
16826 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
16827 (|
16828 ("subject" "Gnus")
16829 ("lines" 100 >)))
16830 1000)
16831 @end example
16832
16833 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
16834 really don't want to read what he's written:
16835
16836 @example
16837 ((&
16838 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
16839 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigir Logge")))
16840 -100000)
16841 @end example
16842
16843 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
16844 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
16845 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
16846 very interesting:
16847
16848 @example
16849 ((&
16850 (1-
16851 (&
16852 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
16853 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
16854 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
16855 ("body" "white.*socks"))
16856 1000)
16857 @end example
16858
16859 The possibilities are endless.
16860
16861
16862 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
16863 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
16864
16865 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
16866 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
16867 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
16868 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
16869 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
16870 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
16871 @samp{subject}) first.
16872
16873 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
16874 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
16875 something like:
16876
16877 @example
16878 ...
16879 (1-
16880 (1-
16881 ("from" "lars")))
16882 ...
16883 @end example
16884
16885 Then that means "score on the from header of the grandparent of the
16886 current article". An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
16887
16888 @example
16889 (1-
16890 (&
16891 ("from" "Lars")
16892 ("subject" "Gnus")))
16893 @end example
16894
16895 than it is to say:
16896
16897 @example
16898 (&
16899 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
16900 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
16901 @end example
16902
16903
16904 @node Score Decays
16905 @section Score Decays
16906 @cindex score decays
16907 @cindex decays
16908
16909 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
16910 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
16911 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
16912 use them in any sensible way.
16913
16914 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
16915 @findex gnus-decay-score
16916 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
16917 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
16918 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
16919 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
16920 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
16921 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
16922 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
16923 definition of that function:
16924
16925 @lisp
16926 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
16927 "Decay SCORE.
16928 This is done according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
16929 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
16930 (floor
16931 (- score
16932 (* (if (< score 0) 1 -1)
16933 (min (abs score)
16934 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
16935 (* (abs score)
16936 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
16937 @end lisp
16938
16939 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
16940 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
16941 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
16942 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
16943
16944 @enumerate
16945 @item
16946 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
16947
16948 @item
16949 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
16950
16951 @item
16952 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
16953 score.
16954 @end enumerate
16955
16956 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
16957 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
16958 the new score, which should be an integer.
16959
16960 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
16961 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
16962
16963
16964 @node Various
16965 @chapter Various
16966
16967 @menu
16968 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
16969 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
16970 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
16971 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
16972 * Windows Configuration:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
16973 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
16974 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
16975 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
16976 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
16977 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
16978 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
16979 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
16980 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
16981 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
16982 * Emacs Enhancements:: There can be more pictures and stuff under
16983 Emacs 21.
16984 * XEmacs Enhancements:: There are more pictures and stuff under XEmacs.
16985 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
16986 * Thwarting Email Spam:: A how-to on avoiding unsolicited commercial email.
16987 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
16988 @end menu
16989
16990
16991 @node Process/Prefix
16992 @section Process/Prefix
16993 @cindex process/prefix convention
16994
16995 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
16996 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
16997
16998 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
16999 command to be performed on.
17000
17001 It goes like this:
17002
17003 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
17004 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
17005 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
17006 with the current one.
17007
17008 @vindex transient-mark-mode
17009 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
17010 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
17011
17012 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
17013 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
17014 the process mark.
17015
17016 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
17017 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
17018
17019 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
17020 are avoided.
17021
17022 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
17023 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
17024 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
17025 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
17026
17027 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
17028 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
17029 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
17030 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
17031 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
17032 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
17033 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
17034 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
17035
17036 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
17037 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
17038 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
17039 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
17040 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
17041
17042
17043 @node Interactive
17044 @section Interactive
17045 @cindex interaction
17046
17047 @table @code
17048
17049 @item gnus-novice-user
17050 @vindex gnus-novice-user
17051 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
17052 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
17053 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
17054 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
17055 default.
17056
17057 @item gnus-expert-user
17058 @vindex gnus-expert-user
17059 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
17060 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
17061 matter how strange.
17062
17063 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
17064 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
17065 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
17066 is @code{t} by default.
17067
17068 @item gnus-interactive-exit
17069 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
17070 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
17071 default.
17072 @end table
17073
17074
17075 @node Symbolic Prefixes
17076 @section Symbolic Prefixes
17077 @cindex symbolic prefixes
17078
17079 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
17080 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
17081 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
17082 rule of 900 to the current article.
17083
17084 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
17085 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
17086 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
17087 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
17088 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
17089 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
17090 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
17091
17092 @kindex M-i @r{(Summary)}
17093 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
17094 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
17095 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
17096 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
17097 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
17098 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
17099 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
17100 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
17101
17102 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
17103 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
17104 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
17105
17106 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
17107 Interactive}.
17108
17109
17110 @node Formatting Variables
17111 @section Formatting Variables
17112 @cindex formatting variables
17113
17114 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
17115 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
17116 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
17117 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
17118 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
17119 be annoyed by.
17120
17121 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
17122 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
17123 lots of percentages everywhere.
17124
17125 @menu
17126 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
17127 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
17128 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
17129 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
17130 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
17131 @end menu
17132
17133 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
17134 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
17135 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
17136 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
17137 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
17138 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
17139 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
17140 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
17141
17142 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
17143 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
17144
17145 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
17146 @findex gnus-update-format
17147 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
17148 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
17149 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
17150 examine the resulting lisp code to be run to generate the line.
17151
17152
17153
17154 @node Formatting Basics
17155 @subsection Formatting Basics
17156
17157 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
17158 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
17159 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
17160
17161 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
17162 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
17163 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
17164 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
17165 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
17166 the right instead.
17167
17168 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
17169 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
17170 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
17171 less than 4 characters wide.
17172
17173
17174 @node Mode Line Formatting
17175 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
17176
17177 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
17178 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
17179 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
17180 with the following two differences:
17181
17182 @enumerate
17183
17184 @item
17185 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
17186
17187 @item
17188 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
17189 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
17190 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
17191 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
17192 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
17193 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
17194 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
17195
17196 @end enumerate
17197
17198
17199 @node Advanced Formatting
17200 @subsection Advanced Formatting
17201
17202 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
17203 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
17204 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
17205 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
17206
17207 These are the valid modifiers:
17208
17209 @table @code
17210 @item pad
17211 @itemx pad-left
17212 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
17213 length.
17214
17215 @item pad-right
17216 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
17217 length.
17218
17219 @item max
17220 @itemx max-left
17221 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
17222
17223 @item max-right
17224 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
17225 length.
17226
17227 @item cut
17228 @itemx cut-left
17229 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
17230
17231 @item cut-right
17232 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
17233
17234 @item ignore
17235 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
17236
17237 @item form
17238 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
17239 used.
17240 @end table
17241
17242 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
17243 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
17244 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
17245 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
17246 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
17247 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
17248 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
17249
17250 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
17251 last operation, padding.
17252
17253 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
17254 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
17255 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
17256 @xref{Compilation}.
17257
17258
17259 @node User-Defined Specs
17260 @subsection User-Defined Specs
17261
17262 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
17263 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
17264 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
17265 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
17266 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
17267 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
17268 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
17269 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
17270 should protect against that.
17271
17272 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
17273 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
17274 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
17275 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
17276 inserted.
17277
17278
17279 @node Formatting Fonts
17280 @subsection Formatting Fonts
17281
17282 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
17283 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
17284 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
17285 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
17286 over it.
17287
17288 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
17289 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
17290 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
17291 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
17292 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
17293 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
17294
17295 Text inside the @samp{%<} and @samp{%>} specifiers will get the special
17296 @code{balloon-help} property set to @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you
17297 say @samp{%1<}, you'll get @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The
17298 @code{gnus-balloon-face-*} variables should be either strings or symbols
17299 naming functions that return a string. Under @code{balloon-help-mode},
17300 when the mouse passes over text with this property set, a balloon window
17301 will appear and display the string. Please refer to the doc string of
17302 @code{balloon-help-mode} for more information on this.
17303
17304 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
17305
17306 @lisp
17307 ;; Create three face types.
17308 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
17309 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
17310
17311 ;; We want the article count to be in
17312 ;; a bold and green face. So we create
17313 ;; a new face called `my-green-bold'.
17314 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
17315 ;; Set the color.
17316 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
17317 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
17318
17319 ;; Set the new & fancy format.
17320 (setq gnus-group-line-format
17321 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
17322 @end lisp
17323
17324 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
17325 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
17326
17327 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
17328 mode-line variables.
17329
17330
17331 @node Windows Configuration
17332 @section Windows Configuration
17333 @cindex windows configuration
17334
17335 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
17336
17337 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
17338 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
17339 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
17340 @code{t} by default.
17341
17342 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
17343 glitches. Use at your own peril.
17344
17345 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
17346 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
17347 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
17348
17349 @lisp
17350 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
17351 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
17352 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
17353 (article 1.0))))
17354 @end lisp
17355
17356 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
17357 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
17358 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
17359 possible names is listed below.
17360
17361 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
17362 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
17363
17364 @lisp
17365 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
17366 (article 1.0)))
17367 @end lisp
17368
17369 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
17370 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
17371 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
17372 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
17373 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
17374 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
17375 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
17376 size spec per split.
17377
17378 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
17379 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
17380 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
17381 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
17382 present) gets focus.
17383
17384 Here's a more complicated example:
17385
17386 @lisp
17387 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
17388 (summary 0.25 point)
17389 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
17390 (article 1.0)))
17391 @end lisp
17392
17393 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
17394 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
17395 occupy, not a percentage.
17396
17397 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
17398 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
17399 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
17400 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
17401 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
17402 is non-@code{nil}.
17403
17404 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
17405
17406 @lisp
17407 (article (horizontal 1.0
17408 (vertical 0.5
17409 (group 1.0)
17410 (gnus-carpal 4))
17411 (vertical 1.0
17412 (summary 0.25 point)
17413 (summary-carpal 4)
17414 (article 1.0))))
17415 @end lisp
17416
17417 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
17418 @code{horizontal} thingie?
17419
17420 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
17421 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
17422 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
17423 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
17424 the screen is to be given to this strip.
17425
17426 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
17427 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
17428 lines from the splits.
17429
17430 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
17431 may look like:
17432
17433 @example
17434 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
17435 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
17436 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
17437 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
17438 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
17439 size = number | frame-params
17440 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
17441 @end example
17442
17443 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
17444 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
17445 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
17446 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
17447
17448 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
17449 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
17450 @cindex window height
17451 @cindex window width
17452 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
17453 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
17454 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
17455 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
17456 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
17457 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
17458
17459 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
17460 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
17461 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
17462 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
17463
17464 @findex gnus-configure-frame
17465 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
17466 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
17467 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
17468 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
17469 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
17470 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
17471 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
17472 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
17473 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
17474 configuration list.
17475
17476 @lisp
17477 (gnus-configure-frame
17478 '(horizontal 1.0
17479 (vertical 10
17480 (group 1.0)
17481 (article 0.3 point))
17482 (vertical 1.0
17483 (article 1.0)
17484 (horizontal 4
17485 (group 1.0)
17486 (article 10)))))
17487 @end lisp
17488
17489 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
17490 @code{frame} split:
17491
17492 @lisp
17493 (gnus-configure-frame
17494 '(frame 1.0
17495 (vertical 1.0
17496 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
17497 (article 1.0))
17498 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
17499 (user-position . t)
17500 (left . -1) (top . 1))
17501 (picon 1.0))))
17502
17503 @end lisp
17504
17505 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
17506 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
17507 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
17508 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
17509 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
17510 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
17511 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
17512 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
17513 is such a plist.
17514 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
17515 be found in its default value.
17516
17517 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
17518 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
17519 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
17520 might be used:
17521
17522 @lisp
17523 (message (horizontal 1.0
17524 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
17525 (vertical 0.24
17526 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
17527 '(summary 0.5))
17528 (group 1.0)))))
17529 @end lisp
17530
17531 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
17532 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
17533 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
17534
17535 @lisp
17536 (message
17537 (frame 1.0
17538 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
17539 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
17540 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
17541 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
17542 (name . "Message"))
17543 (message 1.0 point))))
17544 @end lisp
17545
17546 @findex gnus-add-configuration
17547 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
17548 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
17549 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
17550 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
17551
17552 @lisp
17553 (gnus-add-configuration
17554 '(article (vertical 1.0
17555 (group 4)
17556 (summary .25 point)
17557 (article 1.0))))
17558 @end lisp
17559
17560 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
17561 @file{.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
17562 Gnus has been loaded.
17563
17564 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
17565 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
17566 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
17567 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
17568 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
17569
17570 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
17571 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
17572 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
17573 windows resized.
17574
17575 @subsection Example Window Configurations
17576
17577 @itemize @bullet
17578 @item
17579 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
17580 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
17581
17582 @ifinfo
17583 @example
17584 +---+---------+
17585 | G | Summary |
17586 | r +---------+
17587 | o | |
17588 | u | Article |
17589 | p | |
17590 +---+---------+
17591 @end example
17592 @end ifinfo
17593
17594 @lisp
17595 (gnus-add-configuration
17596 '(article
17597 (horizontal 1.0
17598 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
17599 (vertical 1.0
17600 (summary 0.16 point)
17601 (article 1.0)))))
17602
17603 (gnus-add-configuration
17604 '(summary
17605 (horizontal 1.0
17606 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
17607 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
17608 @end lisp
17609
17610 @end itemize
17611
17612
17613 @node Faces and Fonts
17614 @section Faces and Fonts
17615 @cindex faces
17616 @cindex fonts
17617 @cindex colors
17618
17619 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
17620 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
17621 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
17622 interface.
17623
17624
17625 @node Compilation
17626 @section Compilation
17627 @cindex compilation
17628 @cindex byte-compilation
17629
17630 @findex gnus-compile
17631
17632 Remember all those line format specification variables?
17633 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
17634 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
17635 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
17636 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
17637 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
17638 course.)
17639
17640 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
17641 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
17642 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
17643 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
17644 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
17645 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
17646 them into the @code{.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
17647
17648
17649 @node Mode Lines
17650 @section Mode Lines
17651 @cindex mode lines
17652
17653 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
17654 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
17655 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
17656 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
17657 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
17658 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
17659 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
17660 quicker.
17661
17662 @cindex display-time
17663
17664 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
17665 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
17666 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
17667 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
17668 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
17669 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
17670 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
17671 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
17672 this variable:
17673
17674 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
17675 @lisp
17676 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
17677 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
17678 (+ 21
17679 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
17680 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
17681 (length display-time-string)))))
17682 @end lisp
17683
17684 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
17685 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
17686 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
17687 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
17688 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
17689
17690
17691 @node Highlighting and Menus
17692 @section Highlighting and Menus
17693 @cindex visual
17694 @cindex highlighting
17695 @cindex menus
17696
17697 @vindex gnus-visual
17698 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
17699 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
17700 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
17701 file.
17702
17703 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
17704 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
17705
17706 @table @code
17707 @item group-highlight
17708 Do highlights in the group buffer.
17709 @item summary-highlight
17710 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
17711 @item article-highlight
17712 Do highlights in the article buffer.
17713 @item highlight
17714 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
17715 @item group-menu
17716 Create menus in the group buffer.
17717 @item summary-menu
17718 Create menus in the summary buffers.
17719 @item article-menu
17720 Create menus in the article buffer.
17721 @item browse-menu
17722 Create menus in the browse buffer.
17723 @item server-menu
17724 Create menus in the server buffer.
17725 @item score-menu
17726 Create menus in the score buffers.
17727 @item menu
17728 Create menus in all buffers.
17729 @end table
17730
17731 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
17732 buffers, you could say something like:
17733
17734 @lisp
17735 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
17736 @end lisp
17737
17738 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
17739
17740 @lisp
17741 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
17742 @end lisp
17743
17744 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
17745 in all Gnus buffers.
17746
17747 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
17748
17749 @table @code
17750 @item gnus-mouse-face
17751 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
17752 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
17753 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
17754
17755 @end table
17756
17757 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
17758
17759 @table @code
17760
17761 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
17762 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
17763 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
17764
17765 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
17766 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
17767 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
17768
17769 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
17770 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
17771 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
17772
17773 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
17774 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
17775 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
17776
17777 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
17778 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
17779 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
17780
17781 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
17782 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
17783 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
17784
17785 @end table
17786
17787
17788 @node Buttons
17789 @section Buttons
17790 @cindex buttons
17791 @cindex mouse
17792 @cindex click
17793
17794 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions are very popular with the
17795 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
17796 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
17797 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
17798 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
17799
17800 Right.
17801
17802 @vindex gnus-carpal
17803 Well, you can make Gnus display buffers full of buttons you can click to
17804 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
17805 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
17806
17807
17808 @table @code
17809
17810 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
17811 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
17812 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
17813
17814 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
17815 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
17816 Face used on buttons.
17817
17818 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
17819 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
17820 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
17821
17822 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
17823 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
17824 Buttons in the group buffer.
17825
17826 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
17827 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
17828 Buttons in the summary buffer.
17829
17830 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
17831 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
17832 Buttons in the server buffer.
17833
17834 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
17835 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
17836 Buttons in the browse buffer.
17837 @end table
17838
17839 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
17840 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
17841 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
17842
17843
17844 @node Daemons
17845 @section Daemons
17846 @cindex demons
17847 @cindex daemons
17848
17849 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
17850 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
17851 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
17852 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
17853 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
17854
17855 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
17856 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
17857 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
17858
17859 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
17860 been idle for thirty minutes:
17861
17862 @lisp
17863 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
17864 @end lisp
17865
17866 Here's a handler that scans for PGP headers every hour when Emacs is
17867 idle:
17868
17869 @lisp
17870 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
17871 @end lisp
17872
17873 This @var{time} parameter and than @var{idle} parameter work together
17874 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
17875 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
17876
17877 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
17878 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
17879 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
17880 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
17881
17882 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
17883 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
17884 @var{idle} minutes.
17885
17886 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
17887 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
17888 minutes.
17889
17890 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
17891 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
17892 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
17893
17894 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
17895 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
17896 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
17897 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
17898
17899 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
17900 your @file{.gnus} file:
17901
17902 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
17903 @lisp
17904 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
17905 @end lisp
17906
17907 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
17908 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
17909 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
17910 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
17911 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
17912 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
17913 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
17914 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
17915 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
17916 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
17917 @file{.gnus} if you want those abilities.
17918
17919 @findex gnus-demon-init
17920 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
17921 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
17922 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
17923 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
17924 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
17925
17926 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
17927 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
17928 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
17929 behave.
17930
17931
17932 @node NoCeM
17933 @section NoCeM
17934 @cindex nocem
17935 @cindex spam
17936
17937 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
17938 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
17939
17940 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
17941 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
17942 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
17943 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
17944 away.
17945
17946 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
17947 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
17948 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
17949 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
17950
17951 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
17952 this will make spam disappear.
17953
17954 There are some variables to customize, of course:
17955
17956 @table @code
17957 @item gnus-use-nocem
17958 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
17959 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
17960 by default.
17961
17962 @item gnus-nocem-groups
17963 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
17964 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
17965 default is @code{("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
17966 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")}.
17967
17968 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
17969 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
17970 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
17971 people you want to listen to. The default is @code{("Automoose-1"
17972 "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo"
17973 "hweede@@snafu.de")}; fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
17974
17975 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at
17976 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
17977
17978 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
17979 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
17980 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
17981 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
17982 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
17983 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
17984 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
17985 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
17986 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
17987 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
17988
17989 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
17990 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
17991
17992 @lisp
17993 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
17994 @end lisp
17995
17996 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
17997 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
17998
17999 @lisp
18000 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
18001 @end lisp
18002
18003 The specs are applied left-to-right.
18004
18005
18006 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
18007 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
18008 @findex mc-verify
18009 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
18010 says she is. The default is @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
18011 function. If this is too slow and you don't care for verification
18012 (which may be dangerous), you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
18013
18014 If you want signed NoCeM messages to be verified and unsigned messages
18015 not to be verified (but used anyway), you could do something like:
18016
18017 @lisp
18018 (setq gnus-nocem-verifyer 'my-gnus-mc-verify)
18019
18020 (defun my-gnus-mc-verify ()
18021 (not (eq 'forged
18022 (ignore-errors
18023 (if (mc-verify)
18024 t
18025 'forged)))))
18026 @end lisp
18027
18028 This might be dangerous, though.
18029
18030 @item gnus-nocem-directory
18031 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
18032 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is
18033 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
18034
18035 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
18036 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
18037 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
18038 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
18039 might then see old spam.
18040
18041 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
18042 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
18043 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
18044 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
18045 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
18046 issuers.
18047
18048 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
18049 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
18050 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
18051 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
18052
18053 @end table
18054
18055 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
18056 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
18057 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
18058 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
18059
18060
18061 @node Undo
18062 @section Undo
18063 @cindex undo
18064
18065 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
18066 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
18067 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
18068
18069 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
18070 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
18071 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
18072 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
18073 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
18074 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
18075 @code{undo} function.
18076
18077 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
18078 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
18079 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
18080 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
18081 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
18082 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
18083 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
18084 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
18085 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
18086 never be totally undoable.
18087
18088 @findex gnus-undo-mode
18089 @vindex gnus-use-undo
18090 @findex gnus-undo
18091 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
18092 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
18093 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
18094 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
18095 command.
18096
18097
18098 @node Moderation
18099 @section Moderation
18100 @cindex moderation
18101
18102 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
18103 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
18104 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
18105 get a copy.
18106
18107 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
18108 buffers. Put
18109
18110 @lisp
18111 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
18112 @end lisp
18113
18114 in your @file{.gnus.el} file.
18115
18116 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
18117 supposed to work:
18118
18119 @enumerate
18120 @item
18121 You split your incoming mail by matching on
18122 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
18123 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
18124
18125 @item
18126 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
18127 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
18128
18129 @item
18130 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
18131 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
18132 @kbd{c} command.
18133 @end enumerate
18134
18135 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
18136
18137 @lisp
18138 (setq gnus-moderated-list
18139 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
18140 @end lisp
18141
18142 @node Emacs Enhancements
18143 @section Emacs Enhancements
18144 @cindex Emacs 21
18145
18146 Starting with version 21, Emacs is able to display pictures and stuff,
18147 so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
18148
18149 Gnus-specific tool bars will be used if Tool Bar mode is on. Currently
18150 the group, summary and message buffers have tool bars defined.
18151
18152 MIME image types may be displayed internally if Emacs was built with
18153 appropriate support (see variable @code{image-types}). `X-Face' headers
18154 may be rendered as images internally if you have appropriate support
18155 programs (@pxref{X-Face}). You can play sounds internally if Emacs was
18156 built with suitable audio support; otherwise Gnus will attempt to play
18157 sounds externally.
18158
18159 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
18160 A simplified version of the XEmacs Smiley support for @dfn{emoticons}
18161 (@pxref{Smileys}) is available on graphical displays under the control
18162 of @code{gnus-treat-display-smileys}. Text `smiley' faces---@samp{:-)},
18163 @samp{:-/}, @samp{:-(} and the like---are mapped to pictures which are
18164 displayed instead. The mapping is controlled by a list of regexps
18165 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
18166 @code{smiley-regexp-alist} mapping matched text to image file names. It
18167 contains matches for `smiley', `wry' and `frowny' by default.
18168
18169 There is currently no Emacs support for `Picons' (@pxref{Picons}), but
18170 there is no reason why it couldn't be added.
18171
18172 @node XEmacs Enhancements
18173 @section XEmacs Enhancements
18174 @cindex XEmacs
18175
18176 XEmacs is able to display pictures and stuff, so Gnus has taken
18177 advantage of that.
18178
18179 @menu
18180 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what your reading.
18181 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
18182 * Toolbar:: Click'n'drool.
18183 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
18184 @end menu
18185
18186
18187 @node Picons
18188 @subsection Picons
18189
18190 @iftex
18191 @iflatex
18192 \include{picons}
18193 @end iflatex
18194 @end iftex
18195
18196 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
18197 good way to do so. Its also a great way to impress people staring
18198 over your shoulder as you read news.
18199
18200 @menu
18201 * Picon Basics:: What are picons and How do I get them.
18202 * Picon Requirements:: Don't go further if you aren't using XEmacs.
18203 * Easy Picons:: Displaying Picons---the easy way.
18204 * Hard Picons:: The way you should do it. You'll learn something.
18205 * Picon Useless Configuration:: Other variables you can trash/tweak/munge/play with.
18206 @end menu
18207
18208
18209 @node Picon Basics
18210 @subsubsection Picon Basics
18211
18212 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
18213
18214 @iftex
18215 @iflatex
18216 \margindex{}
18217 @end iflatex
18218 @end iftex
18219
18220 @quotation
18221 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
18222 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
18223 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
18224 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
18225 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
18226 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
18227 @code{GIF} formats.
18228 @end quotation
18229
18230 @vindex gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
18231 If you have a permanent connection to the Internet you can use Steve
18232 Kinzler's Picons Search engine by setting
18233 @code{gnus-picons-piconsearch-url} to the string @*
18234 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/search.html}.
18235
18236 @vindex gnus-picons-database
18237 Otherwise you need a local copy of his database. For instructions on
18238 obtaining and installing the picons databases, point your Web browser at @*
18239 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}. Gnus expects
18240 picons to be installed into a location pointed to by
18241 @code{gnus-picons-database}.
18242
18243
18244 @node Picon Requirements
18245 @subsubsection Picon Requirements
18246
18247 To have Gnus display Picons for you, you must be running XEmacs
18248 19.13 or greater since all other versions of Emacs aren't yet able to
18249 display images.
18250
18251 Additionally, you must have @code{x} support compiled into XEmacs. To
18252 display color picons which are much nicer than the black & white one,
18253 you also need one of @code{xpm} or @code{gif} compiled into XEmacs.
18254
18255 @vindex gnus-picons-convert-x-face
18256 If you want to display faces from @code{X-Face} headers, you should have
18257 the @code{xface} support compiled into XEmacs. Otherwise you must have
18258 the @code{netpbm} utilities installed, or munge the
18259 @code{gnus-picons-convert-x-face} variable to use something else.
18260
18261
18262 @node Easy Picons
18263 @subsubsection Easy Picons
18264
18265 To enable displaying picons, simply put the following line in your
18266 @file{~/.gnus} file and start Gnus.
18267
18268 @lisp
18269 (setq gnus-use-picons t)
18270 (setq gnus-treat-display-picons t)
18271 @end lisp
18272
18273 and make sure @code{gnus-picons-database} points to the directory
18274 containing the Picons databases.
18275
18276 Alternatively if you want to use the web piconsearch engine add this:
18277
18278 @lisp
18279 (setq gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
18280 "http://www.cs.indiana.edu:800/piconsearch")
18281 @end lisp
18282
18283
18284 @node Hard Picons
18285 @subsubsection Hard Picons
18286
18287 @iftex
18288 @iflatex
18289 \margindex{}
18290 @end iflatex
18291 @end iftex
18292
18293 Gnus can display picons for you as you enter and leave groups and
18294 articles. It knows how to interact with three sections of the picons
18295 database. Namely, it can display the picons newsgroup pictures,
18296 author's face picture(s), and the authors domain. To enable this
18297 feature, you need to select where to get the picons from, and where to
18298 display them.
18299
18300 @table @code
18301
18302 @item gnus-picons-database
18303 @vindex gnus-picons-database
18304 The location of the picons database. Should point to a directory
18305 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
18306 subdirectories. This is only useful if
18307 @code{gnus-picons-piconsearch-url} is @code{nil}. Defaults to
18308 @file{/usr/local/faces/}.
18309
18310 @item gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
18311 @vindex gnus-picons-piconsearch-url
18312 The URL for the web picons search engine. The only currently known
18313 engine is @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu:800/piconsearch}. To
18314 workaround network delays, icons will be fetched in the background. If
18315 this is @code{nil} 'the default), then picons are fetched from local
18316 database indicated by @code{gnus-picons-database}.
18317
18318 @item gnus-picons-display-where
18319 @vindex gnus-picons-display-where
18320 Where the picon images should be displayed. It is @code{picons} by
18321 default (which by default maps to the buffer @samp{*Picons*}). Other
18322 valid places could be @code{article}, @code{summary}, or
18323 @samp{*scratch*} for all I care. Just make sure that you've made the
18324 buffer visible using the standard Gnus window configuration
18325 routines---@pxref{Windows Configuration}.
18326
18327 @item gnus-picons-group-excluded-groups
18328 @vindex gnus-picons-group-excluded-groups
18329 Groups that are matched by this regexp won't have their group icons
18330 displayed.
18331
18332 @end table
18333
18334 Note: If you set @code{gnus-use-picons} to @code{t}, it will set up your
18335 window configuration for you to include the @code{picons} buffer.
18336
18337 Now that you've made those decision, you need to add the following
18338 functions to the appropriate hooks so these pictures will get displayed
18339 at the right time.
18340
18341 @vindex gnus-picons-display-where
18342 @table @code
18343 @item gnus-article-display-picons
18344 @findex gnus-article-display-picons
18345 Looks up and displays the picons for the author and the author's domain
18346 in the @code{gnus-picons-display-where} buffer.
18347
18348 @item gnus-picons-article-display-x-face
18349 @findex gnus-article-display-picons
18350 Decodes and displays the X-Face header if present.
18351
18352 @end table
18353
18354
18355
18356 @node Picon Useless Configuration
18357 @subsubsection Picon Useless Configuration
18358
18359 @iftex
18360 @iflatex
18361 \margindex{}
18362 @end iflatex
18363 @end iftex
18364
18365 The following variables offer further control over how things are
18366 done, where things are located, and other useless stuff you really
18367 don't need to worry about.
18368
18369 @table @code
18370
18371 @item gnus-picons-news-directories
18372 @vindex gnus-picons-news-directories
18373 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for
18374 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
18375
18376 @item gnus-picons-user-directories
18377 @vindex gnus-picons-user-directories
18378 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for user
18379 faces. @code{("local" "users" "usenix" "misc")} is the default.
18380
18381 @item gnus-picons-domain-directories
18382 @vindex gnus-picons-domain-directories
18383 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picons-database} for
18384 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
18385 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
18386
18387 @item gnus-picons-convert-x-face
18388 @vindex gnus-picons-convert-x-face
18389 If you don't have @code{xface} support builtin XEmacs, this is the
18390 command to use to convert the @code{X-Face} header to an X bitmap
18391 (@code{xbm}). Defaults to @code{(format "@{ echo '/* Width=48,
18392 Height=48 */'; uncompface; @} | icontopbm | pbmtoxbm > %s"
18393 gnus-picons-x-face-file-name)}
18394
18395 @item gnus-picons-x-face-file-name
18396 @vindex gnus-picons-x-face-file-name
18397 Names a temporary file to store the @code{X-Face} bitmap in. Defaults
18398 to @code{(format "/tmp/picon-xface.%s.xbm" (user-login-name))}.
18399
18400 @item gnus-picons-has-modeline-p
18401 @vindex gnus-picons-has-modeline-p
18402 If you have set @code{gnus-picons-display-where} to @code{picons}, your
18403 XEmacs frame will become really cluttered. To alleviate this a bit you
18404 can set @code{gnus-picons-has-modeline-p} to @code{nil}; this will
18405 remove the mode line from the Picons buffer. This is only useful if
18406 @code{gnus-picons-display-where} is @code{picons}.
18407
18408 @item gnus-picons-refresh-before-display
18409 @vindex gnus-picons-refresh-before-display
18410 If non-nil, display the article buffer before computing the picons.
18411 Defaults to @code{nil}.
18412
18413 @item gnus-picons-display-as-address
18414 @vindex gnus-picons-display-as-address
18415 If @code{t} display textual email addresses along with pictures.
18416 Defaults to @code{t}.
18417
18418 @item gnus-picons-file-suffixes
18419 @vindex gnus-picons-file-suffixes
18420 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
18421 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not builtin your XEmacs.
18422
18423 @item gnus-picons-setup-hook
18424 @vindex gnus-picons-setup-hook
18425 Hook run in the picon buffer, if that is displayed.
18426
18427 @item gnus-picons-display-article-move-p
18428 @vindex gnus-picons-display-article-move-p
18429 Whether to move point to first empty line when displaying picons. This
18430 has only an effect if `gnus-picons-display-where' has value `article'.
18431
18432 If @code{nil}, display the picons in the @code{From} and
18433 @code{Newsgroups} lines. This is the default.
18434
18435 @item gnus-picons-clear-cache-on-shutdown
18436 @vindex gnus-picons-clear-cache-on-shutdown
18437 Whether to clear the picons cache when exiting gnus. Gnus caches every
18438 picons it finds while it is running. This saves some time in the search
18439 process but eats some memory. If this variable is set to @code{nil},
18440 Gnus will never clear the cache itself; you will have to manually call
18441 @code{gnus-picons-clear-cache} to clear it. Otherwise the cache will be
18442 cleared every time you exit Gnus. Defaults to @code{t}.
18443
18444 @iftex
18445 @iflatex
18446 \margindex{}
18447 @end iflatex
18448 @end iftex
18449
18450 @end table
18451
18452 @node Smileys
18453 @subsection Smileys
18454 @cindex smileys
18455
18456 @iftex
18457 @iflatex
18458 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/BigFace.ps,height=20cm}}
18459 \input{smiley}
18460 @end iflatex
18461 @end iftex
18462
18463 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
18464 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
18465
18466 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
18467 @file{.gnus.el} file:
18468
18469 @lisp
18470 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
18471 @end lisp
18472
18473 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{:-=}, @samp{:-(} and
18474 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
18475 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
18476 text and maps that to file names.
18477
18478 @vindex smiley-nosey-regexp-alist
18479 @vindex smiley-deformed-regexp-alist
18480 Smiley supplies two example conversion alists by default:
18481 @code{smiley-deformed-regexp-alist} (which matches @samp{:)}, @samp{:(}
18482 and so on), and @code{smiley-nosey-regexp-alist} (which matches
18483 @samp{:-)}, @samp{:-(} and so on).
18484
18485 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist} variable,
18486 which defaults to the value of @code{smiley-deformed-regexp-alist}.
18487
18488 The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched; the second
18489 element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by the picture;
18490 and the third element is the name of the file to be displayed.
18491
18492 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
18493 files, as well as the color to be used and stuff:
18494
18495 @table @code
18496
18497 @item smiley-data-directory
18498 @vindex smiley-data-directory
18499 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
18500
18501 @item smiley-flesh-color
18502 @vindex smiley-flesh-color
18503 Skin color. The default is @samp{yellow}, which is really racist.
18504
18505 @item smiley-features-color
18506 @vindex smiley-features-color
18507 Color of the features of the face. The default is @samp{black}.
18508
18509 @item smiley-tongue-color
18510 @vindex smiley-tongue-color
18511 Color of the tongue. The default is @samp{red}.
18512
18513 @item smiley-circle-color
18514 @vindex smiley-circle-color
18515 Color of the circle around the face. The default is @samp{black}.
18516
18517 @item smiley-mouse-face
18518 @vindex smiley-mouse-face
18519 Face used for mouse highlighting over the smiley face.
18520
18521 @end table
18522
18523
18524 @node Toolbar
18525 @subsection Toolbar
18526
18527 @table @code
18528
18529 @iftex
18530 @iflatex
18531 \margindex{}
18532 @end iflatex
18533 @end iftex
18534
18535 @item gnus-use-toolbar
18536 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
18537 If @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If non-@code{nil}, it should be
18538 one of @code{default-toolbar}, @code{top-toolbar}, @code{bottom-toolbar},
18539 @code{right-toolbar}, or @code{left-toolbar}.
18540
18541 @item gnus-group-toolbar
18542 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
18543 The toolbar in the group buffer.
18544
18545 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
18546 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
18547 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
18548
18549 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
18550 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
18551 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
18552
18553 @end table
18554
18555
18556 @node XVarious
18557 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
18558
18559 @table @code
18560 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
18561 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
18562 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
18563 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
18564 unusual directory structure.
18565
18566 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
18567 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-alist
18568 This is an alist where the key is a type symbol and the values are the
18569 foreground and background color of the splash page glyph.
18570
18571 @item gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
18572 @vindex gnus-xmas-logo-color-style
18573 This is the key used to look up the color in the alist described above.
18574 Valid values include @code{flame}, @code{pine}, @code{moss},
18575 @code{irish}, @code{sky}, @code{tin}, @code{velvet}, @code{grape},
18576 @code{labia}, @code{berry}, @code{neutral}, and @code{september}.
18577
18578 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
18579 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
18580 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
18581 default.
18582
18583 @iftex
18584 @iflatex
18585 \margindex{}
18586 @end iflatex
18587 @end iftex
18588
18589 @end table
18590
18591
18592
18593
18594 @node Fuzzy Matching
18595 @section Fuzzy Matching
18596 @cindex fuzzy matching
18597
18598 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
18599 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
18600
18601 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
18602 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
18603 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
18604
18605 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
18606 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
18607 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
18608 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
18609 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
18610
18611
18612 @node Thwarting Email Spam
18613 @section Thwarting Email Spam
18614 @cindex email spam
18615 @cindex spam
18616 @cindex UCE
18617 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
18618
18619 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
18620 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
18621 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
18622 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
18623 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
18624 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
18625 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
18626 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
18627 in the end.
18628
18629 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
18630 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
18631 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
18632 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
18633 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
18634 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
18635
18636 This is annoying.
18637
18638 The way to deal with this is having Gnus split out all spam into a
18639 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
18640
18641 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
18642 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
18643 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
18644 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
18645 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
18646 part of the mail address.)
18647
18648 @lisp
18649 (setq message-default-news-headers
18650 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
18651 @end lisp
18652
18653 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
18654 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
18655
18656 @lisp
18657 (
18658 ...
18659 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
18660 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
18661 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
18662 "spam"))
18663 ...
18664 )
18665 @end lisp
18666
18667 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
18668 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
18669 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
18670 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
18671
18672 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @code{smtp} server
18673 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
18674 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
18675 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
18676 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
18677 your fancy split rule in this way:
18678
18679 @lisp
18680 (
18681 ...
18682 (to "larsi" "misc")
18683 "spam")
18684 @end lisp
18685
18686 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
18687 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
18688 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
18689 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
18690 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
18691
18692 If you are also a lazy net citizen, you will probably prefer
18693 complaining automatically with the @file{gnus-junk.el} package,
18694 available as free software at @*
18695 @uref{http://stud2.tuwien.ac.at/~e9426626/gnus-junk.html}. Since most
18696 e-mail spam is sent automatically, this may reconcile the cosmic
18697 balance somewhat.
18698
18699 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
18700 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
18701 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
18702 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
18703
18704
18705 @node Various Various
18706 @section Various Various
18707 @cindex mode lines
18708 @cindex highlights
18709
18710 @table @code
18711
18712 @item gnus-home-directory
18713 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
18714 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
18715
18716 @item gnus-directory
18717 @vindex gnus-directory
18718 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
18719 this variable, which defaults to the @samp{SAVEDIR} environment
18720 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
18721
18722 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{.gnus.el} file is read.
18723 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
18724 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
18725 @file{.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
18726
18727 @item gnus-default-directory
18728 @vindex gnus-default-directory
18729 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
18730 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
18731 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
18732 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
18733 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
18734 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
18735
18736 @item gnus-verbose
18737 @vindex gnus-verbose
18738 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
18739 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
18740 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
18741 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
18742 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
18743
18744 @item gnus-verbose-backends
18745 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
18746 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
18747 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
18748
18749 @item nnheader-max-head-length
18750 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
18751 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
18752 as little as possible. This variable (default 4096) specifies
18753 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
18754 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
18755 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
18756 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
18757 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
18758 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
18759
18760 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
18761 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
18762 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
18763 read when doing the operation described above.
18764
18765 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
18766 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
18767 @cindex file names
18768 @cindex invalid characters in file names
18769 @cindex characters in file names
18770 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
18771 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
18772 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
18773
18774 @lisp
18775 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
18776 '((?: . ?_)))
18777 @end lisp
18778
18779 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
18780 Windows (phooey) systems.
18781
18782 @item gnus-hidden-properties
18783 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
18784 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
18785 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
18786 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
18787
18788 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
18789 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
18790 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
18791 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
18792 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
18793
18794 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
18795 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
18796 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
18797
18798 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
18799 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
18800
18801 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
18802 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
18803 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
18804 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
18805 group).
18806
18807 @sc{imap} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
18808
18809
18810 @end table
18811
18812
18813 @node The End
18814 @chapter The End
18815
18816 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
18817 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
18818
18819 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
18820
18821 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
18822
18823 @quotation
18824 @strong{Te Deum}
18825
18826 @sp 1
18827 Not because of victories @*
18828 I sing,@*
18829 having none,@*
18830 but for the common sunshine,@*
18831 the breeze,@*
18832 the largess of the spring.
18833
18834 @sp 1
18835 Not for victory@*
18836 but for the day's work done@*
18837 as well as I was able;@*
18838 not for a seat upon the dais@*
18839 but at the common table.@*
18840 @end quotation
18841
18842
18843 @node Appendices
18844 @chapter Appendices
18845
18846 @menu
18847 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
18848 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
18849 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
18850 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
18851 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
18852 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
18853 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
18854 * Frequently Asked Questions:: A question-and-answer session.
18855 @end menu
18856
18857
18858 @node History
18859 @section History
18860
18861 @cindex history
18862 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
18863 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
18864
18865 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
18866 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
18867 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
18868 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
18869 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
18870
18871 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
18872 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
18873 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
18874 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
18875 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
18876 appropriate name, don't you think?)
18877
18878 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
18879 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
18880 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
18881 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
18882
18883 @menu
18884 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
18885 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
18886 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
18887 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
18888 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
18889 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
18890 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
18891 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
18892 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
18893 @end menu
18894
18895
18896 @node Gnus Versions
18897 @subsection Gnus Versions
18898 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
18899 @cindex ding Gnus
18900 @cindex September Gnus
18901 @cindex Quassia Gnus
18902
18903 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
18904 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
18905 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
18906
18907 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
18908 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
18909
18910 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
18911 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
18912
18913 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
18914 If was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
18915
18916 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
18917 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
18918 1999.
18919
18920 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
18921 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'' --
18922 don't panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away.
18923 Slowly. Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're
18924 out of its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up
18925 to that instead.
18926
18927
18928 @node Other Gnus Versions
18929 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
18930 @cindex Semi-gnus
18931
18932 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
18933 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
18934 Japan. It's based on a library called @sc{semi}, which provides
18935 @sc{mime} capabilities.
18936
18937 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
18938 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
18939 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
18940 @sc{mime} and multilingualization things, especially important for
18941 Japanese users.
18942
18943
18944 @node Why?
18945 @subsection Why?
18946
18947 What's the point of Gnus?
18948
18949 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
18950 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
18951 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
18952 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
18953 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
18954 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
18955 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
18956 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
18957 keep track of millions of people who post?
18958
18959 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
18960 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
18961 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
18962 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
18963 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
18964 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
18965 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
18966 every one of you to explore and invent.
18967
18968 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
18969 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
18970
18971
18972 @node Compatibility
18973 @subsection Compatibility
18974
18975 @cindex compatibility
18976 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
18977 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
18978 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
18979
18980 Our motto is:
18981 @quotation
18982 @cartouche
18983 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
18984 @end cartouche
18985 @end quotation
18986
18987 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
18988 their names.
18989
18990 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
18991 Articles}.
18992
18993 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
18994 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
18995 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
18996 important variables have their values copied into their global
18997 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
18998 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
18999
19000 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
19001 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
19002 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
19003 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
19004 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
19005 peculiar results.
19006
19007 @cindex hilit19
19008 @cindex highlighting
19009 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
19010 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
19011 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
19012 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
19013 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
19014 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
19015 Away!
19016
19017 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
19018 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
19019 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
19020 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
19021
19022 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
19023 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
19024 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
19025 to stop doing it the old way.
19026
19027 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
19028
19029 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
19030 @findex gnus-bug
19031 @cindex reporting bugs
19032 @cindex bugs
19033 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
19034 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
19035 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
19036
19037 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
19038 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
19039 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
19040 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
19041 up at you.
19042
19043
19044 @node Conformity
19045 @subsection Conformity
19046
19047 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
19048 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
19049 with, of course.
19050
19051 @table @strong
19052
19053 @item RFC 822
19054 @cindex RFC 822
19055 There are no known breaches of this standard.
19056
19057 @item RFC 1036
19058 @cindex RFC 1036
19059 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
19060
19061 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
19062 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
19063 We do have some breaches to this one.
19064
19065 @table @emph
19066
19067 @item X-Newsreader
19068 @itemx User-Agent
19069 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
19070 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
19071 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
19072 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
19073 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
19074 @end table
19075
19076 @item USEFOR
19077 @cindex USEFOR
19078 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
19079 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
19080 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
19081 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
19082
19083 @end table
19084
19085 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
19086 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
19087 know.
19088
19089
19090 @node Emacsen
19091 @subsection Emacsen
19092 @cindex Emacsen
19093 @cindex XEmacs
19094 @cindex Mule
19095 @cindex Emacs
19096
19097 Gnus should work on :
19098
19099 @itemize @bullet
19100
19101 @item
19102 Emacs 20.3 and up.
19103
19104 @item
19105 XEmacs 20.4 and up.
19106
19107 @end itemize
19108
19109 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
19110 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
19111 Emacs versions.
19112
19113 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
19114 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
19115 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
19116 Emacsen.
19117
19118
19119 @node Gnus Development
19120 @subsection Gnus Development
19121
19122 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
19123 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
19124 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
19125 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
19126 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
19127 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
19128 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
19129 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
19130
19131 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
19132 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
19133 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
19134 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
19135 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
19136
19137 @cindex Incoming*
19138 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
19139 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
19140 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
19141 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
19142 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
19143
19144 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
19145 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
19146 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
19147 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
19148 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
19149 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
19150 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
19151 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
19152 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
19153 can't be assumed to do so.
19154
19155
19156
19157 @node Contributors
19158 @subsection Contributors
19159 @cindex contributors
19160
19161 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
19162 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
19163 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
19164 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
19165 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
19166 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
19167 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
19168 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
19169 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
19170 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
19171
19172 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for... oops,
19173 wrong show.
19174
19175 @itemize @bullet
19176
19177 @item
19178 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
19179
19180 @item
19181 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
19182 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @sc{mime} and
19183 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
19184 functionality and stuff.
19185
19186 @item
19187 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
19188 well as numerous other things).
19189
19190 @item
19191 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
19192
19193 @item
19194 Justin Sheehy--the FAQ maintainer.
19195
19196 @item
19197 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
19198
19199 @item
19200 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
19201 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
19202
19203 @item
19204 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
19205
19206 @item
19207 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
19208 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
19209
19210 @item
19211 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
19212
19213 @item
19214 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
19215
19216 @item
19217 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
19218
19219 @item
19220 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
19221
19222 @item
19223 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
19224 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
19225
19226 @item
19227 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
19228
19229 @item
19230 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
19231
19232 @item
19233 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
19234
19235 @item
19236 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
19237 .newsrc files.
19238
19239 @item
19240 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
19241
19242 @item
19243 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
19244
19245 @item
19246 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
19247
19248 @item
19249 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
19250 well as autoconf support.
19251
19252 @end itemize
19253
19254 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
19255 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
19256
19257 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
19258
19259 Christopher Davis,
19260 Andrew Eskilsson,
19261 Kai Grossjohann,
19262 David KÃ¥gedal,
19263 Richard Pieri,
19264 Fabrice Popineau,
19265 Daniel Quinlan,
19266 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
19267 and
19268 Jack Vinson.
19269
19270 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
19271
19272 Jari Aalto,
19273 Adrian Aichner,
19274 Vladimir Alexiev,
19275 Russ Allbery,
19276 Peter Arius,
19277 Matt Armstrong,
19278 Marc Auslander,
19279 Miles Bader,
19280 Alexei V. Barantsev,
19281 Frank Bennett,
19282 Robert Bihlmeyer,
19283 Chris Bone,
19284 Mark Borges,
19285 Mark Boyns,
19286 Lance A. Brown,
19287 Rob Browning,
19288 Kees de Bruin,
19289 Martin Buchholz,
19290 Joe Buehler,
19291 Kevin Buhr,
19292 Alastair Burt,
19293 Joao Cachopo,
19294 Zlatko Calusic,
19295 Massimo Campostrini,
19296 Castor,
19297 David Charlap,
19298 Dan Christensen,
19299 Kevin Christian,
19300 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
19301 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
19302 Laura Conrad,
19303 Michael R. Cook,
19304 Glenn Coombs,
19305 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
19306 Neil Crellin,
19307 Frank D. Cringle,
19308 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
19309 Andre Deparade,
19310 Ulrik Dickow,
19311 Dave Disser,
19312 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
19313 Joev Dubach,
19314 Michael Welsh Duggan,
19315 Dave Edmondson,
19316 Paul Eggert,
19317 Mark W. Eichin,
19318 Karl Eichwalder,
19319 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
19320 Michael Ernst,
19321 Luc Van Eycken,
19322 Sam Falkner,
19323 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
19324 Sigbjorn Finne,
19325 Sven Fischer,
19326 Paul Fisher,
19327 Decklin Foster,
19328 Gary D. Foster,
19329 Paul Franklin,
19330 Guy Geens,
19331 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
19332 David S. Goldberg,
19333 Michelangelo Grigni,
19334 Dale Hagglund,
19335 D. Hall,
19336 Magnus Hammerin,
19337 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
19338 Raja R. Harinath,
19339 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c ?
19340 P. E. Jareth Hein,
19341 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
19342 Scott Hofmann,
19343 Marc Horowitz,
19344 Gunnar Horrigmo,
19345 Richard Hoskins,
19346 Brad Howes,
19347 Miguel de Icaza,
19348 François Felix Ingrand,
19349 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c ?
19350 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
19351 Lee Iverson,
19352 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
19353 Rajappa Iyer,
19354 Andreas Jaeger,
19355 Adam P. Jenkins,
19356 Randell Jesup,
19357 Fred Johansen,
19358 Gareth Jones,
19359 Simon Josefsson,
19360 Greg Klanderman,
19361 Karl Kleinpaste,
19362 Michael Klingbeil,
19363 Peter Skov Knudsen,
19364 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
19365 Petr Konecny,
19366 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
19367 Thor Kristoffersen,
19368 Jens Lautenbacher,
19369 Martin Larose,
19370 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
19371 Joerg Lenneis,
19372 Carsten Leonhardt,
19373 James LewisMoss,
19374 Christian Limpach,
19375 Markus Linnala,
19376 Dave Love,
19377 Mike McEwan,
19378 Tonny Madsen,
19379 Shlomo Mahlab,
19380 Nat Makarevitch,
19381 Istvan Marko,
19382 David Martin,
19383 Jason R. Mastaler,
19384 Gordon Matzigkeit,
19385 Timo Metzemakers,
19386 Richard Mlynarik,
19387 Lantz Moore,
19388 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
19389 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
19390 Hrvoje Niksic,
19391 Andy Norman,
19392 Fred Oberhauser,
19393 C. R. Oldham,
19394 Alexandre Oliva,
19395 Ken Olstad,
19396 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
19397 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
19398 Ettore Perazzoli,
19399 William Perry,
19400 Stephen Peters,
19401 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
19402 Ulrich Pfeifer,
19403 Matt Pharr,
19404 Andy Piper,
19405 John McClary Prevost,
19406 Bill Pringlemeir,
19407 Mike Pullen,
19408 Jim Radford,
19409 Colin Rafferty,
19410 Lasse Rasinen,
19411 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
19412 Joe Reiss,
19413 Renaud Rioboo,
19414 Roland B. Roberts,
19415 Bart Robinson,
19416 Christian von Roques,
19417 Markus Rost,
19418 Jason Rumney,
19419 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
19420 Jay Sachs,
19421 Dewey M. Sasser,
19422 Conrad Sauerwald,
19423 Loren Schall,
19424 Dan Schmidt,
19425 Ralph Schleicher,
19426 Philippe Schnoebelen,
19427 Andreas Schwab,
19428 Randal L. Schwartz,
19429 Danny Siu,
19430 Matt Simmons,
19431 Paul D. Smith,
19432 Jeff Sparkes,
19433 Toby Speight,
19434 Michael Sperber,
19435 Darren Stalder,
19436 Richard Stallman,
19437 Greg Stark,
19438 Sam Steingold,
19439 Paul Stevenson,
19440 Jonas Steverud,
19441 Paul Stodghill,
19442 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
19443 Kurt Swanson,
19444 Samuel Tardieu,
19445 Teddy,
19446 Chuck Thompson,
19447 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
19448 Philippe Troin,
19449 James Troup,
19450 Trung Tran-Duc,
19451 Jack Twilley,
19452 Aaron M. Ucko,
19453 Aki Vehtari,
19454 Didier Verna,
19455 Vladimir Volovich,
19456 Jan Vroonhof,
19457 Stefan Waldherr,
19458 Pete Ware,
19459 Barry A. Warsaw,
19460 Christoph Wedler,
19461 Joe Wells,
19462 Lee Willis,
19463 Katsumi Yamaoka @c Yamaoka
19464 and
19465 Lloyd Zusman.
19466
19467
19468 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
19469 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
19470 (550kB and counting).
19471
19472 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
19473 sure.
19474
19475 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
19476 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
19477
19478
19479 @node New Features
19480 @subsection New Features
19481 @cindex new features
19482
19483 @menu
19484 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
19485 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
19486 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
19487 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
19488 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
19489 @end menu
19490
19491 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
19492 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
19493 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
19494
19495 @node ding Gnus
19496 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
19497
19498 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
19499
19500 @itemize @bullet
19501
19502 @item
19503 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
19504 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
19505
19506 @item
19507 Local spool and several @sc{nntp} servers can be used at once
19508 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
19509
19510 @item
19511 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
19512
19513 @item
19514 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
19515 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
19516 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
19517
19518 @item
19519 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
19520 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
19521 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
19522 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
19523
19524 @item
19525 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
19526 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
19527
19528 @item
19529 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
19530 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
19531 (@pxref{The Active File}).
19532
19533 @item
19534 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
19535 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
19536
19537 @item
19538 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
19539 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
19540 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
19541
19542 @item
19543 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
19544 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
19545 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
19546
19547 @item
19548 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{.gnus}) to avoid cluttering up
19549 the @file{.emacs} file.
19550
19551 @item
19552 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
19553 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
19554
19555 @item
19556 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
19557 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
19558
19559 @item
19560 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
19561 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
19562
19563 @item
19564 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
19565 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
19566
19567 @item
19568 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
19569 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
19570
19571 @item
19572 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
19573
19574 @item
19575 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
19576 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
19577
19578 @item
19579 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
19580 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
19581
19582 @item
19583 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
19584 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
19585
19586 @item
19587 Gnus can fetch FAQs and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
19588
19589 @item
19590 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
19591 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
19592
19593 @item
19594 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
19595 Articles}).
19596
19597 @item
19598 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
19599 Buttons}).
19600
19601 @item
19602 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
19603 configuration (@pxref{Windows Configuration}).
19604
19605 @item
19606 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
19607 (@pxref{Buttons}).
19608
19609 @end itemize
19610
19611
19612 @node September Gnus
19613 @subsubsection September Gnus
19614
19615 @iftex
19616 @iflatex
19617 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/september.ps,height=20cm}}
19618 @end iflatex
19619 @end iftex
19620
19621 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
19622
19623 @itemize @bullet
19624
19625 @item
19626 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
19627 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
19628 now obsolete.
19629
19630 @item
19631 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
19632 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
19633 Threading}).
19634
19635 @lisp
19636 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
19637 @end lisp
19638
19639 @item
19640 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
19641 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
19642
19643 @item
19644 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
19645 referred.
19646
19647 @item
19648 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
19649
19650 @item
19651 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
19652
19653 @item
19654 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
19655
19656 @lisp
19657 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
19658 @end lisp
19659
19660 @item
19661 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
19662 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
19663
19664 @lisp
19665 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
19666 @end lisp
19667
19668 @item
19669 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
19670 Groups}).
19671
19672 @item
19673 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
19674 Topics}).
19675
19676 @lisp
19677 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
19678 @end lisp
19679
19680 @item
19681 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
19682
19683 @item
19684 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
19685 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
19686
19687 @lisp
19688 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
19689 @end lisp
19690
19691 @item
19692 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
19693 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
19694
19695 @item
19696 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
19697
19698 @item
19699 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
19700 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
19701 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
19702
19703 @item
19704 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
19705 (@pxref{SOUP}).
19706
19707 @item
19708 The Gnus cache is much faster.
19709
19710 @item
19711 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
19712 Groups}).
19713
19714 @item
19715 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
19716 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
19717
19718 @item
19719 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
19720 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
19721
19722 @item
19723 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
19724 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
19725
19726 @item
19727 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
19728 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
19729 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
19730
19731 @item
19732 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
19733 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
19734
19735 @item
19736 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
19737
19738 @item
19739 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
19740
19741 @item
19742 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
19743
19744 @item
19745 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
19746
19747 @item
19748 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
19749 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
19750
19751 @item
19752 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Windows
19753 Configuration}).
19754
19755 @item
19756 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
19757 @iftex
19758 @iflatex
19759 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=tmp/fseptember.ps,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/fseptember.ps,height=5cm}}
19760 @end iflatex
19761 @end iftex
19762
19763 @item
19764 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
19765
19766 @lisp
19767 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
19768 @end lisp
19769
19770 @item
19771 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
19772
19773 @lisp
19774 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
19775 @end lisp
19776
19777 @item
19778 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
19779
19780 @item
19781 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
19782
19783 @item
19784 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
19785 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
19786
19787 @lisp
19788 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
19789 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
19790 @end lisp
19791
19792 @item
19793 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
19794 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
19795
19796 @lisp
19797 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
19798 @end lisp
19799
19800 @item
19801 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
19802 buffer to allow easier treatment.
19803
19804 @item
19805 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
19806
19807 @item
19808 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
19809 Articles}).
19810
19811 @lisp
19812 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
19813 @end lisp
19814
19815 @item
19816 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
19817 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
19818
19819 @lisp
19820 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
19821 @end lisp
19822
19823 @item
19824 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
19825 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
19826
19827 @item
19828 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
19829 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
19830
19831 @lisp
19832 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
19833 @end lisp
19834
19835 @item
19836 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
19837
19838 @item
19839 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
19840
19841 @item
19842 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
19843
19844 @end itemize
19845
19846
19847 @node Red Gnus
19848 @subsubsection Red Gnus
19849
19850 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
19851
19852 @iftex
19853 @iflatex
19854 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=tmp/red.ps,height=20cm}}
19855 @end iflatex
19856 @end iftex
19857
19858 @itemize @bullet
19859
19860 @item
19861 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
19862
19863 @item
19864 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
19865 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
19866
19867 @item
19868 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
19869 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
19870 Scoring}).
19871
19872 @item
19873 Article washing status can be displayed in the
19874 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
19875
19876 @item
19877 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
19878
19879 @item
19880 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
19881 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
19882
19883 @lisp
19884 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
19885 @end lisp
19886
19887 @item
19888 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
19889 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
19890 been added.
19891
19892 @item
19893 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
19894 Server Internals}).
19895
19896 @item
19897 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
19898 Parameters}).
19899
19900 @item
19901 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
19902
19903 @item
19904 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
19905 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
19906
19907 @item
19908 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
19909 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
19910 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
19911
19912 @item
19913 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
19914 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
19915
19916 @item
19917 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
19918 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
19919
19920 @item
19921 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
19922 (@pxref{Undo}).
19923
19924 @item
19925 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
19926 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
19927
19928 @item
19929 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
19930 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
19931
19932 @lisp
19933 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
19934 @end lisp
19935
19936 @item
19937 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
19938
19939 @lisp
19940 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
19941 @end lisp
19942
19943 @item
19944 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
19945 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
19946
19947 @item
19948 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
19949 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
19950
19951 @item
19952 A new command for reading collections of documents
19953 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
19954 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
19955
19956 @item
19957 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
19958 Marks}).
19959
19960 @item
19961 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @sc{nntp}
19962 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
19963
19964 @item
19965 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
19966 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
19967 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
19968
19969 @item
19970 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
19971 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
19972 Sorting}).
19973
19974 @item
19975 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
19976 Groups}).
19977
19978 @item
19979 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
19980 Commands}).
19981 @iftex
19982 @iflatex
19983 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=tmp/fred.ps,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=tmp/fred.ps,width=3cm}}
19984 @end iflatex
19985 @end iftex
19986
19987 @item
19988 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
19989 Variables}).
19990
19991 @item
19992 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
19993 Mail}).
19994
19995 @item
19996 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
19997 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
19998
19999 @item
20000 Emphasized text can be properly fontified:
20001
20002 @end itemize
20003
20004
20005 @node Quassia Gnus
20006 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
20007
20008 New features in Gnus 5.6:
20009
20010 @itemize @bullet
20011
20012 @item
20013 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
20014 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See
20015 @pxref{Gnus Unplugged} for the full story.
20016
20017 @item
20018 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
20019 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
20020 group, which is created automatically.
20021
20022 @item
20023 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
20024 values.
20025
20026 @item
20027 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
20028
20029 @item
20030 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
20031 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
20032
20033 @item
20034 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
20035 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
20036
20037 @item
20038 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
20039
20040 @item
20041 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
20042 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
20043
20044 @item
20045 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
20046
20047 @item
20048 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
20049 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
20050
20051 @item
20052 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
20053 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
20054
20055 @item
20056 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
20057 control over simplification.
20058
20059 @item
20060 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
20061
20062 @item
20063 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
20064 limit.
20065
20066 @item
20067 @kbd{M-@key{RET}} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
20068
20069 @item
20070 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
20071
20072 @item
20073 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
20074 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
20075 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
20076
20077 @item
20078 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
20079 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
20080
20081 @item
20082 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
20083 text---@kbd{W d}.
20084
20085 @item
20086 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
20087 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
20088
20089 @item
20090 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
20091 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @sc{nntp} servers.
20092
20093 @item
20094 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
20095 has been added.
20096
20097 @item
20098 A history of where mails have been split is available.
20099
20100 @item
20101 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
20102
20103 @item
20104 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
20105 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
20106
20107 @item
20108 A new function for citing in Message has been
20109 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
20110
20111 @item
20112 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
20113
20114 @item
20115 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
20116 been added.
20117
20118 @item
20119 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
20120 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
20121
20122 @item
20123 The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
20124 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
20125
20126 @item
20127 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
20128
20129 @item
20130 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
20131
20132 @end itemize
20133
20134 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
20135 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
20136
20137 New features in Gnus 5.8:
20138
20139 @itemize @bullet
20140
20141 @item The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
20142 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
20143
20144 If you used procmail like in
20145
20146 @lisp
20147 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
20148 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
20149 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
20150 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
20151 @end lisp
20152
20153 this now has changed to
20154
20155 @lisp
20156 (setq mail-sources
20157 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
20158 :suffix ".in")))
20159 @end lisp
20160
20161 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
20162 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
20163
20164 @item Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
20165 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
20166
20167 @item Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
20168 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
20169
20170 @item @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
20171 called to position point.
20172
20173 @item The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
20174 summary buffers and NOV files.
20175
20176 @item @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
20177 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
20178
20179 @item The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
20180 subtly different manner.
20181
20182 @item New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
20183 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
20184 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
20185
20186 @item Gnus can now read IMAP mail via @code{nnimap}.
20187
20188 @end itemize
20189
20190 @iftex
20191
20192 @page
20193 @node The Manual
20194 @section The Manual
20195 @cindex colophon
20196 @cindex manual
20197
20198 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
20199 either @code{texi2dvi}
20200 @iflatex
20201 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
20202 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
20203 @end iflatex
20204 to get what you hold in your hands now.
20205
20206 The following conventions have been used:
20207
20208 @enumerate
20209
20210 @item
20211 This is a @samp{string}
20212
20213 @item
20214 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
20215
20216 @item
20217 This is a @file{file}
20218
20219 @item
20220 This is a @code{symbol}
20221
20222 @end enumerate
20223
20224 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
20225 mean:
20226
20227 @lisp
20228 (setq flargnoze "yes")
20229 @end lisp
20230
20231 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
20232
20233 @lisp
20234 (setq flumphel 'yes)
20235 @end lisp
20236
20237 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
20238 ever get them confused.
20239
20240 @iflatex
20241 @c @head
20242 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
20243 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
20244 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
20245 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
20246 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
20247 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
20248 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
20249 @end iflatex
20250
20251 @end iftex
20252
20253
20254 @node On Writing Manuals
20255 @section On Writing Manuals
20256
20257 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
20258 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
20259 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
20260 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
20261 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
20262 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
20263 hand in hand.
20264
20265 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
20266 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
20267 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
20268 started with Gnus.
20269
20270 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
20271 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
20272
20273
20274 @page
20275 @node Terminology
20276 @section Terminology
20277
20278 @cindex terminology
20279 @table @dfn
20280
20281 @item news
20282 @cindex news
20283 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
20284 News is generally fetched from a nearby @sc{nntp} server, and is
20285 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
20286 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
20287 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
20288
20289 @item mail
20290 @cindex mail
20291 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
20292 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
20293 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
20294 not posting, and replying is not following up.
20295
20296 @item reply
20297 @cindex reply
20298 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
20299
20300 @item follow up
20301 @cindex follow up
20302 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
20303 are reading.
20304
20305 @item back end
20306 @cindex back end
20307 Gnus gets fed articles from a number of back ends, both news and mail
20308 back ends. Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this
20309 is all done by the back ends.
20310
20311 @item native
20312 @cindex native
20313 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
20314 default, way of getting news.
20315
20316 @item foreign
20317 @cindex foreign
20318 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
20319 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
20320 news.
20321
20322 @item secondary
20323 @cindex secondary
20324 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
20325 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
20326
20327 @item article
20328 @cindex article
20329 A message that has been posted as news.
20330
20331 @item mail message
20332 @cindex mail message
20333 A message that has been mailed.
20334
20335 @item message
20336 @cindex message
20337 A mail message or news article
20338
20339 @item head
20340 @cindex head
20341 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
20342 put.
20343
20344 @item body
20345 @cindex body
20346 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
20347 body.
20348
20349 @item header
20350 @cindex header
20351 A line from the head of an article.
20352
20353 @item headers
20354 @cindex headers
20355 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
20356 collection of @sc{nov} lines.
20357
20358 @item @sc{nov}
20359 @cindex nov
20360 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
20361 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
20362 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
20363 normal @sc{head} format.
20364
20365 @item level
20366 @cindex levels
20367 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
20368 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
20369 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
20370 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
20371 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
20372 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
20373
20374 @item killed groups
20375 @cindex killed groups
20376 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
20377 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
20378
20379 @item zombie groups
20380 @cindex zombie groups
20381 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
20382
20383 @item active file
20384 @cindex active file
20385 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
20386 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
20387 is rather large, as you might surmise.
20388
20389 @item bogus groups
20390 @cindex bogus groups
20391 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
20392 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
20393 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
20394
20395 @item activating
20396 @cindex activating groups
20397 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
20398 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
20399 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
20400
20401 @item server
20402 @cindex server
20403 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
20404
20405 @item select method
20406 @cindex select method
20407 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
20408 server settings.
20409
20410 @item virtual server
20411 @cindex virtual server
20412 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
20413 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
20414 whole is a virtual server.
20415
20416 @item washing
20417 @cindex washing
20418 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
20419 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
20420 original.
20421
20422 @item ephemeral groups
20423 @cindex ephemeral groups
20424 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
20425 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
20426 group, it'll disappear into the ether.
20427
20428 @item solid groups
20429 @cindex solid groups
20430 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
20431 group buffer are solid groups.
20432
20433 @item sparse articles
20434 @cindex sparse articles
20435 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
20436 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
20437
20438 @item threading
20439 @cindex threading
20440 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
20441 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
20442
20443 @item root
20444 @cindex root
20445 @cindex thread root
20446 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
20447 articles in the thread.
20448
20449 @item parent
20450 @cindex parent
20451 An article that has responses.
20452
20453 @item child
20454 @cindex child
20455 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
20456
20457 @item digest
20458 @cindex digest
20459 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
20460 specified by RFC 1153.
20461
20462 @end table
20463
20464
20465 @page
20466 @node Customization
20467 @section Customization
20468 @cindex general customization
20469
20470 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
20471 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
20472 for some quite common situations.
20473
20474 @menu
20475 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
20476 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
20477 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
20478 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
20479 @end menu
20480
20481
20482 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
20483 @subsection Slow/Expensive @sc{nntp} Connection
20484
20485 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
20486 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
20487 Gnus has to get from the @sc{nntp} server.
20488
20489 @table @code
20490
20491 @item gnus-read-active-file
20492 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
20493 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
20494 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
20495 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
20496 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
20497
20498 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
20499 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
20500 the @sc{nntp} server will not be very fast. Not all @sc{nntp} servers
20501 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
20502 @end table
20503
20504
20505 @node Slow Terminal Connection
20506 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
20507
20508 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
20509 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
20510 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
20511
20512 @table @code
20513
20514 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
20515 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
20516 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
20517 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
20518 horizontal and vertical recentering.
20519
20520 @item gnus-visible-headers
20521 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
20522 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
20523 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
20524 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
20525
20526 Set this hook to all the available hiding commands:
20527 @lisp
20528 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
20529 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
20530 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
20531 @end lisp
20532
20533 @item gnus-use-full-window
20534 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
20535 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
20536 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
20537 want to read them anyway.
20538
20539 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
20540 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
20541 hidden initially.
20542
20543 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
20544 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
20545 lines, which might save some time.
20546 @end table
20547
20548
20549 @node Little Disk Space
20550 @subsection Little Disk Space
20551 @cindex disk space
20552
20553 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
20554 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
20555
20556 @table @code
20557
20558 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
20559 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
20560 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
20561 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
20562 default.
20563
20564 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
20565 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
20566 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
20567 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
20568 default.
20569
20570 @item gnus-save-killed-list
20571 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
20572 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
20573 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
20574 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
20575
20576 @end table
20577
20578
20579 @node Slow Machine
20580 @subsection Slow Machine
20581 @cindex slow machine
20582
20583 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
20584 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
20585
20586 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
20587 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
20588
20589 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
20590 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
20591 summary buffer faster.
20592
20593
20594 @page
20595 @node Troubleshooting
20596 @section Troubleshooting
20597 @cindex troubleshooting
20598
20599 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
20600 problems, really.
20601
20602 Ahem.
20603
20604 @enumerate
20605
20606 @item
20607 Make sure your computer is switched on.
20608
20609 @item
20610 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
20611 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
20612 Gnus will work.
20613
20614 @item
20615 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
20616 like @samp{Gnus v5.46; nntp 4.0} you have the right files loaded. If,
20617 on the other hand, you get something like @samp{NNTP 3.x} or @samp{nntp
20618 flee}, you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
20619
20620 @item
20621 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a FAQ and a
20622 how-to.
20623
20624 @item
20625 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
20626 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
20627 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
20628 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
20629 something like that.
20630 @end enumerate
20631
20632 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
20633
20634 @cindex bugs
20635 @cindex reporting bugs
20636
20637 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
20638 @findex gnus-bug
20639 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
20640 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable @key{RET} debug-on-error @key{RET} t @key{RET}}, and send
20641 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
20642 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
20643
20644 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
20645 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
20646 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
20647 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
20648 time.
20649
20650 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
20651 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
20652 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
20653 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
20654 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
20655 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
20656
20657 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
20658 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
20659 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
20660 the bug report.
20661
20662 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
20663 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful.
20664
20665 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
20666 @cindex ding mailing list
20667 You can also ask on the ding mailing list---@samp{ding@@gnus.org}.
20668 Write to @samp{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
20669
20670
20671 @page
20672 @node Gnus Reference Guide
20673 @section Gnus Reference Guide
20674
20675 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
20676 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
20677 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
20678 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
20679 it.
20680
20681 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
20682 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
20683 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
20684 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
20685 and general methods of operation.
20686
20687 @menu
20688 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
20689 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
20690 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
20691 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
20692 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
20693 * Group Info:: The group info format.
20694 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
20695 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
20696 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
20697 @end menu
20698
20699
20700 @node Gnus Utility Functions
20701 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
20702 @cindex Gnus utility functions
20703 @cindex utility functions
20704 @cindex functions
20705 @cindex internal variables
20706
20707 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
20708 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
20709 Below is a list of the most common ones.
20710
20711 @table @code
20712
20713 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
20714 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
20715 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
20716
20717 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
20718 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
20719 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
20720
20721 @item gnus-group-real-name
20722 @findex gnus-group-real-name
20723 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
20724 name.
20725
20726 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
20727 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
20728 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
20729 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
20730
20731 @item gnus-get-info
20732 @findex gnus-get-info
20733 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
20734
20735 @item gnus-group-unread
20736 @findex gnus-group-unread
20737 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
20738 unknown.
20739
20740 @item gnus-active
20741 @findex gnus-active
20742 The active entry for @var{group}.
20743
20744 @item gnus-set-active
20745 @findex gnus-set-active
20746 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
20747
20748 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
20749 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
20750 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
20751 exit.
20752
20753 @item gnus-continuum-version
20754 @findex gnus-continuum-version
20755 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
20756 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
20757 versions.
20758
20759 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
20760 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
20761 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
20762
20763 @item gnus-news-group-p
20764 @findex gnus-news-group-p
20765 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
20766
20767 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
20768 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
20769 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
20770
20771 @item gnus-server-to-method
20772 @findex gnus-server-to-method
20773 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
20774
20775 @item gnus-server-equal
20776 @findex gnus-server-equal
20777 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
20778
20779 @item gnus-group-native-p
20780 @findex gnus-group-native-p
20781 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
20782
20783 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
20784 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
20785 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
20786
20787 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
20788 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
20789 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
20790
20791 @item group-group-find-parameter
20792 @findex group-group-find-parameter
20793 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
20794 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
20795
20796 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
20797 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
20798 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
20799
20800 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
20801 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
20802 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
20803
20804 @item gnus-check-backend-function
20805 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
20806 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
20807 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
20808
20809 @lisp
20810 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
20811 @result{} t
20812 @end lisp
20813
20814 @item gnus-read-method
20815 @findex gnus-read-method
20816 Prompts the user for a select method.
20817
20818 @end table
20819
20820
20821 @node Back End Interface
20822 @subsection Back End Interface
20823
20824 Gnus doesn't know anything about @sc{nntp}, spools, mail or virtual
20825 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
20826 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
20827 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
20828 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
20829 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
20830
20831 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
20832 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
20833 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
20834 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
20835 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
20836 been opened, the function should fail.
20837
20838 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
20839 name. Take this example:
20840
20841 @lisp
20842 (nntp "odd-one"
20843 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
20844 (nntp-port-number 4324))
20845 @end lisp
20846
20847 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
20848 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
20849
20850 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
20851 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
20852 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
20853
20854 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
20855 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
20856 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
20857
20858 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
20859 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
20860 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
20861 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
20862 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
20863 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
20864 return value.
20865
20866 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
20867 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
20868 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
20869 -- they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
20870 more.
20871
20872 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
20873 @code{nnchoke}.
20874
20875 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
20876
20877 @menu
20878 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
20879 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
20880 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
20881 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
20882 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
20883 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
20884 @end menu
20885
20886
20887 @node Required Back End Functions
20888 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
20889
20890 @table @code
20891
20892 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
20893
20894 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
20895 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
20896 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
20897 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
20898
20899 The result data should either be HEADs or NOV lines, and the result
20900 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
20901 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
20902 of HEADs and NOV lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
20903
20904 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching "extra
20905 headers", in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
20906 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
20907 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
20908 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
20909 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
20910 number, do maximum fetches.
20911
20912 Here's an example HEAD:
20913
20914 @example
20915 221 1056 Article retrieved.
20916 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
20917 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
20918 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
20919 Subject: Re: Something very droll
20920 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
20921 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
20922 Lines: 26
20923 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
20924 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
20925 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
20926 .
20927 @end example
20928
20929 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
20930 these in the data buffer.
20931
20932 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
20933
20934 @example
20935 headers = *head
20936 head = error / valid-head
20937 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
20938 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
20939 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
20940 header = <text> eol
20941 @end example
20942
20943 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
20944 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
20945 separated by tabs.
20946
20947 @example
20948 nov-buffer = *nov-line
20949 nov-line = 8*9 [ field <TAB> ] eol
20950 field = <text except TAB>
20951 @end example
20952
20953 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
20954 @pxref{Headers}.
20955
20956
20957 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
20958
20959 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
20960 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
20961
20962 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
20963 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
20964 server. In fact, it should do so.
20965
20966 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
20967 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
20968
20969
20970 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
20971
20972 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
20973 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
20974 reason.
20975
20976 There should be no data returned.
20977
20978
20979 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
20980
20981 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
20982 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
20983 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
20984 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
20985
20986 There should be no data returned.
20987
20988
20989 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
20990
20991 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
20992 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
20993 non-@code{nil} vlue. This function should under no circumstances
20994 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
20995
20996 There should be no data returned.
20997
20998
20999 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
21000
21001 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
21002
21003 There should be no data returned.
21004
21005
21006 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
21007
21008 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
21009 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
21010 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
21011 it would be nice if that were possible.
21012
21013 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
21014 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
21015 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
21016 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
21017 into its article buffer.
21018
21019 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
21020 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
21021 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
21022 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
21023 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
21024 on successful article retrieval.
21025
21026
21027 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
21028
21029 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
21030 making @var{group} the current group.
21031
21032 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
21033 the current group.
21034
21035 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
21036
21037 @example
21038 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
21039 @end example
21040
21041 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
21042 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
21043 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
21044 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
21045 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
21046 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
21047 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
21048 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader.
21049
21050 @example
21051 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
21052 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
21053 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
21054 @end example
21055
21056
21057 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
21058
21059 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
21060 a no-op on most back ends.
21061
21062 There should be no data returned.
21063
21064
21065 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
21066
21067 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
21068 @emph{all}.
21069
21070 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
21071
21072 @example
21073 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
21074 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
21075 @end example
21076
21077 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
21078 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag.
21079
21080 @example
21081 active-file = *active-line
21082 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
21083 name = <string>
21084 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
21085 @end example
21086
21087 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
21088 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
21089 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
21090
21091
21092 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
21093
21094 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
21095 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
21096 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
21097 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
21098 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
21099 clear if the posting could not be completed.
21100
21101 There should be no result data from this function.
21102
21103 @end table
21104
21105
21106 @node Optional Back End Functions
21107 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
21108
21109 @table @code
21110
21111 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
21112
21113 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
21114 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
21115 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
21116
21117 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
21118 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
21119 former is in the same format as the data from
21120 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
21121 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
21122
21123 @example
21124 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
21125 @end example
21126
21127
21128 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
21129
21130 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
21131 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all the
21132 information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
21133 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
21134 should return the (altered) group info.
21135
21136 There should be no result data from this function.
21137
21138
21139 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
21140
21141 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
21142 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
21143 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
21144 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
21145 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
21146 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
21147 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
21148 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
21149
21150 There should be no result data from this function.
21151
21152
21153 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
21154
21155 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
21156 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
21157 @code{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @sc{imap}) however carry
21158 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
21159 propagate the mark information to the server.
21160
21161 ACTION is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
21162
21163 @example
21164 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
21165 @end example
21166
21167 Range is a range of articles you wish to update marks on. Action is
21168 @code{set}, @code{add} or @code{del}, respectively used for removing all
21169 existing marks and setting them as specified, adding (preserving the
21170 marks not mentioned) mark and removing (preserving the marks not
21171 mentioned) marks. Mark is a list of marks; where each mark is a symbol.
21172 Currently used marks are @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply},
21173 @code{expire}, @code{killed}, @code{dormant}, @code{save},
21174 @code{download} and @code{unsend}, but your back end should, if possible,
21175 not limit itself to these.
21176
21177 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
21178 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
21179 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
21180 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
21181
21182 An example action list:
21183
21184 @example
21185 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
21186 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
21187 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
21188 @end example
21189
21190 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
21191 mark on (currently not used for anything).
21192
21193 There should be no result data from this function.
21194
21195 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
21196
21197 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
21198 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
21199 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
21200 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
21201 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
21202
21203 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
21204 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
21205 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
21206 expirable.
21207
21208 There should be no result data from this function.
21209
21210
21211 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
21212
21213 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
21214 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
21215 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query the
21216 POP server when this function is invoked. The @var{group} doesn't have
21217 to be heeded---if the back end decides that it is too much work just
21218 scanning for a single group, it may do a total scan of all groups. It
21219 would be nice, however, to keep things local if that's practical.
21220
21221 There should be no result data from this function.
21222
21223
21224 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
21225
21226 The result data from this function should be a description of
21227 @var{group}.
21228
21229 @example
21230 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
21231 name = <string>
21232 description = <text>
21233 @end example
21234
21235 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
21236
21237 The result data from this function should be the description of all
21238 groups available on the server.
21239
21240 @example
21241 description-buffer = *description-line
21242 @end example
21243
21244
21245 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
21246
21247 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
21248 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date
21249 format. The data should be in the active buffer format.
21250
21251
21252 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
21253
21254 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
21255
21256 There should be no return data.
21257
21258
21259 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
21260
21261 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
21262 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
21263 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
21264 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
21265 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
21266 they are.
21267
21268 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
21269 able to delete.
21270
21271 There should be no result data returned.
21272
21273
21274 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM
21275 &optional LAST)
21276
21277 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
21278 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
21279
21280 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
21281 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
21282 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
21283 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
21284 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
21285 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
21286
21287 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
21288 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
21289 optimizations.
21290
21291 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
21292 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
21293
21294 There should be no data returned.
21295
21296
21297 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
21298
21299 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
21300 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
21301 this function in short order.
21302
21303 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
21304 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
21305
21306 There should be no data returned.
21307
21308
21309 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
21310
21311 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
21312 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
21313
21314 There should be no data returned.
21315
21316
21317 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
21318
21319 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
21320 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
21321 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
21322
21323 There should be no data returned.
21324
21325
21326 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
21327
21328 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
21329 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
21330
21331 There should be no data returned.
21332
21333 @end table
21334
21335
21336 @node Error Messaging
21337 @subsubsection Error Messaging
21338
21339 @findex nnheader-report
21340 @findex nnheader-get-report
21341 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
21342 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
21343 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
21344 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
21345 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
21346 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
21347
21348 @lisp
21349 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
21350
21351 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
21352 @end lisp
21353
21354 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
21355 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
21356 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
21357 takes one argument---the server symbol.
21358
21359 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
21360 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
21361 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
21362
21363
21364 @node Writing New Back Ends
21365 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
21366
21367 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
21368 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
21369 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
21370 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
21371 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
21372 editing articles.
21373
21374 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
21375 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
21376 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
21377
21378 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
21379 package called @code{nnoo}.
21380
21381 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
21382 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
21383 following macros:
21384
21385 @table @code
21386
21387 @item nnoo-declare
21388 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
21389 parameters. For instance:
21390
21391 @lisp
21392 (nnoo-declare nndir
21393 nnml nnmh)
21394 @end lisp
21395
21396 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
21397 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
21398
21399 @item defvoo
21400 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
21401 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
21402 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
21403
21404 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
21405 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
21406 a function in those back ends.
21407
21408 @lisp
21409 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
21410 "Where nndir will look for groups."
21411 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
21412 @end lisp
21413
21414 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
21415 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
21416 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
21417
21418 @item nnoo-define-basics
21419 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
21420 have.
21421
21422 @example
21423 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
21424 @end example
21425
21426 @item deffoo
21427 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
21428 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
21429 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
21430
21431 @item nnoo-map-functions
21432 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
21433 functions from the parent back ends.
21434
21435 @example
21436 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
21437 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
21438 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
21439 @end example
21440
21441 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
21442 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
21443 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
21444 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
21445
21446 @item nnoo-import
21447 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
21448 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
21449 haven't already been defined.
21450
21451 @example
21452 (nnoo-import nndir
21453 (nnmh
21454 nnmh-request-list
21455 nnmh-request-newgroups)
21456 (nnml))
21457 @end example
21458
21459 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
21460 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
21461 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
21462 defined now.
21463
21464 @end table
21465
21466 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
21467
21468 @lisp
21469 ;;; nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus
21470 ;; Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
21471
21472 ;;; Code:
21473
21474 (require 'nnheader)
21475 (require 'nnmh)
21476 (require 'nnml)
21477 (require 'nnoo)
21478 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
21479
21480 (nnoo-declare nndir
21481 nnml nnmh)
21482
21483 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
21484 "Where nndir will look for groups."
21485 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
21486
21487 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
21488 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
21489 nnml-nov-is-evil)
21490
21491 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
21492 nil
21493 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
21494 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
21495 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
21496
21497 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
21498 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
21499
21500 ;;; Interface functions.
21501
21502 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
21503
21504 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
21505 (setq nndir-directory
21506 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
21507 server))
21508 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
21509 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
21510 (push `(nndir-current-group
21511 ,(file-name-nondirectory
21512 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
21513 defs)
21514 (push `(nndir-top-directory
21515 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
21516 defs)
21517 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
21518
21519 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
21520 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
21521 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
21522 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
21523 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
21524
21525 (nnoo-import nndir
21526 (nnmh
21527 nnmh-status-message
21528 nnmh-request-list
21529 nnmh-request-newgroups))
21530
21531 (provide 'nndir)
21532 @end lisp
21533
21534
21535 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
21536 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
21537
21538 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
21539 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
21540 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
21541 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
21542
21543 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
21544 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
21545
21546 Here's an example:
21547
21548 @lisp
21549 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
21550 @end lisp
21551
21552 The abilities can be:
21553
21554 @table @code
21555 @item mail
21556 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
21557 @item post
21558 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
21559 @item post-mail
21560 This back end supports both mail and news.
21561 @item none
21562 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
21563 different.
21564 @item respool
21565 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
21566 articles and groups.
21567 @item address
21568 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
21569 true for almost all back ends.
21570 @item prompt-address
21571 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
21572 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
21573 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
21574 @end table
21575
21576
21577 @node Mail-like Back Ends
21578 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
21579
21580 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
21581 back ends is the heavy dependence by the mail back ends on common
21582 functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the definition of
21583 @code{nnml-request-scan}:
21584
21585 @lisp
21586 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
21587 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
21588 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
21589 @end lisp
21590
21591 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
21592 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
21593 mail.
21594
21595 This function takes four parameters.
21596
21597 @table @var
21598 @item method
21599 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
21600 the call.
21601
21602 @item exit-function
21603 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
21604
21605 @item temp-directory
21606 Where the temporary files should be stored.
21607
21608 @item group
21609 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
21610 performed for one group only.
21611 @end table
21612
21613 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
21614 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
21615 find the article number assigned to this article.
21616
21617 The function also uses the following variables:
21618 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
21619 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
21620 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
21621 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
21622 this:
21623
21624 @example
21625 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
21626 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
21627 @end example
21628
21629
21630 @node Score File Syntax
21631 @subsection Score File Syntax
21632
21633 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
21634 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
21635 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
21636
21637 Here's a typical score file:
21638
21639 @lisp
21640 (("summary"
21641 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
21642 ("Gnus"))
21643 ("from"
21644 ("Lars" -1000))
21645 (mark -100))
21646 @end lisp
21647
21648 BNF definition of a score file:
21649
21650 @example
21651 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
21652 element = rule / atom
21653 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
21654 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
21655 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
21656 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
21657 quote = <ascii 34>
21658 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
21659 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
21660 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
21661 date-header = "date"
21662 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
21663 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
21664 score = "nil" / <integer>
21665 date = "nil" / <natural number>
21666 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
21667 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
21668 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
21669 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
21670 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
21671 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
21672 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
21673 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
21674 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
21675 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
21676 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
21677 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
21678 exclude-files / read-only / touched
21679 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
21680 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
21681 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
21682 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
21683 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
21684 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
21685 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
21686 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
21687 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
21688 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
21689 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
21690 eval = "eval" space <form>
21691 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
21692 @end example
21693
21694 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
21695 discarded.
21696
21697 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
21698 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
21699 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
21700 one looong line, then that's ok.
21701
21702 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
21703 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
21704
21705
21706 @node Headers
21707 @subsection Headers
21708
21709 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
21710 corresponds to the @sc{nov} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
21711 almost suspect that the author looked at the @sc{nov} specification and
21712 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
21713
21714 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
21715 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
21716 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
21717 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
21718 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
21719 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
21720 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
21721
21722 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
21723 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
21724 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
21725 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
21726 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
21727
21728 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
21729 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
21730
21731
21732 @node Ranges
21733 @subsection Ranges
21734
21735 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
21736 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
21737
21738 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
21739 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
21740 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
21741 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
21742
21743 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
21744 sequence.
21745
21746 @example
21747 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
21748 @end example
21749
21750 is transformed into
21751
21752 @example
21753 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
21754 @end example
21755
21756 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
21757 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
21758
21759 @example
21760 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
21761 @end example
21762
21763 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
21764 is slightly tricky:
21765
21766 @example
21767 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
21768 @end example
21769
21770 and
21771
21772 @example
21773 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
21774 @end example
21775
21776 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
21777
21778 @example
21779 (1 2 3 4 5)
21780 @end example
21781
21782 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
21783 also valid:
21784
21785 @example
21786 (1 . 5)
21787 @end example
21788
21789 and is equal to the previous range.
21790
21791 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
21792 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
21793 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
21794 range handling.)
21795
21796 @example
21797 range = simple-range / normal-range
21798 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
21799 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
21800 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
21801 number *[ " " contents ]
21802 @end example
21803
21804 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
21805 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
21806 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
21807 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
21808 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
21809 sequences.)
21810
21811
21812 @node Group Info
21813 @subsection Group Info
21814
21815 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
21816 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
21817 describes the group.
21818
21819 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
21820 second is a more complex one:
21821
21822 @example
21823 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
21824
21825 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
21826 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
21827 (nnml "")
21828 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
21829 @end example
21830
21831 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
21832 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
21833 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
21834 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
21835 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
21836 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
21837 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
21838 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
21839 this section is about.
21840
21841 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
21842 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
21843 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
21844
21845 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
21846
21847 @example
21848 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
21849 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
21850 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
21851 group = quote <string> quote
21852 ralevel = rank / level
21853 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
21854 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
21855 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
21856 read = range
21857 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
21858 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
21859 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
21860 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
21861 @end example
21862
21863 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
21864 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
21865 in pseudo-BNF.
21866
21867 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
21868 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
21869
21870 @table @code
21871 @item gnus-info-group
21872 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
21873 @findex gnus-info-group
21874 @findex gnus-info-set-group
21875 Get/set the group name.
21876
21877 @item gnus-info-rank
21878 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
21879 @findex gnus-info-rank
21880 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
21881 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
21882
21883 @item gnus-info-level
21884 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
21885 @findex gnus-info-level
21886 @findex gnus-info-set-level
21887 Get/set the group level.
21888
21889 @item gnus-info-score
21890 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
21891 @findex gnus-info-score
21892 @findex gnus-info-set-score
21893 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
21894
21895 @item gnus-info-read
21896 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
21897 @findex gnus-info-read
21898 @findex gnus-info-set-read
21899 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
21900
21901 @item gnus-info-marks
21902 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
21903 @findex gnus-info-marks
21904 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
21905 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
21906
21907 @item gnus-info-method
21908 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
21909 @findex gnus-info-method
21910 @findex gnus-info-set-method
21911 Get/set the group select method.
21912
21913 @item gnus-info-params
21914 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
21915 @findex gnus-info-params
21916 @findex gnus-info-set-params
21917 Get/set the group parameters.
21918 @end table
21919
21920 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
21921 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
21922
21923 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
21924 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
21925 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
21926 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
21927
21928
21929 @node Extended Interactive
21930 @subsection Extended Interactive
21931 @cindex interactive
21932 @findex gnus-interactive
21933
21934 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
21935 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
21936 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
21937
21938 @lisp
21939 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
21940 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
21941 ...
21942 )
21943 @end lisp
21944
21945 The best thing to do would have been to implement
21946 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
21947 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
21948 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
21949 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
21950 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
21951 @code{interactive}.
21952
21953 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
21954 adds a few more.
21955
21956 @table @samp
21957 @item y
21958 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
21959 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
21960 variable.
21961
21962 @item Y
21963 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
21964 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
21965 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
21966
21967 @item A
21968 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
21969 function.
21970
21971 @item H
21972 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
21973 function.
21974
21975 @item g
21976 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
21977 function.
21978
21979 @end table
21980
21981
21982 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
21983 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
21984 @cindex XEmacs
21985 @cindex Emacsen
21986
21987 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
21988 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
21989 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
21990
21991 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
21992 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
21993 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
21994 Gnus, that's very useful.
21995
21996 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
21997 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
21998 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
21999 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
22000 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
22001 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
22002 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
22003 following function:
22004
22005 @lisp
22006 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
22007 (start-itimer
22008 "gnus-run-at-time"
22009 `(lambda ()
22010 (,function ,@@args))
22011 time repeat))
22012 @end lisp
22013
22014 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
22015 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
22016 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
22017 all over.
22018
22019 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
22020 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
22021 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
22022
22023 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
22024 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
22025 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
22026
22027
22028 @node Various File Formats
22029 @subsection Various File Formats
22030
22031 @menu
22032 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
22033 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
22034 @end menu
22035
22036
22037 @node Active File Format
22038 @subsubsection Active File Format
22039
22040 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
22041 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
22042 in each group.
22043
22044 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
22045
22046 @example
22047 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
22048 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
22049 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
22050 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
22051 no.general 1000 900 y
22052 @end example
22053
22054 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
22055
22056 @example
22057 active = *group-line
22058 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
22059 group = <non-white-space string>
22060 spc = " "
22061 high-number = <non-negative integer>
22062 low-number = <positive integer>
22063 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
22064 @end example
22065
22066 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
22067 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
22068
22069
22070 @node Newsgroups File Format
22071 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
22072
22073 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
22074 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
22075 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
22076 the user.
22077
22078 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
22079 Here's the definition:
22080
22081 @example
22082 newsgroups = *line
22083 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
22084 group = <non-white-space string>
22085 tab = <TAB>
22086 description = <string>
22087 @end example
22088
22089
22090 @page
22091 @node Emacs for Heathens
22092 @section Emacs for Heathens
22093
22094 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
22095 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
22096 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
22097 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
22098 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
22099 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
22100 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
22101 cat instead.
22102
22103 @menu
22104 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
22105 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
22106 @end menu
22107
22108
22109 @node Keystrokes
22110 @subsection Keystrokes
22111
22112 @itemize @bullet
22113 @item
22114 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
22115
22116 @item
22117 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
22118 @end itemize
22119
22120 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
22121 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
22122 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
22123 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
22124 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
22125 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
22126
22127 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
22128 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
22129 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
22130 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
22131 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
22132 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
22133 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
22134
22135 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
22136 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
22137 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
22138 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
22139 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
22140 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
22141 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
22142
22143 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
22144 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
22145 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
22146 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
22147 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
22148 it.
22149
22150
22151
22152 @node Emacs Lisp
22153 @subsection Emacs Lisp
22154
22155 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
22156 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
22157 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
22158 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
22159
22160 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
22161 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
22162 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
22163 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
22164 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
22165 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
22166 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{.emacs} file
22167 to customize Gnus.
22168
22169 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
22170 write the following:
22171
22172 @lisp
22173 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
22174 @end lisp
22175
22176 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
22177 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
22178 you can go and fill your @code{.emacs} file with lots of these to change
22179 how Gnus works.
22180
22181 If you have put that thing in your @code{.emacs} file, it will be read
22182 and @code{eval}ed (which is lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
22183 start Emacs. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
22184 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
22185 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
22186
22187 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
22188 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
22189 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
22190
22191 Some pitfalls:
22192
22193 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
22194 that means:
22195
22196 @lisp
22197 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
22198 @end lisp
22199
22200 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
22201 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
22202
22203 @lisp
22204 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
22205 @end lisp
22206
22207 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
22208 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
22209
22210 @page
22211 @include gnus-faq.texi
22212
22213 @node Index
22214 @chapter Index
22215 @printindex cp
22216
22217 @node Key Index
22218 @chapter Key Index
22219 @printindex ky
22220
22221 @summarycontents
22222 @contents
22223 @bye
22224
22225 @iftex
22226 @iflatex
22227 \end{document}
22228 @end iflatex
22229 @end iftex
22230
22231 @c End: